You are on page 1of 305

YOUR

ELECTRO.VIBRATORY
BODY
A Study of theLi.feForce as Electrevibratory Phenomena

VICTOR R BEASLEY, PH.D.


Volume one of the Six Volume series ..The SupersensitveLife of Man''.

GENERAL EDITOR

CHRISTOPHER HILLS, Ph.d.,D.SC.,

UNIVERSITY OF THE TREES PRESS


P.O. Box 644
Boulder Creek, California 95006
YOUR ELECTRO.VIBRATORY BODY
Copyrigtt @ 1978 by University of the Trees Press.

ffi RUt t, Reserved. No part of this book may be reproduced in any


form or by any electronic ormechanical means including information
storage and retrieval systems without permission in writing from the
publisher, except by a reviewer who may quote brief passagesin
review.

LIBRARY OF CONGRESS CATALOG CARD NUMBER:

ISBN 0-916438-15-s

SECOND EDITION:'77-085774

First Edition Copyright 1975.

Cover photographs and desien by John Hi[s.

Printed in the United States of America


by Kingsport Press.

Library of Congress Cataloglng in Publlcatlon Data

Beasiey,Victor R, 1945-
Your ElectroVibratory Body.

(The SupersensitiveLife of Man; v. l )


Bibliography p.
Includesindex.
1. Consciousness.2. Personality. I. Title.
IL Series.
BF311.M3 001.9 77-85774
ISBN 0-916438-15-5

University of the Trees Press, Box 644, Boulder Greek Ca. 950O6
Volume One of the Six Volume series "The Supersensitive Life of Man".

INTRODUCTION TO THE'SECOND EDITION

It is now eightyears since Dr. Beasley came to me in London


to embarkon the coursewhich led him to write this book In that
time much has happenedand still is happeningin thewhole field
of the vibratory body which cannot yet be documented due to
lack of time and lack of flrnances.Obviously no government
departmentor large foundationwould think it safeto be risking
its name on this scientific borderline stuffcalled psychotronics,
Supersensonicsor radionics. Hence grantsare nonexistentand
only the sale of the books can help to defray the cost of
publishing further research.Even the first edition printed and
typesetin Barbados in a cramped,badly designedbook without
a color cover sold out on its contentmatteralone.It was used as
a textbook by many schools investigatingnew energies and
thereforewe have redesignedthe book with the able help of Dr.
Robert Massy to becomea textbookwhich has beenbroughtup
to datewith recentresearchesin negativeions, wholistic heling
and biomagnetics.
Christopher Hlls'
General Editor
May, 1978

tv
I
I

INTRODUCTION TO THE FIRST EDITION

When Victor Beasley came to me in 1970 and said that he


was thinking of getting a doctorate under a new program
which would enable him to choose his own field of inquiry,
he asked if I would help him to complete his thesis on
Nuclear Evolution. Inwardly I smiled because of the vastness
of the subject, but I nevertheless encouraged him to seek a
specific area of inquiry in that field, particularly as to how
the emanations of energy at different subtle levels, which are
often called auras, interact with the ability of humans to
communicate with each other. Since the world problems,
peace, political understanding as well as marital and social
understanding, all suffer from the inability of humans to
know from what level of consciousness they are speaking or
seeing, I felt it would be best if I gave Victor a few leads of
people to see, places to go, areas to look into and he would
soon be into the deep waters of our unknown selves. Since
those days he has rigorously limited his field to the graspable
evidence within the reach of anyone who would wish to
investigateand prove for themselvesthe truth of subtle forces.

To go beyond the immediate measuring devices of science


to a reality which can only be measured by developing new
conceptual comparative skills was a courageous decision
which would leave behind many people who would be
passing judgement on his work. The fact that these energies
are just as real, in spite of our scientific inability to measure
and understand them, can only be tested by those who are
prepared to venture into forbidden territory. The human
authorities which label all these "forbidden areas" are those
which may be afraid of discovering a different kind of Truth
from the one they already know. The ancient sages,through
direct perception, charted many of the kingdoms of nature
which science is slowly rediscovering.

The ancient yogis were both physicists and mathematicians,


but the discovery of consciousness dwarfed these disciplines
as it will again when man wakes up to his real nature.
The seven-layered atom and the causal energies which
witness the material universe through the consciousness of
man was the study of great researchers who were not held
back by the need to publish and report findings, or to establish
credibility through name and fame. They raced so far ahead
of ordinary man's everyday experience to discover the life
force itself seated at the Center of the observer and witness
of creation. Man is a nucleus and the universe is its expansion
into seven thresholds of energy. Prana, or vital force of life,
is the cause of this expansion. It is often referred to as the
vital breath of the universe or "vayu" in Sanskrit. Prana
maintains the link between the manifest physical body and
the subtle worlds of the spirit. Prana is present in the uncon-
scious self during sleep as well as in the waking state. In its
expansion from the seed of Self-sense to awareness of the
seven worlds of Being, prana undergoes many modifications
as it passes through the seven chakras in man's psycho-
physical make up. During these modifications, however, it
never changes ts true nature' Just as water can appear at
different enegy levels to be a gas by the application ofheat
energy and to be a solid in the form of ice through extraction
of heat energy and also as a liquid representing 90 percent of
the make up of our physical body, so can prana cause the
expansion and contraction of the normal operation of atoms
and molecules other than water in the human bodv.

This prana being under the control of consciousness in


advanced adepts and being under the unconscious control of
common folk, manifests whatever is in the ego of a person as
a reflection. tf the prana is not flowing evenly through each
of the seven chakras the reflection will be warped and may
not even be visible on the outer limits of the seven thresholds.
We know in physics that every nucleus which is highly
energized has most of its orbits filled with electrons. Man is
no different at the micro-energy level.

The macro-universe in which he exists as a reflection in his


own chakra activity and the energy of his consciousness is
limited or enhanced by the amount of prana which expands

vt
to the seven worlds or contracts to the one physical world.
Or if only two orbits are filled with prana his Being will be
limited to a dualistic world of mind and matter. The
confusions of the thought world and the physical world
cannot be understood nor controlled without getting a
vantage point in other worlds of imagination, intuition, direct
perception, etc., all of which are in turn subject to distortion
and modification by flow of prana through them.

The stilling of the flow of prana through these psycho-


physical centers of Being is as difficult as becoming an opera
singer or achieving excellence in other fields such as physics
or art. The reader of these five volumes on the " Supersensitive
Life of Man", of which Victor Beasley's is the first introduc-
tion, is encouraged to go step-by-step and persist to the end
even if the going may be intellectually or temperamentally
different. To persist until insight comes is the way of all the
creative seers and originators. Victor Beasley persisted in
personally following up all the leads he was given and now
you too may use his work to investigate deeper and further
into the Secrets of the Supersensitive Life.

Christopher Hills,
BoulderCreek
November, 1974
General Editor

vu
ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS

It is doubtful that an individual ever accomplishes anything


really alone. Even if one is without immediate, tangible
assistanceon a particular undertaking, one is at least indebted
to all of one's past experiences -- to parents, to relatives, to
friends, to enemies, to teachers, to acquaintances,to successes
and failures, to profundities and frivolities alike -- for having
conditioned one for the task of the moment. [t has been said,
in fact, that if those of us who live today can see far, then it
is because we stand up on the shoulders of all the generations
of mankind who have preceded us. So it is with the present
work, for not only does it rest upon the shoulders of past
scientific and metaphysical achievements,but is also substan-
tially fortified by numerous contemporary inputs.

Many persons have given generously of their time and of


themselves that this volume might come into being. From the
very outset, the enthusiasm, encouragement, and criticism
received from various members of my Union Graduate
School Committee, named below, have been outstandingly
supportive:
Dr. Roy P. Fairfield Core Faculty
Acharya ChristopherB. Hills, D.Sc. Adjunct Faculty
Dr. Lloyd S.N. Kunar
ll ll

Mr. Aurobindo J. Jani


iltl

Dr. Lee R. Steiner StudentPeer


Dr. Zoltan Tarczy-Hornoch
'r rl
Dr. Joan Halifax-Grof

Credit for the conceptual direction taken by this work must


be shared with an advisor, one trained in both science and
metaphysics, but who prefers to remain anonymous.

Then there are the investigators whom I interviewed for this


project, and others whose counsel and instruction I sought on
particular topics; they are listed in the bibliographic section

vilt
of this work. In every instance, I was fortunate to have
received the patient and unselfish cooperation of these
persons, and without their willingness to share, this work
would not havebeenrealizedin its presentform.

Over a period of nearly three years, the many stagesof


typing, re-typing and correcting the original manuscript saw
th unstinting efforts, aye labors of love, of three lovely
persons:my wife Sonia, and my friendsand colleaguesJanet
Naidu and Barbara Taylor. I am further indebted to several
friends and associates for proofreading the many stages
through which this volume has passed and for otherwise
assistingin its preparation.

I extend an additional note of gratitude to my wife who


yielded to my inumerablehours of domestic truancy, thus
allowing me the freedomof unmolestedtime -- without this,
this projectcould not havebeenundertaken.

Victor R. Beasley
Barbados,W.I.
August 23, 1974.

tx
PREFACE

What man does is inextricably conditioned by what man is.


The social affairs of mankind are a consequence, not an
antecedent, of man's existence as an entity of nature. Thus, it
would seem that a deeper appreciation of human social/
behavioral motivation is not possible without first gaining
fuller comprehension of how man is governed by those
natural forces to which he is subject as a creature within the
Universe's complex. Accordingly, a fundamental sentiment
which prompts the present work is that the motive forces
behind human social behavior are not fully understood or
dealt with, within the confines of many existing approaches.

The accounts presented in this volume are concerned with


the possible influence which certain radiational or "electro-
vibratory" forces might exert upon human behavior. The
term "electro-vibratory" is meant to have a generic applica-
tion. We might have substituted in its place the standard term
''electromagntism,''
but electromagnetism, as understood by
science, refers only to a defintespectrum of what is probably
an infinite range of vibrations occurring in nature. Under the
circumstances, to identify as magnetic the varied forces
mentioned in this work, would perhaps be confusing -- as
well as misleading --- when judged by scientific criteria.
Hence, with an "electro-vibratory" concept, the attempt is to
reflect an identity which is thought to be common to the
different forces, all of whose promulgation is understood to
involve the vibration, oscillation or radiation of energy, and
whose composition, whether at physical or meta-physical
levels of inquiry, is thought to entail charged electrons or
similar particles.

This, then, is a wide interdisciplinary perspective, accom-


plished by a review of some of the accepted tenets of the
physical and biological sciences,together with the presentation
of original research findings as maintained by various investi-
gators in different fields. Also included are reports of
"electro-vibratory" phenomena from the areas of metaphysics
and clairvoyance, where the detection of possible socio-
behavioral causal factors presently lies outside the defined
boundaries of either the physical or the social sciences. A
more critical view, however, suggeststhat the line of demarca-
tion between the Physical and the Esoteric is really a
question of how keenly a particular researcher perceives the
phenomenon under his investigation.

Obviously, those radiational phenomena mentioned in this


volume by no means represent the totality of such forces
which could influence human behavior. And even for those
forces which are discussed here, vast areas of research and
understanding remain to be accomplished. Therefore, the
author, governed by the limitations of time, the accessibility
of source materials, and his own understanding, has confined
this inquiry to those areasherein presented.

Thus this work attempts to be an integrative one, as reflected


in the observation of Mr. William O. Judge, Co-founder of the
Theosophical Society, that, "No science is complete which
leaves out any department of nature, whether visible or
invisible"(19, P. l).

xi
CONTENTS

Introductionto theSecondEdirton. .... iv


Introductonto theFrstEdition. ....... v
Acknowledgements. ..... viii
Preface. .....x
TheFutureof Supersensonics. ........ xv
Supersensonics and theLaw. .. xxv

PART I
THEORIES AND INVESTIGATIONS OF
ELECTRO-MAGNETIC PHENOMENA 1

INTRODUCTION ......2

ATOMICAND MOLECULARMAGNETISM. . . . . . . . . .5
Creationof the Atomic MagneticField. . . . . . . . .6
MagneticMoment and External Fields . . . .8
AtomicPrecession. ....9
MolecularMagnetism. .....11

A BIOCHEMICAL PERSPECTIVE. . . . . . .13


Biochemicaland ElectrolyticResponses.. . .. . .14
TheCellandMagnetism,. .....,19
MagnetismandEnzymes.... .....22
HealingHands .....24

ELECTROBIODYNAMICS.. ...,.,27
FrequencyandElectromagneticSpectrum ... ..28
MagneticFieldComposition ......33
Resonance. . ,.34
Harmonics. .......36
BiomagneticResonance..... .....38
Rapport. . ., ..42
TheMagnetron.. ....47
PestControl in OrganicFarming . . .52
Communication. .....52
HealingApplication ...53
East-WestFlow. ....54

xu
POLARITIES-NORTHANDSOUTH. .......59
PolarDistinctions .......60
FundamentalRays ...63
FundamentalRayDisc. ....64
ANew Look at the Earth'sPolarities . . . . . . . .67
H i l l s ' M o d e l oM
f agnetism... ....71
Medical/BiologicalApplications.... ...72
North-SouthAnimalBehavior. ....74
SomaticPolarities ...78

GEOMAGNETISM AND BTOLOGICAL SYSTEMS . . .85


GeomagneticTrendsin BiologicalEvolution . . . .86
BiologicalSensitivityto GeomagneticForces . . . . . . . .91
MagnetismandAging ......99

AUTONOMIC NERVOUS SYSTEM AND MAGNETISM. . . .103


BrainResponses. ......104
BrainRhythms.. ...109
NeuralStimulationsDevices .....1I4

BIOCLIMATOLOGY AND IONOTHERAPY


T h e E f f e c t s oAf i r I o n s . . ......117
StaticFields . .Il9
AlternatingFields .......121
SphericPulses ....122
Ions in the Environment. . .123
IonsandHumanBiology. ......126
IonizingWinds. ....130
HumanWeatherSensitivity .....,132
NegativeIonTherapy.... ....134
Sulman'slonizationTreatment .......l39
ControllingDisease .....140
AlphaWaves ......142

S U M M A R Y A N D D I S C U S S I O N O F P A R T I. . . . , , , 1 4 7

xut
PART II
DIMENSIONS OF HUMAN BEHAVIORAL FIELDS
PHYSICAL AND META.PHYSICAL 16I

INTRODUCTION ,..162
SUBTLEENERGIES .....165
Thel-Field ...166
RadionicEnergy ...172
Radiesthesia.... ...179
Massy'sLawsofRadiesthesia,... .....181
Supersensonics.. ...185
CHAKRAENERGIES .....19I
TheEnergies... ...192
Chakrasand AssociatedBiological/BehaviorSystems.197
Tie-inMechanisms..... ...202
CHAKRASOCIALMANIFESTATIONS .....,207
The Chakrasand Time Perception. . . . . .208
SacralChakra . ., . ..210
SpleenChakra. . . ., .210 PsychologicalPersona-
SolarChakra.......2ll lityTypes ....218
HeartChakra.. . . . . .2Il SensationType . . . . .219
ThroatChakra.. . . . .212 ThinkingType. . . . . .220
Brow Chakra. . . . . . .2t2 FeelingType. . . . . . .222
Crown Chakra. . . . . .213 IntuitiveType. . . . . .223
ESOTERIC ENERGIES OF GROUP PHENOMENA. . . . . . . .227
A Scientific View of Group Phenomena . . . . . .228
Group Mind. . .229
Esoteric Radiationsof Nations . .233
The Group ConsciousnessExperiment . . . ., . .237
CreativeConflict . .240
S U M M A R Y D I S C U S S I O N O F P A R T T.I. . ...243
APPENDIX: APERSONALPILGRIMAGE ....251
WrittenMaterial ....255
Interviews,Conversationsand Correspondence.. . . . .257
Works and SourcesCited. . .264
TapeRecordedlnterviews... ....266
INDEX ,267-270
THE FUTURE OF SUPERSENSONICS

ADDITION TO THE SECOND EDITION

Dr. Victor Beasley is returningto the University of the Trees


wherehe will be establishinga departmentfor the processingof
homeopathicremedies to develop new methodsof diagnosing
for chiropractorsand medical researchersinvestigatingthe new
fields of bioplasm4 psychotronics, and the umbrella concept
which includes all of this, called "Supersensonics" by
Christopher Hills, founder of the University of the Trees.

The concept of homeopathy was developed by Dr. C. S.


Hahnemann, a medical genius who discovered the medical
equivalentof what is called in folk wisdom "the hair of the dog
that bit you". More scientifically speaking this means that a
substanceor tincturewill cure or heal in homeopathicquantities
what causes the same condition in allopathiC quantities. In
plain languagethis means that what poisons you, for example
snake bite venom, can be so potentizedthat it can heal you of
snake bite. Another way of saying this is that if you get drunk
from too much alcohol or become an addict of Jamaican rum, a
very extraordinary weak homeopathic quantity of the same
alcohol could set you on the road to sobriety. The next step
obviously proceedsto the logical questionof how much of the
original matter,or atomsor molecules of matter,are actually in
the homeopathic dose. Most people do not understandwhen
they take a homeopathic remedy that there is absolutely no
matter involved, because the quantities infused into the final
remedy are infinitesimally small, that they are smaller than
atoms themselves.This representssuch a big hurdle for atomic

* A|lopathyisthemethodotreatingdiseasebytheuseosubstancesproducingeffectsdierent
from those othe disease1reatedas opposedto HomeopalhyWhichusesagentsWhichproduce
the same svmotoms.
physicists, who have found nothing smaller than atoms or parts
of atomsin nature,that they cannot believe it to be true,for it is
so staggeringto man's imagination.

After studying Supersensonicswith Dr. Hills, Dr. Beasley


went to England with the intention of becoming a homeopath
and naturopath after receiving his doctorate from the Union
Graduate School founded by Antioch College in Ohio. In
England he met up with Malcolm Rae, who had developed
radionic instrumentswhich could potentizewater or homeopa-
thic pills with the same vibration as an original homeopathic
substance merely by using a geometric pattern of angles
inscribed on a card and inserted in a radionic instumenl Dr.
Beasley practiced for one year before realizing that this was an
absolute proof of Christopher Hill's assertion that Supersen-
sonic energiescould be communicatedalongthe lines of ink on
paper or from any photo, symbol, or geometric pattern as
proclaimed in his book ,Szpersensonics written three years
before,to which Dr. Beasley himself had written the introduc-
tion, not realizing he was an unwitting tool in the most mind-
blowing reazation, that no matter whatsoeveris required to
create the "hair of the dog' or the vibration of healing upon
which homeopathyworks. Christopher Hills has 4lways said
that homeopathyis uselessunless you have the exact counter-
vibration of the situationyou are attemptingtocure andthatthe
difficulty of gettingmedical doctors generally to spendenough
time to figure out the tuning of this exact vibration is the reason
why homeopathyhas never been popular among doctors who
must getthroughat leasttwo patientsan hour in orderto support
their overheads for offices, equipment nurses, technical
support computer leases, etc., etc. Hence the principles of
homeopathy have been clouded by confusion, opposition,
deliberate condemnaon and unwarrantedskepticism.

Another major problem is in the preparationof remedies.In


the modern world, time is of the essence.Who has the time to
pound a remedy and vibrate it 10,000 times? Even after ten
xvi
your amgetstired and even if you do itby machine,which has
been the case for the last fifty years, it still takes 10,000 times
five minutes to make a 10M remedy;plus who can guarantee
that a profit conscious commercial firm will not take short cuts
in an agewherepeopleare paid by the hour?Consequentlythere
are almost no homeopathic supply companies today that are
absolutely reliable. This is often the reason why scientists
cannot replicate the results of homeopathicdoctors who, when
they have the exact counter-vibrationin a remedy, are able to
get absolutely fantastic results. Nearly every expert homeopa-
thic doctorhas beenatotal skepticuntilhe hit a casein which he
discoveredthe exact correct remedyin which a healingoccured
if not within hours, within minutes. The whole difficulty so far
has been to get the exact remedy, and this has caused
homeopathyto fall into disrepute.

Now modernscience,with computersand crystal ball technol-


ogy, is able to amplify very small potentialswhich far outdo the
dreams of Dr. Hahnemann and make him seem like a pigny
compared to the exact resonanceswhich can be achieved by
modern science. Undoubtedly, homeopathy as conceived by
Dr. Hahnemann is primitive, but it was an original insight like
Newton's theory of gravity. But even Newton's theory needed
an Einstein to come along 200 years later to link light and
gravity into such minute, exact calculations that man could
predict the bendingof light rays as they flew past the sun from
differentstas,as proved in 19 17. Now, in l97 7, exactly sixty
years later, a prediction made by the originator of Supersen-
sonics, Christopher Hills, has been proved true by Malcolm
Rae's equipment testedover four years by 2,000 practitioners,
that the geometric patterns predicted by Christopher Hills
actually do inluenceatomic ionization which in turn influences
the human body, the human emotions, the human mind and
even the human spirit on different levels of function

xvu
Who knows whetherthis is not what Christ himselfwas talking
about and the very means by which he established such
powerful resonances with an afflicted condition at the spiritual
level that instant healingsbecame possible with certain people
who were open to receive it? This principle of super sonic
resonance on different levels of vibration is very well estab
lished in music, in atomic physics and in chemistry, but it had
not been established at the spiritual level of being until
Christopher Hills wrote his theory of Nuclear Evolution in
1968 and expanded it ten years later with his book on the
discovery of the rainbow body. For the reader to get some
inkling of what the new science of Supersensonicsmeans in
terms of vibration perceived and absorbedby the unconscious
mind of a human being and to understandthe profound effects
obtainable by exact resonances and patterns and energies, a
researcherwould have to study not only the book Supersen-
sonics, written in 1975, but also tJlre
I Ching and its links with
rotating systems such as a biologically operated pendulum
which is merely the externalization of the internal tension
existing within a human being. These mental tensions are the
basis of homeopathy and the Chines e1 Cft i ng. They both utilize
values which phaseinto the probability of vibrational compata-
bility with each personwho exists in life in a specific situationat
a specific time.

Compatibility with this situation or being out of tune with it


createsthe harmony or disharmony in the living organismswe
call "cells". When thev are ill at ease we have a situationcalled
dis-ease.

The failure of homeopathyto spread as a science and lack of


interest from the public in the homeopathic laws of similars,
scientifically referred to as the laws of resonance, can be
attributedto the public disbelief that such small quantities of

xvut
matter can influence the psyche of a person Sir James Jeans
describedthe physical universeas more like the expressionof a
great mind than like a material thing If only he had known of
homeopathy, radionics, psychotronics and ultimately Super-
sensonics,he would be able to dance on his own grave,instead
of turningin it at the routemodernphysics has taken.Likewise,
Albert Einstein must have turned in his gravemany times over
the mental gymnastics and verbal ingenuity of quantum
physicists who caused him to say that God does not play dice
with the universe.His words may now be justified in the ready
acceptanceof the entitiesknown as black holes and white holes
which he called the ONE and which modern quantum
physicists call a singularity. We should mention that this
singularity which the quantum physicists talk about dissolves
the whole dance of particles and their probability into one
cosmic eggyolk called a plasma-The density of this plasma at
the beginningof time at the birth of the universewe live in may
be likened to a homeopathic solutiorUbeginningwith the first
essence or substanceor tincture of the oiginal nucleus. The
subsequent expansion of the universe can be likened to the
successive subsequentsuccussions,triturations,dilutions and
vibrations with the thinning out of this original nucleus in the
form of plasma which becomesmatterthroughbeing attenuated
or diluted throughoutthe whole of space.To get an idea which
is beyond any imagination of how much physical matter is
smeared out through the whole of space through the big bang
Isometimescalled an implosion, dependingwhetheryou believe
the universeis expandingor contracting] a scientistmerely has
to look at the way the resonanceof a homeopathicremedy is
establishedwith the disharmony it is designedto cure or the
situation it is meant to phase in with.

To give the reader an idea of how much matter there is in a


homeopathicremedy, perhapswe should begin with the James
Jeans idea of the number of electrons in one's little toe. If we

xtx
mathematicallycalculatedthe numberof electronsin one's little
toe and imagineeach one blown up to the size of a grain of sand
then therewould be enoughelectronsto bury.theearthfour feet
deep in sand over its entire surface.This calculation may give a
useful analogy to convey the size of an electron but it does
nothing to convey the amount of matter in a homeopathic
remedy. Mathematically speaking every time a homeopathic
tincture or essence is potentized or vibrate{ two naughts are
added" so that even in the preparation of a low potency 6X
remedy, one has already diluted the substance by
1,000,000,000,000 parts. This means that if one has a
single physical atorn, a homeopathic atom is one thousard
billion times as small in the potency of 6X. Atomic physim,
however,merely declaresthat an electronis 1835 times smaller
than a proton and therefore compared to a thousand billion
times smalf the electron is a huge universe, even though the
electronsin our little toe would cover the earthfour feetdeep in
sand if each one wereblown up to the size of a grain of sand.Let
us now give an example and look at a homeopathicsubstance
made from the tincture which we would call silver chloride
which is a light sensitivecrystal which we use on every negative
and positive when we take a photograptr"These tiny crystals,
presentin the negativesand positives which we use every day in
our cameras,record the sensitiveaction of light on matter.If we
were to potentizesilver chloride homeopathically,the following
processmixing 99 parts of alcohol with I part of silver chloride
would take place:one molecule of silver chloride,made up of an
atom of silver and an atom of chlorine (AgCD is mixed with 99
parts of alcohol and vibratedbetweentriturations,meaningthat
the number of naughtsthat are added betweeneach dilution is
two. Thus in thetable below,the tincturedilutedwith 99 partsof
alcohol: I X. The abovesubstanceI X diluted with 99 parts of
alcohol : 2X, adding two naughts to the previous two naughts,
making four naughts or 10,000 parts in a2X potency. The

xx
following is listed for convenienceof our visudising the actual
process of diluon

Tincture * 99 parts of alcohol: lX add two naughts 00


lX + 99 parts of alcohol : ZXadd two naughts 0000
2X + 99 parts of alcohol : 3X add two naughts 000000
3X + 99 parts ofalcohol :4Xadd two naughts 00000000
4X + gg parts of alcohol : 5X add two naughts 0000000000
5X +99 parts of alcohol : 6Xadd two naughts 000000000000

xxt
adding twelve naughts to the original physical substance
potentised.We can see from the above that any homeopathic
substanceof 6X is infinitely smaller than the I 8 35 th part of an
atom or an electron, since it is smaller by 8 decimal places.
The homeopathicatomis therefore1000 billionths smallerthan
a physical atorn No scientisthas ever discovereda particle that
small and probably never will. To progressfurtherbeyond the
realm of fantasy may we say that 6X is a low potency in
homeopathic treatment or "Supersensonic" terms, since the
potencycan be increasedwith every numberfrom6Xby adding
two naughts-to 7X 8X, 9X . . . l2X, etc. until we come to
lOM which is 10,000 such operations presuming of course,
that modern pharmacists have the patience to sit on their
bottomsand vibrate anything10,000 times merely to add more
naughtsto a non-existentatom.Frankly it is very diffrcultto get
evenhomeopathicfanaticsto do this withouttaking shortcuts.If
you have ever signed100 travellerschecksyou will know what I
am talking aboul To getthe picture of the physical limitation of
what we are talking about sit down now and sign your name
every secondfor 1000 times, and if you are not bored continue
signingfor 10,000 times. Then you will know what lOM really
is. The sages used to say that if you write out a mantrum
100,000 times and throw it each time in a river, the potency of
the mind would be suflicient to bring about what you wrote.
Therefore10M (10,000X)is a small potencycomparedto the
mental vibration of a mantrum done 100,000 times.
Christopher Hills once travelled to the site of the Bo tree
underwhich Buddha becameenlightened"intendingto meditate
there. In the surroundingmonastery he watched the Buddhist
monks practicing their traditional discipline of 100,000 press-
ups or up and down vibrations in the form of physical
prostrationsof the body. Such physical actionsin the attemptto
get enlightenedappearedto Hills to be mechanical and ineffec-
tive since each prostrationwas done at the samepotency,unless

xxu
there was in the act itself, some quantity which intensifiedthe
human mind in a homeopathic marnermaking the physical
stimulus into a mental force. In meditatingunder the tree, he
had an unusual experienceand heard in his Bodhi tree centreof
the brain the "Mega Nadam". It may not be withoutconnection
that the spiritual forcefield generatedat this particular spot by
hundredsof monks prostratingand each doing 100,000 press-
ups generated a forcefield resonant with spiritual levels of
consciousness which ionised the cerebral-spinalfluids of the
brain and enabledhim to hear this cosmic soundoften referred
to by the ancientrishis as the cosmic soundor the" word" of the
universalONE. The sameinternal experienceof this soundwas
referredto by Jesus when he was initiated by the cosmic one. In
Matthew: 3, v. 17 this event was experiencedby Christ as the
heavensopeningup when he was baptisedby John the Baptisl
which startedhim off on his messianic mission

The potency of consciousness,rarified 100,000 times on the


spiritual level or intensified100,000 times(dependingon which
point you are looking from) is the starting point of Nuclear
Evolutiorl the process which Christopher Hills describes as a
black hole or a white hole in consciousness.This is the nuclear
self in which a seed thought can be placed in the white hot
intensityof one's ultimatetotal cosmic connection.It was on the
possibility of manifestingthis throughthe science of Supersen-
sonics that the new discoveries of geometric patterns which
could potentise ordinary water and homeopathic sugar pills
without any material substanceconvinced Dr. Victor Beasley
to leave his studiesof anatomy,naturopathy,manipulationsof
bones and muscles,diet"etc. to undertakethe developmentof a
special healing deparrrentof the University of the Trees. His
intention is to bring the devices and instrumentsof Supersen-
sonics first to the leading vanguard of naturopathic doctors,
chiropractors,wholistic healers,and new generationof medical
homeopathic doctors and ultimately, through thern, to the

xxul
general public in the crystal ball technology which utilises
computersto use thelCft ing andtapthe powersof themind and
moderntheoriesof probability, throughestablishingresonance
with the patternsin nature with which our subconsciousmind
programs our body and our brain. The book you are about to
read in its second printing was written before Dr. Beasley's
return to develop his departmentat the University of the Trees
and was publishedas Volume I of a whole seriesof books which
setout thebackgroundresearchesforpractitionersof Supersen-
sonics by ChristopherHills andhis studentsat the University of
the Trees. Therefore this book is being republished and
expandedwith the able assistanceof Dr. Robert Massy, PhD.,
who, working as a physicist" has updated and revised the
original edition to conform with the latest theories and modern
speculations.This additionto the secondedition is writtenwith
the knowledgethat within the next few years Supersensonics
and Nuclear Evolution will become entirely validated by
computers, physics and psychology. The instruments which
will enablethe generalpublic to participatein this validation are
already being developed at the University of the Trees and a
detailed catalog of tools and researctr,at a small cost to cover
printing, postage and handling, aeavailable to anyone who
wishes to participate.

The Publishers

xxtv
Publisher's Note

SUPERSENSONICS AND THE LAW


Instntctions on the setting up
ofa healing practce

The words Psychotronics,Radionics and Radiesthesiamean nothingto thosewho are


not familiar with the vast amount of research done in recent years on the rational
explanation of the operation of mental forces. Supersensonics,which is an umbrella
term coined by Christopher Hills to include all types of humanbiological sensitivityto
radiations of all kinds, deals with the spiritual and mental faculties which sense and
report nonphysical signalsto the brain from any source,whetherliving inert or divine.
For centuriesspecial examplesof their sensitivityhave been known,as waterdivining
the homing instinct of pigeons and as direction-flrndingof mosquitoesand butterflies.
However, it is not well known that throughoutnature, from the sensitive skin of the
amoeba to the afTinityof one atom for another,the subtle radiations betweenobjects and
organismscan be detectedwith the instrumentsof Supersensonicsand Psychotronics.
The questionnaturally follows- how can thesebe usedto help peoplewho are sick, both
mentally and physically withoutrunningafoul of the law which restrictsall healingand
diagnosisto peoplewho are qualified in the medical professions?The answeris simple.
We must not pretend that our fledgling new science is in any way dealing with the
normal methods of healing and at the same time try to prevent exploitation of sick
peopleby thosewho could use thesenew tools for fraud It is not for us to judgewhether
the medical professionitself is riddled with fraud and exploitationof medical ignorance
or to say whetherwholistic medicine is the better.Each personmust think for himself.

The health divining methods of Supersensonicsuse instruments which enable a


doctor, homeopath*or a natural healer to detect the most favorable remedy and
treatrnentfor optimum health. Under the Californialaw a homeopathor wholistic
practitionermust practiceundercertainconditions.Clients of healersmustbe informed
ifthe operatoris not a physician andthe healersmust not provide servicesthat the legal
statutesreserve only to physicians. A licensed medical practice providing medical
service is recogrized in law as the diagrosis or treatmentof disease,ailment, injury or
pathological conditions.Therefore"Supersensonic"equipmentfor diagnosiscan only
be used on otherpeopleby licenseddoctorsas an aid in their medical diagnosisand not
as their sole meansof treatmenLFor nonmedicalpeopleto use the equipmentlegally it

*Homeopathy- a concept
developedby Dr. C. S. Hahnemannwho discoveredthe medicalequivalentof
what is cal|ed in o|kWisdom,,thehair of the dog that bil you'..Scientifica||y speakingthis means that a
s u b s t a n c eo r t i n c t u r ew i l l c u r e o r h e a l i n h o m e o p a t h i cq u a n t i t i e tsh e c o n d i t i o ni t c a u s e si n a l l o p a t h i c
quantities.
mustbe used as a detectorofcorrect healthpatternsratherthanusedto detectdiseaseor
ailments. Furthermore, people settingup a wholistic healing service with Supersen-
sonic equipmentmustmake legal agreementswith their clients anddefinehow their role
is distinct from medical doctors and how it ls a health practice.

Such an agreementrecognizes the possibility of a health service that is basically


differentfrom a medical practice.It acceptsthe use ofthe contractas a viable way that
the consentingparties can clarify their roles and responsibilitiesunder the law and
establish a relationship of healer and clienL

A practitioner utilizing a "wholistic" or "natural" approachwith the Supersensonic


health divining methods cannot use the reductionistmethodologythat diagnosesor
treatsdisease.Thus the questionof legality for nonlicensedhealth practitionersis not
dependenton the method they use. Whether the detectionby Supersensonicdvining
methodsis truly wholistic or still diagrostic or reductionistis dependentupon the way
providers of health do their method. The difference between medical methods of
diagnosis and the natural biofeedbackinstrumentof Supersensonicsarises out oftheir
different usage of human faculties as follows:
1. Supersensonics method uses the unconscious mind to detect psychic physical
energiesand to get a neurophysicalresponsethroughdivining the real causes.It
also uses the ability of the nervous system to detect the vibrational pattems of
suitable remedies.This is used togetherwith the rational faculty to check out
results by using empirical methods and experimentsin order to arrive at the
wholistic method.
2. The reductionist method uses only logical analysis and experimentand treatsa
particular effect with a specific countereffect without regard to the whole.
Healers using the Supersensonicinstruments should clearly understandthe
differenceifthey wish to practice a health service.
The reductionistmethodis to understandwhole systemsby observingthe actions of
their parts.Modem medical practiceusesthis approachand its treatmentsarebasedon
diagnosiswhich is dehnedas "the recogritionof diseasefrom its symptoms".Wholistic
methodsdo not necessarilycarefully define a specific disease condition. Insteadthey
try to nurturea person'sown naturalhealingpowersso that they can setpsychophysical
forces in motion which enable him to heal himself no matter what specihc disease a
personis said to have.The wholistic approachis to deal with " Medicine for the whole
prson'' and not for the parts.Thereforea wholistic health serviceoffersindividualized
treatmentthat will build the indidual's own natural constitutionso that healingforces
can deal with the manifested conditions that are causing the health problern

All this has been testedin the Califomia courts in the case of Dana Ullman versusthe
State. Dana was arrested for practicing medicine without a license' The oaklan
Piedmont Municipal Court judge and the District Attomey agreedto a settlement
offered by Ullman's attorney that allows his homeopathicpractice under the above

xxvt
describedconditions of the statutorylaws. Following the dismissal of Ullman's case,
the press gave the mistakenimpressionto the public that a precedenthad been set for
recogrizing the legality of wholistic practices. The local medical society expressed
concern to the Oaklan&Piedmont district attorney'soffrce,which tried to back out of
thedismissal agreementand advisedUllman's attorneythatit would refile chargesif the
Medical Board broughta new caseon the samefacts.It is importantfor practitionersto
understand the implications of this case if they are dealing with wholistic health
practices and giving service to others.Ofcourse thereis no law which can preventany
one from treatinghimself by any methodhe seesfit, but healingothersand diagrosis of
others' illness is not permitted except by licensed doctors. Furthermore the Ullman
case,as a questionofsettinga precedent is in no way bindingon othercourts.This case
may be considered in deciding future cases where the practitioner and the client
considered defining their relationshipby means of specific agreement.

The Ullman case simply recognized that a nonmedical health practice could be
definedby a contracl On October llth,197'l an official of the fraud division testified
before the state Assembly Health committee about the potential for "consumer
exploitation" in the wholistic healttr field. Offrcials have been particularly vigilant
concerning radionic instruments which simulate or appear to work like electronic
instruments but which have no scientifically recognizable healing energy in their
circuits.

The circuits and diagramsof Supersensonicsdo not claim to use electronic energies
and the principles are clearly setout in the608- pagebookSupersensoru'cs publishedin
1975, now beingusedby severalmedicaldoctorsas well as wholistic healersas an aid in
their healingpractice by nonreductionistmethods.The problem with officials, medical
boards and health committeesis that there is an absence of verifiable standardsof
training knowledge,educationand skill University of the Trees has set out to correct
this situation and offers courses and degreesin the study ofthe agentresponsiblefor
wholistic healing-consciousness. It is authorized by the state to issue degreesafter
satisfactorystandardsoftraining have beenobserved These standardsare so high that
tley are more thantheusual universityrequiremenl In this way Supersensonicswill not
and cannot be dismissed by those uneducatedin its practices and methods. These
methodshave been set up as verifiable independentlyof the usual "authorities" which
cannot determine the validity of areas they know nothing aboul

The Federal Trade Commission was recently petitionedrequestingthe regulationof


the "personal growth" industry, complaining that there were no valid standardsby
which to objectively measurea given program. The petition asked the State Health
committee to consider licensing and certifuingof practitioners.The university of the
Trees welcomes this approach in an area where there is little backgroundmaterial or
experienceof Supersensonicenergiesamongmedical people,officials of StateBoards

xxvu
anduniversitiesgenerally'The University ofthe Trees Press endeavorsto pubshbasic
works and referencetexts on methods of practice and the scientific investigationof
wholistic energies.It agreesthat the field is wide open for deception and consumer
exploitationand thereforeinvitesall objectivecriticism and successwith Supersensonic
instrumentsto be reportedfor publication,so thatauthoritieshave somethingmoreto go
on than their own prejudicesor narrow specialist fields which have no knowledgeof
consciousnessresearchor any ofthe parametersofdivining practices.The empirical
observation and tsting of experiences and seeing that a thing works must also be
buttressedwith the rational traditionoflogical analysis and explanationofphenomena-
In modem science today the two systemsof acquiring knowledgeare often opposing
each other. One says, "I know it works but I don't know how it works," and the other
traditionalists say "It must be consistentwith what we have proved already."

Supersensonicsattemptsto provide a body of knowledge at every level of skillful


validation, so that people can test the result for themselvesand are not dependenton
experts.Supersensonicskills are availableto anyonejust as consciousnessis available
to everyone. However, people use their consciousness differently and often with
differentquality of skills and it is this we attemptto validate,notthe knowledgeitself or
the method of acquiring the knowledge. It recognizes many ways of acquiring
knowledge in unorthodox ways and gives mankind a second way of validating its
authenticity.Hence Supersensonicsis even more scientific than current concepts of
objectivity and we publicly repudiatethose limited reductionist methods which are
claimedto be absolutelyobjective,whenthey are nol Many haveprovedto be basedon
false assumptionsabout healtll nature and the workings of the human mind.

Supersensonicswould welcome a test case in any court as to the effrcacyof divining


methods,where we can bring hundredsof witnessesto prove that it works, along with
our own rational tests and theories as to how it works. We can also explain why it
sometimes does not work, just as a scientific medicine in some cases does not work
either.
People who set up a health practice should be preparedto standup to the authorities
and the courts to defendthe practice ofwholistic remediesand results,but they should
not make excessiveclaims and then expect sympathy from those who consider all the
forces in society as a whole.If we are truly wholistic we must understandthe reasoning
of medical doctors and their well-meaningoppositionto unqualified,and(in their eyes)
untestedpractices.We must documentour successesand show that we are capable of
reasoning. We must understandthat our laws governing the health profession are
writtenby rationalistsand not relatedto empirical criteria These laws do not apply to
wholistic practices but since our social attitudes are also govemed by rationalist
thinking, wholistic methods such as Supersensonicsare presumed by offrcials and
doctors to be an alternative form of treatmentfor pattrological conditions and therefore
aeseen as requiringlicenses accordingto existing statutes.This kind of thinking is a

xxvul
misapplicationof rationalistmethodologybecausea wholistic method,thoughit can be
validated, cannot be clearly defined by laws or authorities.

Unless wholistic practitionerstake action to define and documenttheir own work the
dangeris that medicaljudgmentsand rationalizationswill judge it for them, and these
authorities will be allowed to govern the growth and developmentof the wholistic
professions.

The primary vehicle for making a new conceptualframeworkfor health servicesand


healthpracticesis theobtainingofdegreesofexcellence in thepublicaon ofknowledge
of the skills nvolvedand in the making of private agreementsand contractsregarding
those skills. The University of the Trees is one of the hrst institutionsto offerdegreesin
this wide-openflreldof human enquiry which incorporatesboth religion and science,
philosophy and practice. Its main textbooks are Supersensonics arLdNuclear
Evolution- Discovery of the Rainbow Body. These texts provide enoughbackground
evidencefor you to become a wholistic healer providing you follow the legal practice
outlined above in some form of contracl

The use of Supersensonic equipment for divining the homeopathic potency of


remediesand for potentizingtheseremediesis perfectly legal in healing ourself and if
thereis no pretense!o practicemedicineas definedwithin the law, is also perfectlylegal
for helping others. Its use in treatmentof crops is now being researchedand if all
psychotronicinstrumentscan be offeredas researchtools ratherthan as substitutesfor
the established traditional professions there can then be no question of fraud or
deception especially if all health relationshipsare based upon contractswhich dehne
the roles and responsibilitesof each party.

Finally we can assertthat all the wholistic health movementsencouragepeople to be


responsiblefor their own healttl Yet this does no/ mean that people should only try to
heal themselvesand avoid going to a health practitioner.It means more clearly that
peopleshouldlook within for thecauseandinto all the ways they can help themselves.It
meansthey shouldgo to a healthpractitionerro help them help themselves.In this way
Supersensonicsworks as an aid to e practitionerand does not claim to be any better
than the operator.This is true of any other equipmentfrom a computerto a motor car.

These instructionsto doctors,homeopathsand chiropractorsand lay peopledesiring


to set up a healing practice are given so that you can know the law in respectto these
nontraditionalmethods.

We are working with many people to set up psychotronic shops and distributorships
for our tools and instrumentsand can supply an entire rangeofbooks and stock on a
franchise basis. We also offer our franchisedistributorsour full rangeon a returnable
basis should they find that they get stuck with inventory.

xxtx
PART I
THEORIES AND INVESTIGATIONS OF
ELECTRO-MAGNETIC PHENOMENA

"And the vast reaches of celestial space stretched


out in ininite blackness. No thing was about' Even
the embryonic primordial gases adumbrating the
advent of earth, had not yet coalesced. And the
inhabitants of the earth -- consciousness ranging
from mineral to man -- were yet mere slndows of
a future ar distant.

Then after eons of nurturing evolution, millenia of


living creations spawned, condensed, and bound
together by cosmic forces -- homo-sapiens evolved.
Now atom, man, and planet all obediently adhered
to the myriad manifestations of magnetism playing
upon and throughout the still fledgling globe.
From outside man himself into his innermost core,
came vital vibratory instructions -- to sleep - to
breathe - to savor his surroundings in many
wonderul ways. Ever so subtly and sub-consciously
was the reluctant homo-sapiens prodded along an
evolutionary path towards something even grander
than himself."

(v.R.B.)
INTRODUCTION The physical dimension of the human body is a mass of
atomic substance,intricately designed and regulated, delicate-
ly balanced with environmental forces, and receiving its
ultimate animation from sources vet bevond full scientific
scrutiny.

Part I is, to a large extent, reflective of the approach used


throughout tfus work, which is more eclectic than compre-
hensive. The present section is partly a review of generally
accepted scientific knowledge regarding magnetism, as under-
s'tood by the fields of chemistry, physics, and biology;it also
deals with selected experimental and theoretical findings
associated with certain electro-vibratory systems which,
apparently, can alter and/or goven behavior patterns in
biological systems, particularly man's.

The writer does not make the claim that everything presented
on the following pages is unequivocally accurate and should,
therefore, be accepted without proper analysis. To the
contrary, inconsistencies between the works of different
researchers,and fallacy of interpretation can occur. And it is
thus in the interest of scientific decorum that the reader is
reminded that there are presented some research findings
which have been reported by only one investigator, which
have not been repeated, nor received the general approbation
of the scientific community.

Nevertheless, deviations from the scientific norm may, in


fact, be a prelude to redefining the known boundaries of
scientific inquiry. In any event, the contents of the succeed-
ing pages are offered as objectively as possible, within the
spirit of the perennial human quest towards fuller compre-
hension of nature's forces.
I

ATOMIC AND MOLECULAR


MAGNETISM
ATOMIC AND MOLECULAR MAGNETISM
lH"
I
I

t:l
l--.

I
I
I
I
I t,
I
f" I
..1
I /
I I
rl
I
fr

H'.,.
s sum of the spins L total orbital momentum
J total angularmomentum total spin magneticmoment
/s

f.i total orbital magneticmoment


resultantmagneticf ield
jtt total magneticmoment
CREATION OF THE ATOMIC All forms of matter have atoms as basic building units, and
MAGNETIC FIELD there are at least 92 kinds of atoms which naturally occur in
nature. The essential composition of an atom is: a positively
charged nucleus, containing protons and neutrons, and
negatively charged electrons, orbiting the nucleus. Funda-
mental to the generation of atomic magnetism is the orbital
movement of negatively charged electrons around a positively
charged nucleus. The relative movement of dissimilar charges
constitutes a flow of electrical currents, which, in turn,
produces a magnetic field. Electricity and magnetism are very
closely related. In fact, they seem to be different aspects of a
single phenomenon -- hence the terms, "Electromagnetism".
Magnetism, then, becomes a corollary to the movement of
charges, wherever such movement occurs. The magnetic field
itself is often described as a field of influence, (attractive or
repelling), surrounding the flow of electricity, such that if the
field were diagrammed, it would be seen surrounding the
current flow and at right angles to it.

*p:
THE MAGNETIC FIELD
Thus, it is seen that electron movement around the nucleus
produces electrical flow, which, in turn, produces magnetism.
But this is only one source of magnetism in the atom.

In addition to their orbital movement, the electrons also spin


on their axis, thereby creating yet another magnetic field.
And to a lesser extent, the protons and neutrons inside the
'4.nelectron moving in a circular orbit is eqvalent to a
nucleus have an intrinsic rotation which results in giving the
circular loop of wire with the cunent flowing in the oppo
site diredion to the electrcn.
nucleus. a certain magnetism, although it is considerably
smaller in strength than that created by the electron move-
ment.* It is the combination of all these internal properties
that give the atom its overall magnetic moment.

A spinning electron. Any small piece of the electron moves


in a circular orbit and produces a magnetic field like a
current flowing in a circular loop.

*lt
has been shown that the magneticmoment of the nucleus of an
atom is about 2,000 times weaker than that of the whole atom. (6).
MAGNETIC MOMENT & In physics, the term "Magnetic Moment" is used to identify
EXTERNAL FIELDS the presence of a magnetic field associated with a given body,
and to refer to the strength and direction of that magnetic
field. When applied to the atom, magnetic moment relates to
the overall character of the magnetic field of the atom. The
atom's magnetic moment results primarily from the combina-
tion of the orbital and spin movements of the electrons. If,
however, the orbital and spin movements are viewed separate-
ly, each is seen to have a magnetic moment as distinct from
the other, though it is the vector sum of their respective
fields that give the atom its overall magnetic character.
Arising out of this interaction between orbital and spin
magnetic moments is what is called the "spin-orbital coupling"
(l, P. 16). This relates to an internal splitting of energy levels
and further contributes to the internal cohesion of the atoms'
structure. It is worthwhile to note that virtually all atoms
comprising matter -- whether organic or inert -- are consi-
dered to have a magnetic moment. Any system or body
which is the source of a magnetic field is said to have a
magnetic moment. Obviously, the magnetic field inherent in
the atom and created by its own natural motion does not
exist by itself in isolation from other external fields. Not
infrequently, an atom is exposed to magnetic fields stronger
than its own. If an external magnetic field of a strength
considerably greater than that of the atom's internal field is
applied the result is to destroy the spin-orbital coupling
mentioned above. In this instance, the dominant effect would
become that of the stronger external field. The exact external
field strength necessary to destroy the spin-orbital coupling
seems to vary, depending on which element of matter is being
acted upon. The inference drawn from the interaction of the
atom's spin-orbital coupling with an external magnetic field is
that under such conditions an alteration in the normal energy
level of atoms (and of molecules) occurs, and that in certain
instances this can lead to a considerable modification of
established atomic and molecular processes ( I , P. I 6).
Dr. Madeline F. Barnothy indicates that external magnetic
fields can affect the nuclei of atoms. She points out that a
field external to the atom may affect the spin orientation of
protons within the nucleus. Such an external field can have
the effect of acceleratingor retarding proton activity ( I , P. 83).

ATOMIC PRECESSION Two other concepts merit review within the present context
of external magnetic field influence upon atoms. They are:
"Preces'sionand resonancer" and are seen to bear an intrinsic,
Applied even causal relationship to each other. Precession is said to
occur when an applied magnetic field acts upon the magnetic
field of the electron, (or upon the magnetic field of any
body), altering the direction of movement of the field belong-
ing to the electron. The usual result is to give the electron's
field a kind of conical motion around the applied field.
Thus, the field of the electron is said to precess around
the applied field. Precession occurs with the spin as well
as the orbital motion of the electron. There is also precession
associated with the nucleus. With the various precessional
effects of an applied ield upon an atom, the result is a
complicated relationship between competing forces: the
applied field, the spn and orbital fields of the electrons, and
the nucleus. These interactions are further complicated by the
many billions of atoms when matter is considered in bulk.

Full Vector Model


of Precession

The magneticfield of a bar magnet


showingonly five spinningelectrons.
The rate of precession will vary, depending on the character-
istics of both the applied magnetic field and the subject
magnetic field. A varying applied magnetic field means that
the rate of precession will also vary. It turns out that the
earth's magnetic field (discussed in later pages) gives rise to
precession in all atoms comprising all matter upon the surface
of the earth. Thus, the picture that emergesis one of preces-
sion as the norm for all atoms, a stable condition for all
terrestrial matter, under the constant influence of the earth's
magnetic field.
The motion of the atom with its nucleus and orbiting
and spinning electrons precessing around a magnetic field is
repeated in nature on the macroscopic scale in the solar
system with its orbiting of spinning planets all precessingas
part of the Milky Way around some variable point in space.
Micro and macro mirror each other.

Spring
(March2l) y

g Fatl
(SePt.22)

Resonance in an atom occurs when the frequency of


precession of the field of the nucleus is the same as the
frequency of the applied field. This is referred to as "nucleus
magnetic resonance." In addition to nuclear resonance,
electron resonance can also occur if the external field
frequency matches that of the atom's electrons. It is under
the condition of resonance that the combined, interacting
effect of the magnetic fields is at maximum.

l0
MOLECULAR Physicists tell us that in probing the mysteries of matter,
MAGNETISM each level, e.g. atomic, molecular, and so on, has its own set
of laws, which may differ little or greatly from the other
levels. Nevertheless,patterns and principles established at one
level are frequently found to have an analogous carry-over to
other levels of investigation. So it is with the laws governing
the creation of magnetic fields. The fundamental principles
are established at the atomic level, thereafter,at the molecu-
lar level one has to consider the way in which atoms combine
to produce a particular substance. With the atom, the overall
magnetism depends on how the internal magnetism of the
atom's nucleus links up with the orbiting and spin magnetic
field of the electrons. With matter in bulk, it is the total
vector sum of various atom groupings which determines the
final character of molecular magnetism (A).* For example, in
the case of iron or cobalt, the atoms join together in such a
Phil Allen's concept of body
way that there is, in effect, no cancellation of the individual
polarities.
field of each atom, all fields combine to point in the same
direction, thus producing a substance exttemely responsive to
magnetic influence. Phil Allen shows how the human body
functions as a giant electromagnet (45, P.62\. The next
chapter explains the whys and hows.

'si?
) > --> )a> -+-+-++
SCHEMATIC \
-->>-z
\>
3
,/
/'r->
--=)
-+ --+ --+ -)
_>-> N
stages
lron in successive magneticfield weak magnetic strongmagnetic
of magnetism with at zero field -+ fie|d .--.
arrowsas domains.

KtX
--)
ACTUAL
--2
-

*The human organism, it has been estimated, consists of about


1 0 t r i l l i o nc e l l s ,i n w h i c h t h e r ea r e n e a r l y 1 0 b i l l i o nm i l e so f D N A , t h e
nucleo-protein which playsa key role in the transmissionof life codes.
Oliver Reiser suggeststhat the two chains of the double helix DNA
moleculeare of oppositepolarity.This polar affinity within an aqueous
medium is thought to aid in the stabilizationof the overallmolecular
structure(3, P.4261.

ll
A BIOCHEMICAL
PERSPECTIVE
A BIOCHEMICAL PERSPECTIVE

cell wqll

cell membrone

endoplosmic reticulum
lsmooth)
vocuolc

-?
ribosome {ree)
^.\
milochondrion /1 .t
( :'r i.'
\ ^ ' rP . r
\'n .
i ri,idt'
endoplosmic reticulum
(rough) I"'"{
lJ *l ]
l,,e r,,
nucleolus \. 1trl
nucleus

nucleor envelope a

b*
chromolin
ot droplet
6t
1i'e
i'.'

SCCrslOrygronule5
Golgi complex

9rycogon
chloroplost

I ronum

The above diagramshows a generalizedpicture of a cell with its many detailedcell


structures.For an expositionof new theoriesconcerningthe storageand transmissionof
vital forces through the transduction of ATP and the electrical ionization of the
m i t o c h o n d r i o nr,e a d " N u c l e a rE v o l u t i o n :D i s c o v e r yo f t h e R a i n b o wB o d y ( S e c t i o nl l ) .

l3
BIOCHEMICAL & If we consider the chemical composition of the human
ELECTROLYTIC body and some of its related processes,we get a closer view
RESPONSES of the magnetic processes operative at this level. The human
body consists of over 80% water. Water is universally
recognized to be particularly susceptible to magnetic
influence. The chemical explanation given for this is that
since the nucleus of the oxygen atom has no magnetic
Isotop Magnetic Moment
in
moment, and should therefore not respond to an external
Nuclear Magnetrons magnetic field, it is the single proton of the hydrogen's
H1 Hydrogen
nucleus that is thought to be so amenable to magnetic fields,
2.793
Proton with the result that water can be easily polarized by an
s42 0.857 external magnetic force. Thus, under normal circumstances,
c13 o.702
Na23 2.216
some of the hydrogen protons contained in the water within
si29 -o.555 the human body might be expected to line up in the direc-
ct35 0.821 tion of the earth's magnetic field. Extending this rationale,
r39 o.391
1129 2.79
these hydrogen protons in water would realign themselvesin
the direction of any local or applied magnetic field whose
strength greatly exceeds that of the earth's field. Hence, the
body's high percentage of water is thought to be a prevailing
reason for its susceptibility to magnetic influences.
momentof a singleproton= 1.410x 10-23erg/gauss
Magnetic

lElectron magnetron = 3:33l ro.,o erglgauss


Whereu is the nuc|ear
U.
Over recent years, several scientists have investigated the
effects of magnetic fields upon biochemical processes.And
I while there is no general consensus among them as to the
I precise nature of these effects, the findings, when considered
I Otto,on
I collectively, leave no doubt that under some laboratory
situations, artificially imposed magnetic fields can alter
normal biochemical processes. So, the main point of conten-
tion is not so much whether magnetic fields influence bio-
The simplest atom. hydrogen,
chemical processes, but rather, by what specific mechanism
conlains only one proton anrl one electron, does the change occur.

l4
Dr. Madeline Barnothy, experimenting with mice, has
indicated that under given research conditions, there are at
least three possible effects of magnetic fields upon bio-
chemical processes: a) An upset of the normal enzyme
balance, b) An increase or decrease in the stability of the
genetic code, c) Modification of the normal rate of cell
division(1, P.80-87).

Two other researchers, Drs. I. L. and L. N. Mulay offer


further'evidence of chemical responses to magnetic fields.
Emphasizing that "life processes themselves represent a
delicate balance between several interdependent biochemical
reactions," the Mulay team, as an out-growth of their work
with fruit-flies and mice, explain that "the chemical compo-
nents in the cells have varying magnitudes of magnetic
susceptibility . Hence, the permanent and any transient
components will experience varying forces under the influence
of the magnetic field. Although these forces are small from a
microscopic point of view, they may be appreciable enough
to overcome weak intermolecular forces and thus to upset
the delicate balance (chemical or other equilibria, inside and
outside the cell) necessary for the sustenance of a living
system" (1, P.166-167). The Mulays further reported on
experiments which indicated that magnetic fields ranging
between 2,000 to 7,000 oersted may have the effect of
increasing the production of gases by the decomposition of
liquids exposed to such fields (1 , P. 165).

If we consider its electrolytic properties, we achieve another


perspective of the body's chemical susceptibility to magnetic
fields. An electrolyte, as we know, is a substance in solution
capable of conducting an electric current; and where there is
electric current flow, there also is magnetism. Some liquid
solutions, because of differing chemical properties, are better
electrolytes than others. Obviously, the better the electrolyte,
the greater the current flow, and consequently, the larger the
resultant magnetic field. Iron is known to be especially
susceptible to magnetization, and the human blood carries in
solution relatively large amounts of iron. Given these
conditions, the body is seen to generate a magnetic field of

15
its own, owing partly to the presence of iron-produced
chargedparticles flowing in the blood stream,although other
chemicalelements,e.g.potassiumandsodium,also contribute
a fair measure of charged particles to the body's overall
bioelectric/biomagnetic status.It is common knowledgethat
blood placed under a microscope with a magnetic field
applied,revealsthe blood cells all lined up in the directionof
the field. This easypolarizationof the blood is thoughtto be
greatly facilitatedby the high percentageofiron containedin
the blood. Dr. Jeno Barnothy has shown that under certain
conditions magnetic fields, in altering the orientation of
blood cells,induce changesin their biologicalreactions,and
thereby modify the probability of chemicalbond formation
( l , P .l 5 ) .

C a e
O(E @@
@@o @@
e@ @ @(D@
@@ cD@ @
O(D(9(D

H=O H finite -->


MAGNETICFIELD (H}

L6
Dr. A. R. Davis explains that the blood is very slightly
alkaline, with respect to body cells which are moe acid in
nature. Consequently, if one is suffering from a condition
prompted by the over-acidity of the blood, the proper
application of negative, alkaline north pole magnetic energy
should help restore the blood to normal (D)*,(22,P.32-36\.
It is well known among biomagnetic researchers in several
countries that the blood's leucocyte count is particularly
amenable to magnetic influence, their numbers quickly rising
or dropping, depending on the prevaing magnetic conditions.
But just what implications, if any, this fluctuating leucocyte
count could have for affecting behavioral modes is not fully
clear, Thus, within the human system, the blood, because of
its chemical composition, assistsin the creation of the body's
intrinsic biomagnetic field. And further, due to its iron
content, the blood is highly amenable to magnetic fields from
external sources.

The Magnetic Cell

*
Letter notationsthroughoutthis work indicate that the referenced
informationwas obtainedby way of intervew,discussion,or persona|
correspondence with the particularinvestigatoras shown in the biblio-
graphicIistng.
t7
_ +40
g ,-^
z
^:n
o-zT

x>
=--0
5 -ao

+ + +'l'-- ++{- ++-+1'+l-'+++ | + . f+ + + + + + +

++.t.- ++++'++'t'i I r l-+ + l +++-|,t++-f+,1-++--f

----+
, +40 -;r
1r'f
z i,i;::,r,r
- o -20
z= -.u
< -
= -0
>- -80

++++++++++ I j'1 + 1 I i i+++l-+; l- l-*

++++++++++++++l-- t++++{-f++l-+l+++++

=+
. 40
aI 20
7
0
oi
9t 20
s=- 40
0

T- +++++++++t-+t- ++++++

++++++* l.--, + + + + + + + + + + + + + +l - * :|+++


I ll tttl I I
MTTilSECONDS0 t2 78e10 t2
CENTIMETERSO 5 2A 25 30

PROPAGTION oF NERVE IMPULSE coincides with changes the axon interior locally positive. In the wake of rhe impulse the
in the permeability of the axon membrane. Normally the axon in, sodium gate closes and ! potassium gate opens, allowing potassium
lerior i6 rich in potassium ions and poor in sodium ions; the fluid ions to flow out, resloring the normal negative potential. s the
outside bas a reverse composition. Vhen a nerve impulse arises, nerve impulse moves slong the axon !I and 2) it leoves the axon in
having been triggered in some fashion, a..gate'opens anil lets a refrnclory state briefly, ater which a recond impulse can follow
godium iono pour into the axon in advance o the (J). The impulse
impulse, making propagation speed is that oI a squid axon.

l8
THE CELL & The cell is an important unit of analysis in considering the
MAGNETISM production of magnetism in the human body. Biomagnetic
researchets look upon the cell in the ving organism as a small
electric battery with the mitochondria as the power house.

All functions of the human body are electro-chemical in


their operations. A cell, like all units comprised of physical,
atomic substance, has a magnetic moment which, in part,
results from the interaction of its electrochemical constitu-
ents. In'fact, Dr.Oliver Reiser has speculated that there is a
resonance which holds between the DNA in the chromosomes
of the cell nucleus and the RNA residing in the cytoplasmic
envelope which surrounds the nucleus (3, P.423428).

Biochemists are steadily expanding their comprehension of


the phenomenon of the constant transfer of electricity occur-
ring across cell membranes. In outlining the process by which
the nervous system conveys a message,one author writes:
"the electric messageis carried along the nerves as a result of
changesin the quantities of potassium and sodium salts inside
and outside the cell. Outside is a lot of sodium salt and little
potassium, inside lots of potassium and little sodium. The
effect is lke that of a wet battery where different solutions
separated by a semi-permeable membrane give rise to an
electric current. [f a very fine electrode tube is inserted inside
an individual nerve and another tube is bathed in the external
sodium predominating liquid, an electric difference of 65 - 95
millivolts can be measured between the two points.

*Diagram
on adjacentpagetakenfrom ScientificAmerican,Sept. 1961,
"How Cells Communicate,"BernardKatz.

t9
When a nerve is stimulated,sodium flows into it at the
point of stimulation and potassiumflows out, discharging
the local voltage difference across the membrane. The
voltage difference is then dischargedin the next bit of
membrane a little further along and so on - thus, the
messagetravelsalongthe nerve' ' (4, P .17l) .

Tnterior Extcrior
K+ No* No* K*
K+
CELL
No*
t,z*
K
Potassium Kt
V/AL Sodiu-
Excess
tsrces9

Nh* K* r No*
No*

Consequently, each cell can be viewed as possessingits own


immediate magnetic environment, or magnetic field, which
combines with the fields of like and adjacent cells, thereby
giving rise to the magnetic field of a particular system wthin
the human body. For example, the magnetic field of the
skeletal system can be seen as distinct from that of the
nervous system. In practice, however, the individual magnetic
fields of all the body's cells and of all the body's systems
combine to yield an overall "somatic magnetic field," result-
ing from all of the body's physical, electrochemical, magnetic-
producing processestaken collectively.

20
Christopher Hills' radionic measurement of the seven levels of the bioenergetic field
taken with instruments described in his book Supersensonics. ---
----------a\ ,,4=--

a=-\
-- V -"-

;-A-=-..t-\

AS
'(((ttlr 7
,l, ?,

N
//

7r
//rr 2A
'//

t(tt
trrl
((t Z<-\s\
it'-.,\ (t((r
tlt ffi cs\,iiil
,(|tt\\|||l|i{ii(ifi'
7i;Ei
,lll.l,t,le $\\\

r\[:ll\i[['"li';
lll\l
\tt \\
ttttttttt
[ril
llilttrr!\ i,\\\iirrtttt
liln
tltltl l!lrllll

s' N K\'N ll|iti


?,,\\lt,t,irl
l|,trrr

W
\\\\\\\ r\t
\tiN
\\\\
,(
lrr,\
\\
*\\'

.ss ry
.-r\-=-=
N .Z
7/
// ..'.\

:2"7
' ---\
---t
--t \ \ \ \ - -\
/// -\\
- MAN'S soMATIc MAGNETIC FTELD \
----/ rZ
MAGNETISM & An enzyme is defined as a biological catalyst; it enters into
ENZYMES a chemical reaction but does not become a part of the
reaction itself. The enzyme is considered the "Brain" of the
cell. Each cell in our body has its own enzyme*, and all
reactions occuling in each cell are dictated and controlled by
the enzyme (E).'"Enzyme failure is the ultimate cause of
disease; all disease can be traced to some malfunctioning
enzyme. Thus, any succ_g:ssful therapy must be noticed at the
enzyme activity 1sys1"(E).This is hbw the noted researcher,
Dr. Justa Smith explains her concept of the place of the
enzyme in the structure of human biochemistry.

Viewed in light of the above perspective, all biological


mechanisms become, comparatively speaking, gross levels of
analysis of magnetic effects. The nervous system controls
behavioral patterns, but enzymes control the nervous system.
Hence, physiologically speaking the enzyme is the lowest
possible level of behavioral control, all biological systems,
necessarily,being directed by enzymes.

It was in doing researchfor her doctoral degreethat Dr. Smith


observed the effects of magnetism upon enzymes. Enzymes
deliberately damaged by exposure to ultraviolet radiation
were subjected to various magnetic fields of strengths up to
13,000 gauss.Her resultsshowed that molecular behavior was
altered, and that there was a general enhancement of enzyme
activity. From this, it wgg concluded that bonding activity
was somehow affected (E). Atttrough several othei enzyme
solutions were tested, the enzyme trypsin figured most
prominently in the research.Also, catalase,an enzyme of the
blood, was found to be especially responsive to the presence
of a magnetcfield. But at no time was there found to be any
harmful effects to the enzvmes because of the strensth of the
field employed (E).
* The earth'smagnetic fieldis alsosaidto activate
an enzymesystemin
fruitsandvegetables whichcausesnormalripening. Whenthefieldof a
magnetpasses throughtheorganiccompoundof an apple,for example,
it is found to producea lossor gainof protonswhichspeedsup the
enzymesystemandcausesripening(23).

22
These pioneering investigations seem to leave little doubt as
to the ability of certain magnetic fields to alter enzyme
reactions which, in turn, could modify the chemical processes
occurring in each cell of the human body, However, in order
to satisfy scientific criteria other researchers may want to
duplicate Dr. Smith's work before reaching definite
conclusions.

{,

Shown is an electromagnetused in biological research.


Permanentmagnets (not shown) are also used. Depending
upon experimentalrequirements,field strengthsmay range
from a few hundredgaussto severalthousandgauss,

23
HEALING HANDS Dr. Smith has also conducted research on the effects of
"spiritual healing," or the "laying on of hands," upon
enzymes, as compared with the effects of magnetic fields. In
a series of experiments using the enzyme trypsin, she
compared the results of solutions treated by a healer against
those obtained from enzymes exposed to a magnetic field. It
turned out that the activity of damaged enzymes treated by
the healer, increased to a degree comparable to that obtained
in a magnetic field of 13,000 gauss. It was noted that the
qualitative effects of both the magnetic field and the healer's
hands were always the same - an enhancement of enzyme
activity. The effects were also quantitatively similar, up to
one hour ofexposure (E) .

A constant, and obvious question which has arisen through-


out her research is, what is the nature of the force emanating
from the healer? Is it magnetism, or some other form oi
enetgy? Using a fairly sensitive gauss meter, tests were made
for a possible magnetic field between the healer's hands --
there was no measurable field. Dr. Bernard Grad, a colleague
of Dr' Smith, who had also carried out previous investigatins
on "spiritual healing," says that the nature and mechanism of
the healing force is not known, but that it representssome X
factor or energy that flows from the human body. Dr. Smith
is equally reluctant to identify this paranormal healing energy
as magnetic. Both investigators agree,however, that whatever
the nature of the force, it can be modified by the healer's
general state of mental health, as well as by his mental
attitude or frame of mind at the time of testing (E).

24
s?,
'spueq
s,JalPaqp ueaMleqn oll ^6.raue
lo slepoulpelse06ns
ELECTROBIODYNAMICS
ELECTROBIODYNAMICS*

ffi
a

,"2
Bou
CR\6TALLIZE
xAgHlc L|GIJT

.This term is contrived to sug8 s t that what follows is a discussion of certain selected
electrodynamic and biological phenomena, as thou8trt to be elevantwithin the context of
this work. And as it is not intended to offer a full interpretation of electrodynamic and bio
logicel processes, as usually undestood by physical science; efencesae made to both con.
ventional and unconventional indings.

27
FREQUENCY & Frequency is defined as "rate of vibration," a cyclical
ELECTROMAGNETIC fluctuation of energy, over time, between certain values. The
SPECTRUM greater the rate of vibration, the higher the frequency. (The
higher the frequency, the denser the particle and the less the
heat, as heat is associated with the longer waves nearer the
red end of the spectrum; this principle is applicable to every-

E=mcz
thing in the created universe) (7). Dutch physician
Dr. J. Postma has noted that, since Einstein, we have known
that energy and matter are but two different aspects of a
single, unknown reality, that matter and energy are quantita-
tively different manifestations of one fundamental phenome-
non, viz. vibration (2, P. 38). We know too that there is only
one law of vibration, whether the field is electromagnetic (as
in radio waves), or mechanical (as in sound), or nuclear (as in
sub-atomic particles) (6). Hence, frequency, a rate of vibra-
tion, is peculiar to everything that is -- every manifest entity
in the universe has its own rate of vibration.

f'- visible
infrored ll x-roys
micro- ^ ----+
. .i l .
rodio woves woves ||ulirovio|et "Y-oys
+ -- .--.\-
-
.:
104 106 l0E l0r0 lor2 1014 1016 l0t8 f in cycles/sec
l'r i0, io lur

The elec|romogn.tic aPcckumi lhis is o con|inuour rong frcqucncy ond wovc length. Thc regionr wiilr hisloricol nomcr
of rodiotion spreoding rom gommo royr io rodio wovel. over|op, but the nomes st||givc o hint of ||re common sourccrl
The descrptive nomer for seclions of thc lpectrum ore historico|; rodio woves ond microwoves from e|ecironr movngin conduciors;
t|rey mcre|y givc o convencnt c|ogsificolion occording to th nfrored from hot obiects; vi:ib|e |ighl from very hot obiecls;
source of the rodo|ion. Thc physico| nofure of rodioiion ir uhrovolct from orcg ond gos dischorgcr; X roys from elccironr
the 3om. throughout the wholc ronge. In oll sectiont it hos strkingo |orge'' gommo roys romnuclei of rodiooclive otoml.
lh 3omc ve|ocity, |he somc c|eclromognelic nofur., ond thc
only difference from one port of thc spccirum lo onofher is in

28
Associated with frequency are the forces of nature, and
there are four forces popularly recognized by contemporary
physics.

In their descending order of strength they are: Nuclear


Forces;Electromagnetic Forces, which are one hundred times
weaker than nuclear forces; Weak-Interactions Forces, which
are one hundred million times weaker than nuclear forces;
and Gravitational Forces, which are the weakest of all
(3, P. 200-2Ol). Physical substance can be analyzed with
respect to all, or any ofthe above forces. For purposes ofthe
current discussion, our perspective is an electromagnetic one.

THE CREATION SPECTRUM*

\ \

\ vorD
tr"Tlg
BLACK NUCLEAR\ LIGI.{T
HOLES troR.cEsI PHOTONS

/
to'lP ,/
I

*From (43, p.101).


Hills' Theory of Consciousness

29
According to the latest measurements of physicists, what is
normally regarded as the electromagnetic spectrum begins at
one end with radio waves of very great wavelengths and
continues through infra-red rays, visible light, ultraviolet
light, until it reaches the other extremity of X-rays, gamma
rays, and cosmic rays, where the wavelengthsbecome exceed-
ingly short. This comprises some 60 to 80 octaves. All this
enegy travels at about l86,000 miles per second (5' P' 71).
However, when we pursue the matter further, we find that
the popularly defined electromagnetic spectrum is, in reality,
only a section of a much longer energy continuum - one
which probably extends, on its high end, into infinity.

}
THE CREATION SPECTRUM

NUCLEM WEAKINTERACNONS GRAVITY

" F r o m " H i l l s ' T h e o r yo f C o n s c i o u s n e s s( "4 3 ,P . 1 0 1 )

30
Most physicists will agree that all matter in which charges
oscillate should radiate magnetic waves, and since all matter
contains electrons in motion, i.e. moving charges, no
substance known to science should be excepted. Thus, once
charges are set in motion, they can radiate electromagnetic
energy, wherein the electrons are said to exhibit a wave-like
behavior. Some matter, then, demonstrates a low frequency
of electromagnetic waves because of the low oscillation rates
of the charges constituting that particular form of matter.
Such a slow rate of movement may produce a low frequency
wave, not easily measured because of its relatively weak
vibratory pattern. But, however weak and unmeasurable by
scientific means, the radiation should still be there. An
"inert" boulder, outwardly manifesting no signs of life has
its own electromagnetic rate of vibration, just as does a
vigorous young calf, obviously pulsating with life. Consequent-
ly, if all matter is placed along a continuum, and considered
with respect to its electromagnetic frequency, we will
discover numerous objects with wavelengths much longer
than those of radio waves. This would greatly extend the
lower end of the electromagnetic spectrum as viewed by
science. Seen from this perspective, a single electromagnetic
continuum would include rocks, plants, cows, and man's
physical body, each differing from the other only by its
relative electromagnetic frequency.

Hence, we can conceive of a vast array of electromagnetic


energies, ranging from atoms to stars. According to
Dr. Christopher Hills in his book Supersensonics (42) ths
creation spectrum consists not only of the known 80 octaves
of physical energy but includes 80 octaves of thought waves
and 80 octavesof imagination radiations (43, P. 100).

THE SPECTRUM OF CREATION


Subatomic Spectrum ElectromagneticSpectrum SuperatomicSpectrum
Thoughts Physical Imagination
80 octaves 80 octaves 80 octaves

3l
World Sensor,um

Multec|luar orgonisms

Un lcellular Orgonisrre

C et ls

/vlolecules

E fementarg Particlcs

lllustration of a spiralled "electro-vibratory"progressionof


light-energy.matter ranging from elementaryparticles to a
planetary entity called the "world sensorium" from prof.
Oliver Reiser'sCosmic Humanism,conceivedand redrawn
by StephanieHerzog.

32
Diagramaticexpressionof a sphericalsectionof nodal points report-
edly existing within the force-field of a small bar magnet.
Researchersclaim that by means of proper detection devicesnodal
point movementin spacecan be registered
over a considerabledistance.
(CourtesyDe La Warr Laboratories)

MAGNETIC FIELD Physics teaches that all magnetic materials must have a
COMPOSITION bipolar configuration, i.e. they must have a north pole, as
well as a south pole. It is evident that if two opposite poles
are facing each other attraction occurs, whereas repulsion is
the result when two similar poles face each other. One
British researcher, however, Dr. H. Tomlinson, claims that
there are polar fields developed in all directions around a
magnet. These fields, he asserts, may extend several feet,
fading as distance from the magnet increases. Tomlinson
speaks of the total ield surrounding a magnet as being
comprised of various "rays" each of which can be detected in
a specific area around the magnet (10, P.31-35). If
Tomlinson's assessment is correct, it would appear that the
detailed composition of a magnetic field is more complex
than the simple bipolar structure as popularly understood in
physics.

33
RESONANCE According to our previous discussion, all matter is under-
stood to have a rate of vibration which is peculiar to itself,
notwithstanding that it may be imperceptible to normal
human faculties, or to detection by scientiicinstrumentation'
To have a rate of vibration is to have a rhythmical pattern of
recurring periods wherein the energy of the vibration changes
from one value to another. In such a situation, the frequency
of a system is said to oscillate, or exhibit rhythmic variations
between certain maximum values. All matter, all freely
vibrating systems, then, are conceived as having their own
natural frequencies or periods of free oscillation; this consti-
tutes a system's native vibration in an unobstructed state,
i. e. without the influence of an outside compelling vibratory
force. Resonance is said to occur when the respective periods
of free oscillation of two or more different systems coincide
with each other. If two independent systems, both having
the same naturally occurring frequency, are joined together
in phase, resonance occurs with the result that their
maximum and minimum values are reached simultaneously.
Both systems vibrate in unison. Under these conditions, the
resultant waveform values, created by the union of the two
frequencies, exceed that which either could produce indepen-
dently. An illustration of this is found in the fact that a
vibrating tuning fork will set into sympathetic vibration, or
resonance, another tuning fork of the same frequency.

Resonance, necessarily, involves an exchange between


systems, a kind of mutual "sensing." In most cases two
vibrating systems interact, one becomes dominant, and the
other moves to the frequency of the dominant one. But once
resonance is achieved, there is continual and maximum
energy exchange between the two systems. Professor Oliver
Reiser, in his book, Cosmic Humanism, refers to the British
investigator, Ninian Marshall, who has postulated a theory of
"Holistic Resonance."

34
Mr. Marshall asserts that any two structures exert a mutual
vibratory influence upon each other which tends to make
them become more alike.* He further statesthat "the strength
of this influence increaseswith the product of their complexi-
ties and decreases with the differences between their
p a t t e r n s "( 3 , P . 4 7 6 ) .

A group of researchers in "Radiational Physics" maintain


that all vibrating matter with a wavelength (and that includes
all matter) is like an antenna which moves back and forth in
resonance with the gyratory forces ofnature around it. These
investigators have found that all vibrating bodies have around
them a pattern of specific points -- nodal points -- at which
resonance with other systems can occur (6). They further
suggestthat resonance between different octaves or realms of
matter is possible. "All quanta," they explain, "depend on
the frequencies of radiation." A feeble radiation of very high
frequency can cause the materialization of that frequency in
a large number of atoms when in resonance, while intense
radiation of a low frequency may not materialize at all if
there is no resonance(7).

We broaden our concept of resonance by the use of the


term "complementary." Two or more fields are considered to
be complementary if when brought together their individual
phase and frequency result in an amplified, increased effect.
Two combined fields may show a complementary relation in
some aspects, but destructive in others. Thus, with combined
fields, one must consider relative degreesof "complementari-
ness" (or relative degreesofresonance) as such frequencies in
combination with each other can manifest varying aspects of
additive or destructive interaction, depending on their points
of intersection.

* Mostphysicists
wouldagreethattwo independentlyvibrating sources
exerta mutualinfluenceupon eachother,but not all will agreethat
sucha mutualexchangemakesthemmorealike.

35
HARMONICS The state of resonance between two interacting magnetic
ieldsinvolves more than the association of simple frequencies.
As explained earlier, all naturally occuring waveforms are a
complex, having several component features. And one of the
factors contributing to the complexity of frequency composi-
tion is the phenomenon of "harmonics." Every vibration has
what is known as a fundamental frequency, plus its accom-
panying harmonics. The "fundamental" (sometimes referred
to as the first harmonic) is the first and the lowest frequency
and has the longest wavelength. A harmonic is a mirror image
of the fundamental. Together with the fundamental frequency,
there is an infinite series of harmonics, all vibrating at
different amplitudes, but all reflections of the original
frequency. The frequencies of the harmonics are all integral
multiples of the fundamental frequency. The first harmonic,
following the fundamental, is double the fundamental,
the next is treble the fundamental, and so on. Investigations
of harmonic behavior reveal that amplitude and intensity
decreasewith an increase in frequency (B). And it is generally
known that magnetic fields, and consequently their harmonic
vibrations, interact with each other in varying degrees of
attraction and repulsion, varying degreesof "in-phaseness" or
"out-of-phaseness" with each other. The harmonic of a
physical body is seen to be intermeshed with the body itself,
but also extending beyond it.
An illustration will serve to elaborate our discussion of
harmonics. One writer described harmonics this way: "a
string fixed at each end can vibrate at a number of different
frequencies. The lowest of these, F, is called the fundamental
frequency. The other will have values 2F,3F, etc., and are
called harmonics. These frequencies can be excited simultane-
ously and the resulting vibration has a complex waveform.
Thus, the summation of anumberof frequencies harmonically
related gives rise to a complex periodic waveform"(l3, P. I l).
Nor is the phenomenon of harmonics constrained by physical
dimensions; it ranges the continuum from micro to macro
manifestations. Nuclear physicists have found that all atoms
have a fundamental vibration, along with its series of harmonic
reflections.

36
Summarily, then, we see that naturally occurring waveforms,
i.e. waveforms emanating from freely oscillating, uncontrived
sources, are complex in their composition. This includes all
waveforms in nature, leaving the production of "pure"
frequencies to be attempted only in experimental laboratory
situations. Waveforms are generally complex for at least two
major reasons:
Each vibration has its fundamental frequency
plus associated harmonics, which together
produce a complex frequency.
Any given waveform is invariably a mixture
being comprised of more than one distinct
frequency, thus resulting in another degree of
complexity.
As separate vibrations join to produce a single, resultant
waveform, each vibration carries with it an infinite range of
harmonics which interact with each other in the formation of
the final waveform configuration. This resultant waveform
will, in turn, have its associated harmonics and can combine
with yet other frequencies in an infinite process of combina-
tion and re-combination.

,==n Stringvibratingas a wholeand


Fundamentalmode
in segmentsat the same time

'=^
3rd harmonic
ffarmonics in addition to the fun-
t=i^ damental are produced when a string vi-
brates in two or more segments.

t-f,x
7th harmonic

a-
3t
BIOMAGNETIC Several years ago, the De La Warr researchers,using specially
RESONANCE devised equipment, found that all matter, that all human
beings, emit a distinct frequency vibration which is an integral
feature of physical existence ( I I , P. 60). It was further
discovered that some aspect of man's somatic vibrations
translates as audible sound frequencies. Dr. Von H. Rohracher
of the Psychological Institute of Vienna University has
recorded sonic micro-vibrations emitted by the skin of
humans and animals. These emissions are complex sound
waves which differ with each individual, as indicated on
recorded graphsmade by Rohracher (12,P.22).

Recalling our previous discussion of harmonics, it was seen


that any given oscillation has a fundamental frequency plus
its associated harmonics, that the propagation, and the inter-
action of fundamental and harmonic frequencies in three-
dimensional space are such that an infinite number of
frequency combinations, and resonance between separate
frequencies are possible. This concept is meant to embrace all
vibrations - including those emitted by human beings. Thus,
each man, somatically speaking, is seen to generate a funda-
mental frequency peculiar to himself, which, in turn, propa-
gates into space an ininite series of harmonics, all bearing an
integral relationship to the original fundamental frequency.
Based on a series of experiments which he conducted in
Holland, Dr. H. Philippi discovered that every living entity
has a vibratory pattern which is typical of the species which
the entity represents(2,P.47).

We conceive, then, of each living organism as radiating out


into space, a frequency identifying other aspects of its
physiological (and no doubt psychological) existence.

We know that resonance occurs if the oscillatory sequences


of two or more independent systems coincide, thereby
producing a sympathetic vibratory unison of their respective
frequency patterns. Such a situation establishes a comple-
mentary relationship between independently vibrating sources.

38
I

t_

An illustration based on the De La Warr findings of nodal point


distributionsurroundingthe human being.The patternof nodal points
an
is reportedto changewith the individual'sthought,thus suggesting
interrelationshipbetween one's mental energiesand the force-field
containingone's nodal Points. (CourtesyAstara)
Given these conditions, it seems reasonable to expect that a
given human body, as an independently vibrating source, is
capable of attaining a degree of resonance (or "complementa-
riness") with other independently vibrating sources.* Accord-
ingly, the De La Warr researchershave postulated that under
certain conditions, a state of "magnetic" resonance could be
set up between two objects that are distant from each other.
They say that in such a "magnetic" continuum the force-
fields of a distant person could be detected at almost any
point in space and a psycho-somatic diagnosis carried out by
means of appropriate apparatus ( I I , P. 7).

Also associated with resonance and harmonics is the


previously mentoned phenomenon of nodal points. The
De La Warr group has found that around every human being
is a "magnetic" force-field with a pattern of nodal points,
vortices of energy, similar to that of a bar magnet. Each of
these points, they explain, is in contact with the person to
whom they belong. Consequently, to be in resonance with
any one of these points is to be in resonance with the indivi-
dual ( I l, P. 7). Other investigators maintain that nodal points
are resonance bonds which function to bind man, and all
things, to the creative force-field ofthe universe (7). Phil Allen
in Energy, Matter and Form (45, P. 15-17) explains how
these nodal points occur inside the body as acupoints; the
high energy bonds at the acupuncture meridian systems.

* Here
we think not only of resonanceas beingpossiblebetweentwo
or more human bodies,but of resonanceoccurringbetweenan indivi-
dual and particular frequenciesof sound, color, fragrance,or other
i ndependentIy
vbratngsources.
It has further been suggestedthat if a frequency produced by the
human brain is placed in resonancewith a magneticfield of sufficient
intensity,behaviorcan be modified (D).

40
A De La Warr demonstrationof the symmetricaldistributionof some
of the nodal points in the human force-fieldand their experimental
detection. Investigatorsmaintain that this field interpenetrates
and
surroundsthe physical body and that its "magnetic" propertiesare
present throughout the earth,s magnetic fie|d, thereby formng a
continuumwhich extendsinto a "pre-physical"stateof matter.

4l
RAPPORT Closely related to, and practically synonymous with, the
phenomenon of resonanceis the concept of "rapport" about
which researchersstill have much to learn. The term rapport,
within the context of biomagnetics, may be taken to express
a psychophysical relationship between two persons, or
between an object and a person,in space and time. However,
in 1852, a Frenchman named M. Benoit used snails in his
experiments, as he felt certain that a form of rapport was
operative in the animal kingdom (l l, P. 57-58). First, the
researcher paired off 52 snails and allowed them to become
well acquainted by living together in separate pairs. Then on
each pair, he wrote a letter of the alphabet,two A's, two B's,
and so on. One set of alphabet{abeled snails was sent to
America, and the other retained in Paris. At a pre-determined
time, in Paris, an electric shock was applied to a snail, say
snail E. Simultaneously snail E in America reacted in
sympathy, exhibiting a kind of erratic behavior. Several other
snails were shocked, and it was possible to transmit a simple
messageby "snail telegraph" ( I 1, P. 58).
In 1965, a modern day corollary to Benoit's experiment was
conducted at De La Warr laboratories in Oxford, England.
But the unique feature of this endeavor was to show that
rapport exists between a physical object and a photograph of
that object. A photograph was taken of a snail and sent to
the town of Evesham, 40 miles away. In Oxford, the animal
was placed in an apparatus whereby histogram* readings
could be taken. In Evesham, which was linked to Oxford by
telephone, the snail's photograph was intermittently exposed
to certain light energies which were successful in producing
responsesregisteredby the histogram in the Oxford laboratory
(l I, P. 58). Similar experiments were carried out with human
subjects and their photographs; several energy stimuli were
utilized: light, sound, color, ultraviolet and infra-red
radiations, and magnetism.
* A deviceusedto recordand measure
amountsof energytransmitted
throughparticularpartsof the body;it registers
physiological
reflex
actions resultingfrom such changes,Histogramsare essentially
amplitude/frequencygraphsof energytransmission through body
tissues,Thesegraphsreportmuscularand possiblyvascular
changes in
the subject'sbody as rapportis establishedand broken(\2,P.541,
( 11 ,P . 3 8 ) .
42
#
\l \\ r
y4^- - \t a'-
--I4 -,:'t ) r\ll-Z
/

\--'\

-'/v\
-r\ lY-

J1- :

&-

_/Vv

NEW YORK

OXFOR, D

Av l'AG< Ht6o6lR'AF4 ?Pot.l

43
In each instance histogram readings indicated that a state
of rapport existed between the subject and his photographic
image (2, P. 56\. Other De La Warr tests suggestthat rapport
holds, over great distances, between an individual and fus
blood or hair specimens (2, P 56), (l I, P. 4-7) Apparently,
some mechanism involving resonance andfor harmonic
relationships is responsible for maintaining a lasting bond
between an individual and certain objects related to that
individual, even when individual and object are separatedby
space and time.

Like rapport between an individual and an object,


"magnetic" rapport between two individuals has also been
demonstrated at the De'La Warr facilities. A subject was
made to relax for thirty minutes in a reclined position until
a regular pattern indicating his relaxed state began to register
on the histogram. Some 100 yards away, in another building,
a person presumably closely associated with the subject was
situated. At a time' unknown to the subject the distantly
located person began thinking of him; shortly the histogram
recording changed,apparently reflecting the incoming thought
energy from the thinking person(ll, P.55-57). Of major
significance in this test is that a state of rapport obviously
already existed between the two individuals, or that a state of
rapport could easily be established between the two persons,
in order to best transmit thought energy between them. In
Benoit's earlier test, it was clearly his purpose in pairing the
snails, to have them first establish rapport by living together,
prior to the actual experiment. Thus, it would seem that
close physical association is a key factor in facilitating a state
of rapport between animals or humans.

It is explained that the product or effect of rapport, is one


of communication, and that this communication appears to
take place without the propagation of electromagnetism
(2, P.54), as we presently understand it. Nevertheless,it has
been shown that the state of rapport is affected by various
kinds of known electromagnetic energies,including light and
magnetism.

44
Moreover, the De La Warr researchers explain that whatever
the mechanism responsible for communication by rapport, it
is apparent that it involves factors outside our normal
concepts of space/time dimensions (2, P. 54).

If, then, we were to try to capsulize a provisional definition


of rapport on the basis of what is presently known, we could
say that rapport is a state or condition existing between two
or more entities, whereby communication between the
entities can occur; the factors responsible for establishing
rapport are seen to lie outside the known dimensions of space,
time, and electromagnetism,although various electromagnetic
energiescan influence rapport.

It has been further noted that the breaking of rapport


usually produces a large change in histogram patterns. The
De La Warr researchers explain that this phenomenon is
suggestive of a similar situation in some electrical circuits
where there is a rise of instantaneous voltage when the circuit
is broken, bringing about the collapse of the associated
magnetic fields. However, they conirm, in the case of
rapport, no magnetic field, as such, is evident; but the
observed effect when rapport is broken seems to imply the
presence of a field of energy, the nature of which is not yet
known (2,P.54\.

We can speculate further on a couple of mechanisms which


may be involved in the establishing of rapport between indivi-
duals. Dr. P. [. Guliaev, a Russian researcherin parapsycholo-
gy, has commented that it is known that certain electric
currents, when applied directly to the brain, cause neural
excitation, thereby evoking various sensations, including
light, sound, and even recollection. He thinks, therefore, that
it is quite possible that cerebrally generated electromagnetic
waves might stimulate another sympathetic brain (27).

45
If Guliaev's assumption is correct, it could provide an
important explanation for the phenomenon of rapport, as
viewed from the physiological perspective. Such an interpre-
tation would be entirely within the realm of known physical
mechanisms, for it will be recalled from our earlier discussion
of resonance,that two independently vibrating systems can
exert a mutual influence upon each other which tends to
make them more alike. Two or more individuals frequently
brought together in mutual association, might be conceived
of as so many autonomously vibrating cerebral systems
whose close proximity, and consequent interchange of
energies, produces a kind of "communal likeness" among
them. Once a sympathy or likeness of cerebral vibrations is
established, the kind of sympathetic cerebral stimulation
suggested by Guliaev would seem possible. This eventually
leads to communication via thought waves. Phil Allen takes
these discoveries to some surprising conclusions in Energy,
Matter and Form (45, P. 102-136).
PHIL ALLEN

"Is everythingwe see really constructedfrom interfering


wavefieldsofthoughttakingplace in our consciousness?"
(p. 100)

"(Recent research)implies that our body is a three-


dimensionalvirtual image (i.e. a hologram)formed by
wave interferencepatternsin our mind-our self-image.
The microtubules(withinourcells)may actlikefiberoptic
waveguidesfor the transmissionof light wavesthroughus.
If so, it is quitelikely that our body is a creationofholo-
graphicthoughtprocesses-a psychic hologram-and we
self-organizebasedon the imagewe have of ourselfin our
mind" (p. ll9)

Visualizationby Phil Allen


Energy, Matter and Form (p. 100)

46
THE MAGNETRON Even more recently in August, 1977 ,Dr. Robert Massy gave
a paper at the U. S. Psychotronics Conference in Los Angeles
demonstrating rapport in two practical experiments of very
different natures. The following is abstracted from this paper.

During the great European revval of radiesthesia and radionics,


beginning around 1920, rapport was discovered to hold over great
distances.betweenan individual and his blood or hair specimens.Some
mechanism involving resonance is apparently responsible for maintain-
ing a lasting bond between an individual and certain objects related to
that individual, even when individual and object are separatedby space
and time.

In October,1953 the Servranx brothers published a paper in an


English pubcation, Radiational Physics Notes, describing the use of
the drawing of the cross section of a Magnetron to establishrapport
between two similar samples.(The Magnetron is a generatorof micro-
waves which was later superseded by the klystron generator, the
klystron generatorbeing more pure and the Magnetronmore powerful.

This they used for triangulations in map reading for location work
and with anatomical drawingsfor diagnosis,the witnessesbeing placed
in the center circle. Another use was in selecting medicinal remedies by
laying each sample separatelyat the Magnetroncenter and determining
'the
small outer white disc which is in resonancewith the remedy tested.
The remedies were then placed in position on the smaller discs and
sympathy with the center witnessfound.

Threecommon typesof magnetroncavities:slot, hole and


slot,vane.

47
5
6

Dr. RobertMassy settingup the Magnetronto broadcastenergyoa specificrequency


to himse|. Note how
the plantin the backgroundhasgrownso as to be overthe energyemittedfromthetops of the smallboxes.
Theseboxesare Pi-Ray Coffers.See " RaysFromthe Capstone"by ChristopherHillsfor detailson thiscoffer
and its energies.
Under the direction of Dr, ChristopherHills, the research team at
the University of the Trees wanted to come up with an apparatus whose
broadcasting distance would be operator independent. Duplicating
the campus radionics set was ruled out due to its inherent disadvantages
in supplying a unit to each team member.

A literature search uncovered a number of instruments which were


finally narrowed down to the Magnetron. Redesigned to incorporate
modern day technology, the Magnetronseemedto offer the advantages
we were looking for.

RADIONICS SET MAGNETRON


DISADVANTAGES ADVANTAGES

Price (:$460.00) Low cost


Not readily portable Light weight
Space user Occupies small space
Operator training needed Easily tuneable
Time consuming set up No training needed
Error prone in set up Set up time minimal
Not legal fot servces
Unlimited broadcast
distance, independent
of the operator, by
tying into the eatth's
magnetic field.
Note:
Becausethe effectiveoperationofthe Magnetron
is dependenton the cooperationofthe conscious-
nessofthe operator,no commercialclaims can be
made for it The nstrumentis available for
research purposes where students of psycho
troncs are still testing the results wth ins c t
control, broadcast of bioenergetic signals and
other uses of the Magnetron principle. Univer-
sity of the Trees is collecting actual eportsof
results for future publication.

49
THEORY In 1899 Nikola Tesla constructedthe world's biggestTesla coil, near
Colorado, whose primary coil was 80 feet in diameter.Centeredwithin
this was a coil about l0 feet tall and l0 feet in diameter, connected
to a huge metal ball on a 200 foot tower above the building. With
this coil, Tesla proved that the earth itself can be used for the trans-
mission of energy without wires and that the force followed the lines
of the earth'smagneticfield.

These lines have connection with the ley lines which were observed
by the ancients and account for the lines of magneticvariation at the
earth's surface. The earth's magnetic field is influenced by changes
in the sun's strong magnetic fields producing solar flares and sunspots.
The carrier is the solar wind, a continuous breeze of electrified gas
which arriveshere about four days after an event on the sun to create
disturbancesin the earth's magnetism. There are holes in the sun's
chromosphere which appear to have alternatingpolarity. The energy
of the sun travelsfrom one hole to the next along these polarity lines
and thus produces the well known shape of the solar flares,These arcs
evidentlytrace out lines of magneticforce.

Making useof this information, magnetswere added to the Magnetron.


Their positions were such that their polarities simulated the sun's field
and at the sametime obviously utilized the earth'smagneticforce-field.
The Magnetron itself is not the tool, but is only a focalizer.The vast
magnetic field of the earth providesthe invisible wires for broadcasting.

50
mcgrilelnon
cX
A

a
.,.9

..t-

A";

Supersensonic & Direction


Broadcast tinder

t'*'
Supersensonics
@tszs
University of the Trees Press P.O. Box 644 Boulder Creek, CA 95006

51
PEST CONTROL IN The Magnetron is simply set up by orientating its long side parallel
ORGANIC FARMING to magnetic north.

A vegetable garden which had previously been divided into nine lots,
each separatedby a two foot wide path on all sides,as illustrated,was
chosen for the first experiment, since this garden had a history of
pest invasion. The previous year, slugs had been eliminated from the
entire area using a radionics set. This left a problem of snails and sow
bugs as the primary pests.To provide adequatecontrols,it was decided
to concentrateon clearing the sowbugsfrom one plot only. Plot E was
chosen. It appeared to be suffering the greatest from these pests.

A piece of sod and a live sow bug from plot E were placed at the
center of the Magnetron.In this position the sow bug was killed, thus
broadcastinghis death pangs to plot E. The apparatuswas left undis-
turbed for two weeks. Within three days there was no sign of sow bugs
in plot E and they have not returned all summer. In the control plots,
A through I, sow bug activity continued at normal rate.

Used in this manner the Magnetron appeasto have enormous


potential in the field of organicfarming.

COMMUNICATION This instrument carries important ramifications for the future of the
group dynamics field. Its application in a group situation, for example,
would be where communicationhas become blocked or has completely
broken down becauseof sch conditions as extreme anger or rigid ego
positions. In such cases we have employed the magnetronto balance
the energy fields f each of the participants, thus making effective
communicationpossible,

During a meetingbetweentwo opposingfactions,a photographof the


participantswas placed at the magnetron'scenterand a light was shone
through a green filter irradiating the photograph with energy which is in
resonancewith the heart. The result was that the participantsmoved
away from their strong ego positions and communication between the
partiestook place.

52
Experiment with different colored filters produced the following
correlations of group behavior in meetings.*

COLOR EFFECT PRODUCED

Red A loud meeting


Orange Social atmosphere
'Yellow
Intellectual/planning
mood
Green Greater understanding
between participants
Blue Nostalgicmood
Indigo A fast moving meeting
Violet A visionary meeting

HEALING APPLICATION: Dave Edwards, reseachetin human behavior change, reports on his
introduction to the Magnetron. Using orthodox medical techniques, he
had been unable to shake off a flu virus which drained his energiesand
left him too weak to work. Using divining, Massy determined that
Edwards needed energy corresponding to the red and green wavelengths
alternately for two and four hour periods each. At 10 o'clock a.m.
Edwards started to treat himself using witnesses consisting of a photo-
graph of himself and vitamin C at the center of the Magnetron. He set
up a lamp to cast red ligltt on the Magnetron for two hours and a g;reen
fuht for four hours, alternating back and forth, The following morning
Edwards stated that "my strength returned and I felt completely
recovered from the vius.''

*
For further information on the effects of color on our personality,
see "Nuclear Evolution" by Dr. ChristopherHills (Pub. Universityof
the Trees Press).

53
EAST-WEST FLOW Our preceding discussion of the principles of magnetism is
largely predicated upon knowledge provided us by the
conventional physical sciences. Now, however, we move
into a somewhat uncommon area of investigation, that of
"Radiational Physics." Of particular interest to our present
subject is the concept of the "East-WestFlow." The intent
here is to review this phenomenon which popular physics
has not yet integrated into its conventions, to see how the
east-west flow might be associated with certain "electro-
vibratory" influences upon humans. The material presented
in this section is taken from a series of papers published by
"The Commission for Research Into the Creative Faculties
of Man," Centre House, London.

It will be recalled that we mentioned earlier, Dr. Tomlinson's


explanation that no magnetic field is comprised simply of
north and south polarities, that there are various other rays
and polar opposites contained within a given field. The
De La Warr researchers further substantiate this finding by
their postulation of an east-west axis in a magnetic field
(12, P.12 & l8). Expounding on the east-westflow pheno-
menon, the Commission investigators describe it as a wave
radiation, a belt of energy, subject to the laws of physics,
which surrounds the earth's equator and moves in a direction
from east to west, at right angles to the earth's magnetic
field. This force, it is said, passesthrough solid matter, can be
reflected by a mirror, and travels long distances at speeds
varying with the density of the substance through which it
passes. The east-west flow apparently acts upon objects, as
well as geometrical forms. The investigators go on to explain
that the east-west flow has a condensing effect which creates
the bipolar forces of attraction and repulsion which are
always to be found at right angles to its east-west axis.

54
EIectrc

Eogt West F low

s --_\

(42, P.96)
From Supersensonics
Receivingantennaorientation

55
Taken in this perspective, the east-westflow, then, becomes
the progenitor of the earth's north-south polarity, with which
we are more familiar. The east-west flow is seen to balance
polarity, in reality creating four poles where science normally
conceives of two. This situation conduces to the postulation
that there is no duality in polarity, that polarity, on the
whole, is a state of complementary tensions, and not based
on the logic of opposites. We find further, that the gyratory
nature of wave propagation cannot be explained by the usual
north-south polarity of any entity or field of energy. But
acting in concert, the north-south, east-west force-fields
would cause the gyratory motion in all material bodies on
earth, to the right or left, depending on the polarity of the
body itself. A state of resonance is said to exist between the
east-west and the north-south force-fields. And there is the
additional implication that the east-west flow of electrons is
somehow responsible for conditions of resonance between
the earth's magnetic field, and the magnetic ields of all
entities inhabiting the earth. The assertion is made that the
principle of resonance is the secret of all galactic formations,
and of the spiralling east-west flow of energy; and that from
this, it seems to follow that the spin of the earth itself is
owed to the resonant interplay of east-west, north-south
force-fields. Within the earth's magnetic envelope, a balance
of these forces is seen to prevail, and together they account
for the horizontal and vertical orbits of free electrons in all
living organisms.

But we are left with the question of what, precisely, is the


nature of the east-west flow. It is, apparently, somewhat
different in character from the known electromagnetic
forces. The Commission researchers say that it is a third
force, neither electric nor magnetic, but that it acts upon the
nodal points, the resonance bonds of all systems. tt is
concluded, however, that whatever its ultimate nature, the
east-west flow is essential to life, for without it there would
be no rotation of the spheres, no atmosphere, no magnetic
moment, and no life.

56
tr:

\
}-

.... magneiJ.-
field
--- E-w flow
:. e|eatr. fi.eld

57
POLARITIES-
NORTH AND SOUTH
POLARITIES-NORTH AND SOUTH

-----_--.->

E c l i p t i c p l o n ! .o f
Eorth 's orbit.

!
tr

o $or,.

---------------*r

"The Van Allen radiationbelts shown as dots are made up of high energyproticity.The
East* West flux of electronswhich flow betweenand around them causesall objects
on earth to be interpenetrated with a resonantfield of polarizedelectricalenergywhich
is constantlypassingthroughthe human nervoussystem.This energywas called"Prana"
by the ancient seersand diviners;it interactswith the field of consicousness known as
K u n d a l i n ie n e r g y .E v e r y o n eh a s K u n d a l i n i ,b u t n o t e v e r y o n eh a s f u l l b i o l o g i c acl o n t r o l
o f i t . " D r . C h r i s t o p h eH
r i l l s ,S u p e r s e n s o n i c s .

59
POLAR DISTINCTIONS lf one were to consider physicists and biomagnetic researchers
collectively as that groupof scientistsperhaps most intimately
concerned with the nature of magnetic fields, one finds that
there is among them no consistent standard for determining
magnetic polarity. But even beyond the question of standard-
ized polarity interpretations, there are some fairly significant
differences between the views of conventional physicists and
biomagnetic researchers, involving the behavior of polar
energies.
What constitutes the negative pole and what constitutes the
positive pole of a magnet appears to be open to how the
individual scientist chooses to define it. Physics maintains
that negative and positive are relative concepts, and that in
dealing with a magnetic dipole field, we can say that one of
its poles is negative with respect to the other pole. We are
taught, in effect, that there are no distinguishing characteris-
tics which constitute "magnetic negativeness,"as opposed to
"magnetic positiveness." And in the absence of any clear
personal definition of poles that an individual researchermay
choose to give, the convention in physics is to consider the
north pole as being of positive polarity and the south pole as
negative. This position, however, is not shared by several
biomagnetic researchers who consistently maintain that the
north pole is negative in polarity and the south pole positive.
A bit further on, we examine some of the evidence given in
support of the biomagnetic position. But for the present, we
pursue some of the points of contention between the two
views.

g
A compass is a small magnet, suspended so that it rotates
freely in response to magnetic influences. [n using a compass
to determine magnetic polarity, one has at least two options
for defining what happens: that the end of the compass
marked "N" is indeed the north pole of the instrument, and
that when it points to geographic north, it is actually point-
ing to magnetic south or, that the end of the compass marked
"N" is the north-seeking pole - which means that it is really
the south pole of the compass. Just wfuch definition one uses
A compass needlein a magneticfield lines up in the
directiono the fie|d.
is a matter of personal preference.

60
Both interpretations seem to be equally popular. Neverthe-
less, their north-south differences not withstanding, there
appears to be a majority consensus among most researchers
concerned with magnetism, that those who live geographically
north of Huancayo, Peru are under the influence of negative
polarity geomagnetic energy, while inhabitants to the
geographic south of the magnetic equator are exposed to
positive polarity geomagnetic energy. Thus, the point of
debate does not so much involve the polarity of energy which
prevails in the respective hemispheres, but whether the north
magnetic pole is located in the southern hemisphere, or vice
versa;the biomagnetic position implicitly holds that magnetic
north and geographic north are both located in the same
hemisphere.*

There is yet another area of difference between the views


held by conventional physics and those of biomagnetic
investigators. This involves the question of the path of move-
ment followed by magnetic lines of force. Popular physics
conceives of the lines of force emanating from the end of a
bar magnet as being fairly straight lines which travel through
the air from one pole to the other. They further maintain
that electrons entering this field are caused to spiral around
the lines of force, and that the way in which they spiral
depends on the direction in which the magnetic field is
pointing - this particular interaction phenomenon is referred
to as the "angle of incidence." The electrons, they say,
follow a helical path determined by that of the existing ield.
On the other hand, biomagnetic researchersassert,using a bar
magnet as illustration, that the lines of force issuing from
magnetic poles are not straight, but spiralling, with a cork-
screw like motion. Consequently, they explain the spiralng
motion of electrons in a magnetic field as resulting from the
natural spiral of the magnetic lines of force.

* This, of course,exceptsthe differencesof about 12oof the earth's


surfacesituatedgeographically south, but falling within magnetic
north,i.e. the difference
between Ouito,Ecuadorand Huancayo, Peru.

6l
MAGNETIC FIELD

Electron field manifests at right


angles to the magnetic field" Old
concept depicts rnagnetic lines of
force in straight|nes.New concept
depicts magnetic forces in spirals*.

r,i !
)''.."'
'v*-t

I
I

\ I

*From "The UniversalLink", 1962, publishedby the Commissionfor CourtesyDr. ChristopherHills


Research into the Creative Faculties of Man, Centre House, London.
|44,P.8291

62
FUNDAMENTAL RAYS Christopher Hills takes this concept further in his book
Supersensonics(42, P. 336-338).

The idea that all matter was one continuous energy but manifested
with different nodal points of energy at different angles in a spiral
spectrum would explain the three-dimensionalnature of matter and
give science four poles instead of only two, Not only was there a
positive and negativehorizontal and vertical aspectto each particle but
also a positive and negative characteristic of its spiral rotation through
space.That some matter has left-handedspin and some right-handedis
explainedby bringingin the concept of East to West flow.

MATTEB HAS FOUB POLES

TWO POLES N-S

TWO POLES E-W


horizontal plane,

V r t i c a l p | a n a t
rlght angleto the
horizontal.
SCIENCE HAS

POSITTVE/NEGATIVE POLES

Finally bringing in the concept of the scatteringof particlesof energy


according to their number of protons would suggestthat any material
element is stabilized at a fundamental angle of manifestationfrom the
universal field of which it is a part. In other words, each particle is
undergoing creation and annihilation continuously so fast that we do
not perceiveit.

63
Like the sequential action of light photons on the eye such as a
cameraprojector,we do not see the interval betweenevents.The reality
of matter is decided by its fundamental angle of manifestationand at
any other angle the same universal energy is manifesting as something
else in the periodic table of elements. Each element has its own
resonant frequency with the fundamental frequency of the universal
field which forms itself into patterns which we call material structures
of atoms.

FUNDAMENTAL Following this line of thought, Louis Turenne, a famous


RAY DISC French pioneer of radiesthesia,developedthe Fundamental
Ray Disc in 1935.The followingdiscussionof the useof this
instrument is taken from Hills' book Nuclear Evolution
(44,P. t94-t97).

This color disc divides each segmentof color into anglesrepresenting


the elementsof nature as they manifestto our consciousnessout of the
spiral form of the primordial atom. Turenne found that by putting a
radioactive sample at the center of the disc the vertical polarisationsof
any element placed at the center of the disc would radiate its spectral
lines in a horizontal direction and could therefore be plotted for each
element as a seriesof anglesin different sectionsof the color spectrum,
depending on the complexity of the atom, its atomic number and its
shellsof electronsorbiting around the nucleus.

N
I

__E

64
Kf,i\ii

06 4t
I
- |
Q-

,rVOlD Y

I J
I @
z

EY
6

OIA
'ln oC
^i rt
t31u'.

Fundamental
Ray Disc

Supersensonics
"'
@tszs

Univesityo the Trees Press P.o. Box 644 Bou|dercreek' cA 95006

65
By placing one's finger at the center and holding a pendulum over it,
the angle of the various elements of matter in the human body will
produce a diviner's reaction just like a water dowser gets from a rod
over underground water, The Turenne disc measuresany disturbance
or oscillation in the body due to lack of body elements.It measures
imbalance,whether in the aura or in the body, and by treatingthe one,
heals the other. Or the body may be treated directly by divining the
prope remedy to fill the lack' As a cross check the remedy, when
placed at the center of the disc with a witnessof the person,will cancel
out the vibration of the illnessit is in phasewith.

The abity, using the Turenne disc,* to detect the thresholds of


radiations coming from all objects around us in the environment in
terms of their relation with the color spectrum, gives mankind a
completely new technique for probing and measuringthe vibrationsof
matter as they are influenced by light and to understandthe natural
state in which they function without the distortedimagesbrought to us
through mechanical devicesand sensorswhich do not give us a correct
picture of causes but only detect effects. Therefore Turenne's color
rosette is a useful tool for detectingnot only visual colors but invisible
colors emanating as auras around objects and people. It is a way of
detecting what the kundalini energy is actually doing inside us and
tracing its effects on our consciousness,and of verifying the work on
the levelsof consciousnessin Part II of this book.

*
c o m p | e t ed e t a i l s o f t h i s n s t r u m e nat r e g i v e n i n , , | n s t r u m e n t so f
Knowing" availablefrom the publishers,showing where you can get
the whole rangeof Turenne'srules,discs, and the divining rods,etc,

66
A NEW LOOK AT THE The biomagnetic researchers believe that the magnetic
EARTH'S POLARITIES equator is a null point* lying midway between the two polar
extremities. The further assertion is made that in the
northern hemisphere (negative polarity) the field spirals to
the left in an anti-clockwise direction, while in the magnet's
southern hemisphere, where positive polarity is dominant,
the field spirals to the rieht in a clockwise direction.

_THE NEW-

NoBIYoLt

));

S\::r ;)1
'

t""ttrs$
The generallyaccepteds c i e n t i f i cd i a g r a mo f D r s . D a v i sa n d S i e r r a ' sc o n c e p to f h o w l i n e s
the path followed by lines of force in a o f f o r c e b e h a v ei n a d i p o l e m a g n e t i cf i e l d .
dipole magneticfield-
*
The null point is an area of zero magnetism.A magnet'sintensityis
found to be greatestat the poles,this strengthgraduallydecreasing with
movement towards the magneticequator, and finally reachingzero
valuepreciselyat the magneticequator.Followingthis view, a currently
developingtheory has it that the earth'sdipole field strengthis of zero
valueat the magneticequator.

67
In his laboratory, Dr. Davis demonstrated this principle with
a special device he has developed, called the "Magnetophoto-
cronograph"* (E).

The function of this instrument is to present a visual


representation of the lines of force assumed by the field
emanating from a magnet. This device, a modified version of
a color television set, produces, in color, a distinct visual
pattern for each of the poles of a bar magnet. When the polar
end of a bar magnet is held a few inches away from the
instrument, one can actually see the anti-clockwise rotation
of north pole energy as it impinges upon the electronic screen,
or the clockwise movement of south pole energy. The force-
field leaving the pole is seen to generate a circular-moving
vortex, whose speed appears greatest towards the center of
the magnetic field. With the center of the magnetic field
positioned in the center of the electronic screen, there is
produced a black spot exactly in the ield's center; it is here
that the field's rapid whirling motion is most clearly notice-
able. Surrounding this black spot, is a beautiful geometric
pattern consisting of severalbright colors, all intricately inter-
woven with each other. And except for the black spot, this
mosaic of colors blankets the entire surface of the screen
which measures approximately 17 inches square. When the
pole facing the screen is reversed,the general configuration of
the pattern remains the same, although there is a slight
change of the tint of the colors in the pattern, and a reversal
in the direction of magnetic field rotation is easily seen in the
black spot at the middle of the screen.

There is some controversy surrounding this instrument and


much of Davis's work. Dr. Hills states that this same pattern
alleged by Davis to be magnetic phenomena can be produced
by focusing a video camera on the crystals of a video screen.
This causes a feedback resonance loop by the interaction of
the light with the sceen crystals. A picture of the effect
under discussion is shown on the opposite page.

* lt hasbeenpointedout thattheeffectsobserved Davis'sdeviceare


on
in physicsby othermeans.
alsoreproducible
68
tI t*

Photographshowingthe geometricpatternof a magneticfield emanatingfrom a


bar magnet.The angulardark area in the foregroundis the magnetitself while
the more circular dark area representsthe center of the magneticfield as it
registerson Dr. Davis's"Magnetophotochronograph". (CourtesyDr. A. R, Davis)

69
Nevertheless, there was another device in Dr. Davis's labora-
tory that also demonstrated polarity differences and is worth
mentioning. This peculiar instrument converted magnetic
vibrations into audible sonic vibrations. As the small device
was switched on, there was a pervasive kind of humming
noise which Davis described as the combined electromagnetic
frequencies given off by all the objects in that one room of
his laboratory. A bar magnet was then taken and one of its
poles passed quickly back and forth across the surface of the
device, but without any contact between the instrument and
the magnet. This movement produced a sound with a distinct
tonal pitch. The magnet was then reversed, and its opposite
pole passed over the detection device, just as before. This
time, a different pitch, much lower than that produced by
the other pole, was clearly audible. The sonic frequency
patterns generated by the respective poles of a single magnet
were obviously different.

Or. A. Boy Davis demonstrat-


ing one of th many e|ctronic
measuring devices used in his
research,
Sclence has not yet tested this
;il machine or concept and dis-
putes most of Davis's research.
In the interest o scientlfic
truth the matter needs to be
carefully lnvestigated and
provod once and for all,

70
HILLS'MODEL More recent research by Dr, Hills has indicated that the laws
OF MAGNETISM of magnetism follow a combination of the old concepts and
the Davis-Sierra model. Hills' model is illustrated below
(42,P.156).

The foregoing arguments and illustrations relating to polar


differences suggestonly part of the basis upon which several
leading biomagnetic researcherspositively maintain that there
is a critical distinction to be made between the quality of
negative and positive polar energies.If these investigations are
correct in their postulations, it may give us cause to reconsider
much of what is currently being taught regarding magnetism.
However, biomagnetic evidence for a qualitative difference
between magnetic poles does not end with physics -- it
extends to medical, biological, and animal behavioral modes
as well.

'7t
MEDTCAL/BTOLOGTCAL On the basis of laboratory experiments, Drs. Davis and
APPLICATIONS Sierra insist that the two energiesof a magnet affect biological
systems (and behavior patterns) in different ways. Dr, Sierra
states that "North and south pole magnetism, together,
interpenetrate all life on earth," and claims "they combine in
a kind of Go, No-Go computer system. Whereas the north
pole acts to restrain growth, the south pole acts to promote
life" (C-1). The north pole checks, arrests,retards. The south
pole increases, rejuvenates, accelerates. The south pole of a
magnet applied to the positive cell nucleus results in faster
cell replacement, while the north pole applied to the negative
cell membrane, controls and stabilizes excessivecell mortality
(C.1). North pole energy attracts the potassium ion necessrry
to maintain the cell in a healthy condition. The north pole
dissolves cholesterol and fatty deposits limiting blood flow
(C-1). The south pole must be kept away from all bacterial
infections and viri; it must not be applied to an inflamed
mucous membrane. Cancer and tumor growths spread rapidly
with south pole energy applied. Conversely, cancer and
tumor growths are retarded by the presence of north pole
energy (C-l).
The pH factor also appears to be related to magnetic energy.
Dr. Sierra reports that, if the north pole of a cylinder magnet
is placed in a glass of water for a few minutes, it will give a
mildly acid reading on. a pH detector, while the south pole,
(positive polarity) when placed into water, shows a slightly
alkaline effect (C-1). In another experiment involving the pH
factor, Dr. Davis exposed several hen eggsto a magnetic field,
while a control group of eggs were left unexposed. Both
groups were carefully broken and the relative amounts of
acidity and alkalinity measured. The exposed eggs contained
slightly less acid in the yolk and more alkaline in the whites
than the unexposed eggs(22, P. 43).

72
Another illustration demonstrating the differing biological
effects of positive and negative magnetic energy, involves the
use of water. It will be recalled from earlier discussions that
water is easily polarized by a magnetic influence. Dr. Sierra,
as a part of his ongoing laboratory experiments, has what he
calls a "magnetic garden," the soil of which is irrigated with
polarized water. He reports that plants watered with south
polarized water grow shorter and thicker than plants watered
with north polarized water. South watered plants, he says,
produce fruits that are larger and sweeter, and that this is
particularly noticeable with plantain and banana plants. [n
contrast, north watered plants tend to grow tall and slender,
and are generally weaker than plants watered with south
polaized water (C-1).

Among the wide range of physical complaints treated by


biomagnetic research* is that of pain due to calcifications
and arthritic spurs. Under given conditions, north pole
magnetic energy acts to dissolve mass deposits accumulating
at bone joints. In other kinds of cases where excessivebleeding
is involved, the north pole functions to restrict blood flow.
In yet other instances, treatment with both north and south
pole can be alternated, for example, in a weakened condition
where infection is also present. A quick exposure to the
south pole will provide needed strength to the organism; this
is then followed by a north pole application to control
infection (C-1).

* Magneticfields used by Dr. Davis for biologicaltreatmentare


essentiallyconfinedto thoseproducedby a permanent magnet,and
usuallydo not exceed4,500 gauss.Davisexplainsthat when field
strengthgoesabove3,500 gauss,its ability to renderbeneficialtreat-
ment to a biologicalsystemgenerallydecreases.He furtherpointsout
that in mosttreatmentsusingmagnetsof 300 to 500 gauss,he prefers
to keep the magnetabout 3 inchesaway from the treatedsurface,
althoughthe measurable energytransmitted may extendfour to five
inchesaway from the magnet'spolarsurface.Somemagnetsof 1,000
gaussor morehave a measurab|e energytransmisson as muchas 18
inchesawayfromtheirpo|arsurfaces. Thedistance overwhchmagnetic
energiescan be measured will depend,in part,on thesensitivity
of the
measuring deviceused(D).
73
NORTH.SOUTH Within the context of north-south polar distinctions, it
ANIMAL BEHAVIOR would be well to review some of the laboratory findings
which relate to animal behavioral differences, as examined
under separate polar influences. This information is provided
by Dr. A. R. Davis and results from experiments carried out
in his laboratory.

A series of experiments were conducted using baby chicks.


Fertilized eggs were exposed to a magnet for 10 hours, then
placed in a hatcher. The hatcher had previously been fitted
with the south pole of a magnet exposed in a corner opposite
the eggs. First, it was observed that the eggs hatched sooner
than the expected 2l-day norm. Then, as soon as the chicks
emerged, still wet, they proceeded immediately for the south
pole of the magnet in the opposite corner. There they all
cuddled up in front of the magnet, apparently sensing a kind
of motherly strength, In another similar experiment, newly
born chicks were placed in a cage with a horseshoe magnet
placed in the far end of the cage. Each chick, in turn, lay
down in front of the magnet for five to seven minutes, then
returned to the farthest end of the cage and remained there
with the other chicks. This experiment, Davis explains, was
repeated several times, always with the same result. When the
real magnet was replaced by a wooden dummy of the same
shape and size, none of the chicks paid it any attention. In
still another situation fertile eggstreated with negative,notth
pole energy produced a taller, more sensitive,more intelligent
bird at maturity. This was contrasted by birds similarly
treated by positive, south pole energy; up to a certain point
of their growth, they too exhibited advanced intelligence.
But as these south-exposed chicks grew older, they developed
into vicious meat-eaters, quite unlike the normal, timid
characterexpected ofthis type ofbird.
Dr. Davis surmises that the observed behavioral aberrations
are attributable to changes in DNA, RNA, and the resultant
genetic coding of the fertilized egg. There were no further
appreciable behavioral changes, once the animals reached
maturity. It appears from this that a permanent character
imprinting takes place once the unborn chick is exposed to
the experimental field before hatching.
'74
The result of another group of experiments conducted with
mice paralleled, in some aspects, those carried out with
chicks, though in the case of the mice, Dr. Davis observed
that behavioral patterns were somewhat more complex. The
living habits of separategroups of female mice were observed
-- some under the influence of the north pole, others
exposed to south pole energy. South pole mice were seen to
bestow more care upon their offspring, both at birth and
afterwards. They also exhibited cleaner living habits, suffered
less labr pains and had an easier delivery of their offspring
than did the north pole mice (22,P.60).

Other mice treated prenatally by north and south magnetic


fields, subsequently showed distinct modes of behavior
attributable to their particular polar influence. Mice in group
(A) were exposed to south pole magnetic influence prior to
birth. As they matured, they exhibited tremendous physical
strength and stamina, but were mentally dull, insensitive,
unclean, and indulged in sexual intercourse to the point of
self-annihilation. Group (B) mice were treated prenatally by
north pole energy. At birth, they were thin and highly
susceptible to diseases, but upon maturing, they showed a
high degree of intelligence. Group (B) mice were neat and
clean in their living habits. Their awarenessto light, odor, and
sound vibrations was especially keen. They were, in short,
very much more aware of all that occured in their environ-
ment. But with all their intelligence, group (B) mice died
quickly, their life span lasting much less than normal. So in
an attempt to program an animal with the strength of those
in group (A) and the intelligence of those in group (B), mice
treated prenatally under north pole conditions were taken at
birth and placed under south pole influences. The result of
this dual field exposure was to produce an animal that
retained all the intelligence of the previous group (B), while
maturing towards the strength of those in group (A), but as
soon as this animal reached maturity, it killed itself by over-
indulgence in sexual intercourse. At last report, Dr. Davis was
still looking for a solution to his newest problem (D).

'75
GEOMAGNETIC TRENDS It will be recalled that the main component of the earth's
IN BIOLOGICAL field, its dipole aspect, is visualized as being similar to that
EVOLUTION produced by a permanent bar magnet, wherein the intensity
of the magnetic field strength decreases from the polar
extremities, where it is always strongest, towards a null area
at the magnet's mid-point, the magnetic equator. There is
abundant evidence which suggeststhat this basic geomagnetic
dipole field periodically reverses itself, and in so doing,
modifies extant biological systems.

By extracting circular drill cores from the sides of ancient


volcanoes, geologists can determine, by various dating
methods, what the earth's magnetism was like thousands,
even millions of years ago. One report, based on the atomic
dating of volcanic rock, shows that the earth's field has
reversed no fewer than nine times within the last four million
years (22, P. 120). Amplifying this position, Dr. P. J. Smith
of England points out that the earth's ield polarity has
reversed numerous times since four and a half million years
ago (17, P.25I-255). Japanese researcher Dr. T. Nagata
further substantiates this with the observation that one such
reversal occurred about a million years ago, at which time the
strength of the magnetic field was smaller than at present
(3, P. 440). British Professor E. C. Bullard gives additional
credence to the question of field reversals in stating that
"reversals take place in a surprisingly short time, probably in
one or two thousandyears" (17, P.71). And further on the
point of ''revesalperiodicity,', Dr' D. W. Allen of Cambridge
University believes that the earth's main field may have
oscillation periods of several thousand years, and reversalsof
the field at intervalsof hundreds of thousandsof years (D-1).

Within recent years it has been demonstrated that ocean


sediments are magnetized in the direction of the prevailing
earth's field at the time of deposition. Based on investigations
of fossil magnetism of deep sea sediments, John Foster of the
Columbia University Geological Observatory reveals that the
layers of sea sediments which recorded reversals were

86
correlated with layers that indicated an abrupt change in the
populations of tiny marine animals (22,P.166). Supporting
these findings are Brian Funnel and Christopher Harrison of
the Scripps Institution of Oceanography; they have reported
a similar correlation of mass extinction of marine life in
mid-Pacific sediments, which dates at 700,000 years ago, the
time of the last geomagneticreversal(22,P. t17).
It is explained that during a reversal, the strength of the
field gradually wanes, eventually reaching a minimum, where-
upon it begins building up again in the opposite direction.
The ultimate outcome is a complete switch in the relative
positions of the north and south poles.

In 1968, physicist Keith McDonald, an environmental


scientist, and Robert Gunst of the U.S. Coast and Geodetic
Survey calculated that the strength of the earth's magnetic
field has decreasedby 15 percent since A.D. 1670, and that
if the decline continues at its present rate, the field will fade
away completely in 2,023 years. They estimate that for 500
years before A. D. 399I, and for as long as 2,000 years after-
wards, the earth's field will be so weak that it will not
perform its usual function of trapping the high-velocity
radiations streaming from the sun, Such changes occurring
world-wide, the scientists explain, might cause lush valleys to
become barren wastes,deserts to bloom, icecaps to grow and
cover land areas, or to melt, thereby raising sea levels enough
to bring about massiveflooding (22,P.ll9).
Another team of investigators,Drs. t. K. Cain and P. C. Cain
of Australia, and Dr. M. G. Plaut of Canada, have traced
magnetic polarity conditions over a period of 350 million
years. Of particular interest in their findings is the discovery
of a peak period of geomagnetic field strength about 80
million years ago (D-l ). From anthropological data, we know
that this date correlates favorably with a flourishing period of
the gigantic mesozoic animals. It has been suggested that
during this time, the earth's field strength measured as much
as 300 gauss.Some researchersfeel that certain fossil deposits
of land animals also point to a relationship between their size
and the strength of the geomagnetic field at the time of
deposition (C-2\.
81
Drs. Allen Cox and A. Brent Dalrymple, in delineating
periods of polarity reversal, explain that the present earth's
polarity has existed for about 700,000 years. For a period of
1.8 million years before that, called the Matuyama Epoch,
the polarity was reversed. Before that, between 3.36 million
and 2.5 million years ago, there was the Gauss Epoch, during
which time the polarity was the same as it is today (D-l).

Polarity
epochs

Normal
data Jaramillo
Field normal event
Field reversed
Reversed
Data

0.0 1.0 3.0 4.0


Potassium-Argonage.in .|06 years
Schedule for the Earth's magnetic field reversalsovethe past four mil|i6n yg613,according to U.S. Geological Survey researchen
Cox and Dalrymple.

But the study of paleological magnetic field reversalsis not


just a straightforward geological matter, for it is further
complicated by biological speculation as to the condition of
faunal life on earth at the time of field reversal.Dr. R.J. Uffen
a Canadian Geophysicist, asserts that evolutionary surges
would occur at every polarity reversal of the earth's magnetic
field. He maintains that the geophysical field is reduced for a
short period, geologically speaking, during which time the
Van Allen radiation belts would spill on the earth's atmo-
sphere, and solar wind would bathe the earth. There would
then be high radiation dose rates and rapid evolution at a
polarity reversal(17,P.260).

88
Expanding on this position, Dr. D. I. Black of England
explains that certain radioactive isotopes, known to be
produced by cosmic rays and solar flares, would increase in
concentration during polarity reversal of the earth's ield.
When incorporated in the genes, these isotopes could
conceivably destroy the genes from the violence of their
decay thereby resulting in mass faunal extinctions (17 , P. 260).
But there has yet been no conclusive relation established
between field reversals and faunal evolutionary surges. And
some of the more reserved scientists maintain that such
causal evidence is still circumstantial and fragmentary.
Nevertheless,it has been suggestedthat the earth's magnetism
was of far greater intensity during the age of the great
mammals (ca. 80 million years ago), and that as the magnet-
ism weakened through the ages,the remains of animals found
at various levels in the earth's crust also grew smaller (C-2).

A solar prominence205.000
miles high. photographedin violet light of the
calcium K line, July 2. 1957. (Hale Observatories.)

89
7

Historical records give additional evidence of the decreasing


strength of the earth's field. C. S, Gauss is the first person
known to have measured the earth's magnetic field; this was
early in the 19th century. Since then, the total magnetic
moment of the earth has been steadily decreasingattherate
of five percent its total value per century (16). This further
means that such a rhythm of decrease would result in the
total disappearance of the field by the year 4,000. Dr, W. M.
Elsasser, however, suggeststhat there is evidence that in the
last few years, the rate of decline has slowed down, and that
in the near future, the earth's magnetic field strength may
start a swing upward (16). Thus, it appears that earth's
inlrabitants may not face any immediate, dire biological
consequences resulting from the extinction of the magnetic
field, or even of its reduction below tolerable limits.

If, then, the mounting evidence in favor of geomagnetic


polarity reversals as the causal factor in mass faunal changes
is accurate, we are provided with an important explanation of
how entire species of new life forms might be generated.The
lowering of the earth's field, it seems, would not only permit
harmful biological mutations to occur among extant fauna,
but could, at the same time, produce genetic mutations
conducive to the proliferation of entirely new species.Given
the foregoing conditions, we might conclude that those life
forms currently inhabiting the earth are those which through
the eons of evolution have become selectively adapted to the
present strength of the earth's magnetic field.

90
BIOLOGICAL SENSITIVITY Witfun the past decade, various research teams headed by
TO GEOMAGNETIC FORCES Dr. Frank A. Brown Jr. of Northwestern University have
made very significant discoveries regarding the sensitivity of
biological systems to weak magnetic fields. Working primarily
with planaria and snails, Brown has established conclusively
that even these simple biological systems readily respond to
changes in a weak magnetic environment of the order of the
earth's own. In the tests with snails, the following field
strengthswere used: .0410.110.210.81215110 gauss(28). The
snals proved sensitive to all those field strengths,but beyond
certain limits, the animals apparently became confused and
no longer responded normally. It seems the snails became
saturated when the field strength exceeded certain limits.

Based on his experiments with planaria, Brown observed


that the degree of demonstrated sensitivity suggests that
planaria are steadily appraised of the earth's natural field.
Brown reports that the degree of sensitivity is seen to surpass,
by many times, that required for the organism to become
aware of a thundercloud several miles away. Speculation is
that the magneto-receptive mechanism is in some way
associated with the photoreceptive apparatus (29). Following
a series of experiments co-authored by Dr. F, H. Barnwell,
the two researchersoffer these observations:

"There remains no reasonable doubt that living systems are extra-


ordinarily sensitive to magnetic fields. By extremely simple experiments,
it is shown that highly diverse types of plants and animals may have
their orientation modified by artificial fields of the order of strength of
the geomagnetic field. The systematic and periodic alterations in the
strength and character of biological response suggest a higbly differen-
tiated response mechanism within the organism . . the nature of the
response properties suggest that the organism is normally integrated
with its geomagnetic environment to a striking degree. Clearly, the
perceptive mechanism for weak magnetic fields is not an independent
system functionally isolated from the remainder of the living organism"
(1).

9l
on the basis of current research' it is now firly certain that
the intensity of magnetic energy required to evoke behavioral
changes in most biological systems is relatively little. In this
connection, Dr. Jeno Barnothy has observed, "It is not far
fetched to assume that living creatures become not only
accustomed to the geomagnetic field as part of their natural
habitat, but that in some of them, biological processes have
evolved which could be influenced by fields of the order of
the geomagneticfield, i.e. a fewtenths ofan oersted"(1, P. I 1).

A classic demonstration in physics is to illustrate that the


mere movement of a coil of wire through space will set up a
flow of current in the coil; this occurs because, as the coil
cuts through the earth's invisible lines of magnetic force, a
current flow is naturally induced.

An analogous,neural mechanism is thought to be responsible


for the homing pigeon's accuracy in flight. With a network of
sensitive nerve fibers throughout the bird's body, correspond-
ing to the experimental coil of wire, minute electrical signals
would be relayed to the brain as the pigeon flies, cutting the
geomagnetic lines of force. The character of the signals reach-
ing the brain would indicate to the bird if his geographic
bearings are correct, until he reaches the vicinity of his
destination, whereupon his visual familiarity with local land-
marks would guide him to his final perch. It has been noticed
that when a homing pigeon is released away from home, it
immediately soars upwards and swoops around in large
circles, as if sensing for the proper direction for its homeward
flight. Only after this ritual does the bird head off on its
course.

When a wire loop rotatesin a mag-


netic f ield, the induced current
flows alternately in opposite
directions.

92
Early investigations with pigeons suggested that their
homing apparatus was affected whenever a radio station was
established in the vicinity of their usual flight paths. Many
birds became confused as to which course of flight to take.
This led researchers to speculate that the pigeon's homing
instinct was somehow dependent upon vibrations of an
electromagnetic nature - undoubtedly those of the earth's
magnetic field. The effect, then, of a new radio station
transmitter was that it probably presented the birds with
strange vibrations which overrode those of the normal earth's
magnetic field.

If the neurological network of planaria, snails, and pigeons


is sophisticated enough to offer an acute sensitivity to the
presence of the geomagnetic field, what then must be the
limits of human sensitivity to extremely subtle electro-
vibratory phenomena? It would be difficult to conceive of
man, with many miles of sensitive nerve fibres lacing his
entire body, as being any less responsive to very weak electro-
magnetic vibrations than are his fellow creatures of much
lower phylum.

Several investigatorshave commented on the acute sensitivity


of the integrated human organism to subtle electro-vibratory
energies. Dr. Henry Tomlinson, a leading British researcherin
Radiesthesia, points out that "there is no man-made instru-
ment so sensitive as the human body, which reacts to all the
forces of nature, each in a specific wayr''$ (10, P. 45). The
early biomagnetic work of Dr. Abrams, Tomlinson says,
showed that the sensitivity of the muscular system, both
voluntary and involuntary, surpasses any human-devised
detector. Also, the findings of Dr. Kholodov seem to support
the position held by both Abrams and Tomlinson. In experi-
ments he conducted with isolated organs and tissues in a
static magnetic field, Kholodov found that a greater field
strength was required to elicit a biological response than in
experiments with an integral organism ( I, P. 196).

93
The De La Warrresearchers furthersubstantiatethe concept
of an integratedorganism'sextreme sensitivityto magnetic
radiation,with their discoverythat magneticeffectsare more
likely to be amenable to detection in terms of a whole
organism'sresponsein vivo, rather than in isolated tissuesin
vitro (22,P. l2l-122). It wasthis rationale,the high sensitivity
and complexity of the human nervoussystem,which led the
De La Warr group to prefer human subjects(as opposedto
animals) in most of their biomagneticexperiments.They
point out that the humanorganismhas evolvedas a systemof
great precision,constantlyadjustingitself to changes,and is
incredibly sensitive to all energies. Accordingly, the
De La Warr-invented "Reflexograph", records ,the actual
physical change that takes place when the human body is
subjected to various kinds of energy radiations,including
light, sound, and magnetism.When a magnetis held nearthe
seventh cervical vertebra,the reflexographdetects a reflex
movementat the wrist. A single 75 amperesolenoidplaced
at the neck was sufficientto elicit a reflex responseas remote
as the ankle .- so sensitiveis the body to magneticradiation
(8, P. l7). Becauseof their findings,the De La Warr investi-
gators have been led to postulate that all human tissue is
capable of respondingto some sort of magneticinfluence,
even though the complexity, or strengthof the field may
vary in many instances.

*
Some physicistsmay challengeTomlinson'sstatementon the grounds
that the body does not registerradio frequenciesor other such subtle
radiations;however,Tomlinson is speakingas a trained radiesthesist
with a highly developedsenseof perception.

94
A D e L a W a r r p h o t o g r a p hs h o w i n gt h r e em a g n e t i cf i e l d sb e i n ga p p l i e ds i m u l t a n e o u s tl yo
differentparts of the body. The apparatusin use.calledthe MT/3, is capableof handling
a s m a n y a s t e n s o l e n o i d sa t o n e t i m e . R e s e a r c h e rcsl a i m t h a t b o d y t i s s u e si n p r o x i m i t y
to and distantfrom the fieldsshow a responseto externallyappliedmagentism.

95
LeonardP. Corte, Director
De La Warr Laboratorv

ry
ffiry

Demonstratingthe sensitivityof the human beingto magnetism.


A bar magnetis held one inch from th7th cervicalvertebraand
the reflex action is recorded by the reflexograph.

96
Continuing, this same group of scientists reports that human
tissues have the capacity to transduce pressure waves, e.&
sound waves into electrical stimuli primarily by means of the
pacinian corpuscles (also known as "mechanoreceptors")
located in the body tissues. The frequency range of the
human body's transducing cells is said to lie between 50 and
800 cycles per second (ll, P.13). It is suggestedthat
combined sonic frequencies can effect a state of resonance
with specific cell structures, particularly for therapeutic
purpses. The De La Warr goup explains that the frequency
transmission faculty of tissues will vary with their state of
health, and with whatever extraneous energy that happens to
be acting upon them at the time of transmission(11, P. 54).

Researcher-writer George Lakhovsky believes that the


human organism is very delicately balanced within the matrix
of natural radiating forces present in the earth's environment.
He maintains that because of the irregular distribution of
mineral constituents within the earth's surface some radiations
of extraterrestrial origin, when they strike the eatth, are
absorbed, while others are refracted, causing criss-cross
vibrations or "interruptions" to be set up. These apparently
affect the organism, disrupting normal cell division, and
producing various diseases,including cancer, which is seen to
be particularly prevalent on certain soils (25, P.213).

And then, there is a very curious report of organismic


sensitivity to magnetic fields related by Dr. Bhattacharya,
that at a certain magnet manufacturing company, all of the
married male workers have produced only male offspring
since their employment with the firm. For over seven hours a
day, the men are engagedin the production and processing of
various types of magnets. Bhattacharya suggeststhat this is a
phenomenon worthy of closer investigation (22, P.98\.

In attempting to assess the sensitivity of biological systems


to electro-vibratory forces we should be clear that there are
many kinds of geophysical forces, each with its own peculiar
rhythm, to which a living system can respond.

97
The biological rhythms of all life forms are found to be
inseparable from light, gravity, barometric pressure, and ion
density, to mention only a few of the known causative forces
operative in our environment. Thus, one is well cautioned
not to ascribe to geomagnetism, as such, all rhythmically
recurring patterns in living systems. The sun, aside from
sending forth magnetic emanations, also produces thermal
oscillations and a whole host of additional vibrations which
undoubtedly contribute, in some way, to both somatic and
behavioral changes in life forms. A particular system which is
photosensitive, for example, would respond to relative
degreesoflight and darkness, whereas a change in the external
magnetic field might fail to trigger its mechanisms. Some
biomagnetic researchers,however, feel that in any considera-
tion of the various geophysical forces which can be identified
as responsible for shaping habits and behavior patterns, the
prevailing magnetic field plays a predominating role in
relation to other geophysical factors.

n, That there is linkage of an electro-vibratory character


c' binding together biomagnetic, geomagnetic, and extraterres-
)sp trial magnetic forces, is a fairly certain proposition, which
.\e\o\? I i.'' few who have investigated the matter would dispute -- the
.,--\"!trl7/p
\,_\\ \ /2.,_ --- question is one of deciphering the nature of the interconnect-
\ ing mechanism. Veteran philosopher-scientist Professor Oliver
r -=il1-;_-.= *o
Reiser has commented on the difficult task of finding a
bridge between the various'dimensions of "electro-vibratory"

-zir'f11\N
o-/ - r , tJ : \ -
-
energies present in the universe. He feels that "there are
'{z7tt,\ certainly genic terrestrial, and celestial force-fields involved;
but the precise relations between the bioelectric fields of the
v- ,1-\b\o human body and the geomagnetic and solar fields are not
oo t clear" (3, P.430), Reiser has also speculatedthat the broad
spectrum of electro-vibratory forces associated with our sun
as well as with our galaxy as a whole, might affect the
behavior of human populations (3, P. 463466\. He further
suggests that the sun acts as a mediator, a kind of relay
station, in conveying vibratory influences from other planets
into earth (3,P.436).

98
MAGNETISM AND The use of magnetic energies to prolong and enhance life
AGING was not unknown to ancient societies. Various accounts have
come down to the present day of Asian and Egyptian rulers
who wore magnetic jewelry next to their skin, the "Divine
Force" of the magnet supposedly imparting to its wearer,
longevity, virilty, and certain increased mental powers.
Cleopatra is reputed to have used a magnet tiara on her fore-
head, which was intended to help her maintain her beauty.
And one of the Kings of Zeiland (Ceylon or Sri Lanka) is said
to have had all his meals servedon plates made of loadstone,
believing that this practice would preserve the vigor of his
youth. Several early writers and philosophers are reported to
have commented on the magnet's mysteriouspower. Homer,
Aristotle, Lucretius, and St. Augustine all left written
referencesto that strange"Binding" force associatedwith the
loadstone.
But the use of magnetism in controlling aging processes is
not limited to royalty of ancient times. In 1964 Dr. E. K.
Maclean, a New York Gynecologist and cancer researcher,
was 64 years old, but was said to have looked 451'he had
been exposing himself daily to a 3,600 gauss magnetic field
for about 5 years. Maclean had a full head of dark brown
hair. And he further claimed that many of his cancer patients,
w {'s. or. st6rr ed Pwjib|n capdr, w'jq hx fu*{!r.6sn{!
most of them elderly individuals, had experienced a restora-
tion of their original hair pigmentation, changing in most
cases from silvery white to its natural color of their younger
years. About his research,Maclean maintains "Cancer cannot
exist in a strong magnetic field" (23).

In private conversations with Dr. Sierra, he revealed that


before he began biomagnetic research several years ago, his
hair was thinning and greying, and that he himself was
weaker and older-looking than at present. To some extent,
the writer was able to verify the truth of Dr. Sierra's claim,
by comparing his present appearance with that of an earlier
photograph which he had in his laboratory -- there was a
visible difference along the lines he had indicated. The effect
of magnetism in relation to aging, insofar as humans are
concerned, has been largely confined to observational
accounts,like those related above.
But a much closer look at these processeshas been taken in
laboratory experiments, using small animals, particularly
mice. Dr. Jeno Barnothy reports that in one experiment the
effect of a magnetic field was to slow down mitotic cellular
activities in general (1, P. 100). He further points out that
magnetic influence has retarded the growth of young mice
and lengthened the gestation period of pregnant mice
(1, P. 100). Supporting this position is Dr. Leonid Repin, a
Russian scientist, who asserts that a strong magnetic field
inhibits the development of the fetus. The stronger the field,
the greater the inhibiting effect. New-born mice which had
been prenatally exposed to a magnetic ield weighed 20
percent less than normal. Mice exposed to a magnetic field
when young grew bald later than those which had not been
exposed (24).
From a wide variety of sources, there is an amazing consis-
tency in research findings relating to the influence of magnet-
ism on the aging processes of laboratory mice. Dr. Harold
Alexander, North American Aviation Corporation, found that
mice increased their life span up to 45 percent when exposed
to magnetic fields. In one case, a mouse attained an age
equivalent to 90 years in humans (D-1). Dr. Robert Becker
reports that one of the early biomagnetic researchers,
L. Tchijevsky, probably by experimentally causing a decrease
in the earth's natural magnetic field, brought about a rapid
onset of death in rats beingtestedundertheseconditions (18).
Dr. Madeline Barnothy found that animals treated in their
youth in a magnetic field reached their old age with a far
lower number of genetic errors. She claims that treatment at
an advanced age, when the genetic errors are more or less
incorporated, tended to be less effective (1, P. 87). Dr. Sierra
reports on a pair of rats which he maintained under the
simultaneous influence of both magnetic poles. These rats, he
says, seemed as if they would never die, they acted very
friendly and were full of life at all times. The animals
eventually died when taken out of the 600 gauss field to
which they had become accustomed. Sierra concludes that

100
their systems had become accustomed to a high level of
magnetic energy radiation, which was transferred to all the
vital centers oftheir bodies, and that the rats could, therefore,
not exist in the 0.5 gauss aveageof the earth's field (C-1).

Dr. Davis, who over the years has done extensive experi-
mentation with various animals in magnetic fields, states that
the life span of a mouse can be extended or shortened by
direct and continuous exposure to certain magnetic fields. A
short exposure does not cause death, he confirms, but
prolonged exposure to high magnetic energy can cause
saturation of the animal's body, thereby producing chemical
changes for the worse, and eventually resulting in death
(22, P.67). Davis goes on to explain that a mouse normally
grows old in t l14 years, its activity is lowered, health fails,
aging processes set in and it usually dies within a short time.
If at the time aging processesbegin, the mouse is treated with
a magnetic field of 3,000 to 4,200 gauss for 2 hours a day,
once in the morning and again in the evening for 3 or 4
months, it looks younger. Mice which were treated in tfus
way become more active, gained weight, shed all aging
symptoms and finally appeared like mice of 6 or 8 months
old. One mouse who had reached an age of 625 days, was
treated as described above and lived for anothe yea
(22,P.69).

On a visit to Dr. Davis' facilities, the writer saw his "labora-


tory mice," several of which were incredibly large rodents.
These hefty creatures, Davis explained, ranged in age from a
few months to one which, atthe time of this writer's investi-
gation, was almost 4 years old. Both their size and their
longevity were attributed to the specialized magnetic environ-
ments under which they were conceived and developed.

101
AUTONOMIC NERVOUS SYSTEM
AND
MAGNETISM
AUTONOMIC NERVOUS SYSTEM AND MAGNETISM

-l
Locrlmolglond

Sollvory glond Sollvory glond


Ciliory gonglion

Csrvico I
gongl ion

Thoocic cod

gonglion

Smoll splonchnic

Lumbor cord

Inf r ior
m s 6nle|c
9on9lion
Urinory bloddci Pelvic Urlnory blodder
n e ve
Socrol cord

Gonods . ser occessories Filum lorninolg


Gonods. sox occassorlar

I PARASYMPATHETICI
| (cronio-socrol) |

Diagramof the autonomic nervoussystem.The parasympathetic system


is shown on the left, the sympathetic system on the right. Boman
numeralsreferto the numbersof the cranialnerves.

103
BRAIN RESPONSES The total human nervous system is a network of unimagin-
able complexity, regulating varied life processes extending
from subtle glandular secretions to the more gross motor
activity of the limbs, and even to the determination of
behavioral patterns. From a biological point of view, it is the
central nervous system which administrates these disparate
functions, combining them into a coherent whole. Consequent-
ly, if magnetism is capable of affecting the central nervous
system, we might expect a concomitant influence upon those
processes dependent upon the central nervous system.

Dr. N. S. Hanoka of Harligen, Texasrhas reported on some


of the Russian research findings in connection with the brain
and magnetism. He points out that it is definitely known that
powerful magnetic fields slow down some basic life processes,
and increase the sensitivity of certain nerves (D-l). There is
the further effect of lowering the brain's responses to some
stimuli, and raising the level of reaction to other influences.
A rather disturbing effect noted by Hanoka is that of some
magnetic fields affecting the brain's ability to control normal
body motions. But a discovery of even greater magnitude,
and with farther reaching implications from a behavioral
standpoint, is that powerful magnetic fields can act directly
upon the highest center of the human brain - the cerebral
cortex (D-t1.*

In another area of investigation, Dr. Hanoka reports that


Russian space researchers have found that changes in the
magnetic fields of outer space can produce a decreasein the
rate of mental processes,cause weariness and distress, or
induce sleep. Additional experiments have been conducted
with fighter pilots and space ship crews in an effort to
control, by means of magnetism,emotional distressand panic
during in-flight emergencies (D-1 ).
Animal experiments, too, have contributed to our present
understanding of magnetic-neuralinteractions. Working with
fish, Dr. M. N. L. Livanov, of the Institute of Higher Nervous
* Dr.ChristopherHillshasbaseda wholeareaof studyon thefactthat
braincellsgrowtowardsareasof greatest (46).
stimulation.

r04
Activity and Neurophysiology, Moscow, found that as the
fish learned to detect magnetic force, profound changes in
brain responses occurred (D-l). In a related development,
Dr. Y. A. Kholodov, Livanov's colleague of the same institu-
tion, demonstrated, also with fish, that a magnetic field has a
biological effect, which most easily manifests itself in the
brain. The brain, he suggests,is the first organ of the body to
respond directly, without any intermediate stages, to the
appearance of a magnetic field (24). Kholodov says that the
fact that a magnetic field has such an especially strong effect
on fish, can perhaps be explained by the peculiar structure of
their central nervous system, as well as by the probable
influence of the magnetic field on water (1,P. 197).

Dr. Kholodov has also conducted experiments on other


animals in order to determine brain responses to magnetic
fields. In one test, he placed rabbits and cats in a magnetic
field for several hours, after which he studied microscopic
sections of the brain. He found that the glial cells (cells
associated with the brain neurons) were enlarged and had
increased in number apparently because of the magnetic
field. After some time, the cells regained their natural state.
The conclusion drawn was that the magnetic field somehow
interfered with the metabolism of the glial cells (24). This
same Russian researcher reveals that ionizing radiation and
high frequency magnetic fields exert direct influence on the
diencephalon of animals. In a series of experiments with
rabbits, he found that the structures of the forebrain and
diencephalon, deprived of nervous connection with the
receptors, react to a static magnetic field more often, more
rapidly, and more intensively than an intact brain (1, P. 199).
lt was assumed, on the basis of these findings, that a static
magnetic field exerts direct, non-specific action on the
central nervous system of vertebrates. Further studies at the
Moscow lnstitute suggestthat some center in the brain acts as
a receptor of magnetic force, and that the animal's brain can
be permanently changed by magnetism to develop a magnetic
sense(D-1).

10s
Returning to references on the human brain, it is suggested
that properly applied magnetic fields can provide beneficial
stimulation to the brain, and that some research efforts
have given rise to speculation about subtle differences between
the sexes and the magnetic orientation of the brain (D-1).
Dr. Becker, speaking on the interrelationship between neural
structures, magnetic fields and human behavior, says that
"we have discovered that the electromagnetic field in our
environment has a profound effect on behavior and biological
cycles. We believe the mechanism for its action is within the
central neryous system." Becker, and a fellow biomagnetic
pioneer, Professor F. A. Brown, seem convinced, on the basis
of numerous investigations which they have conducted
independently of each other, that the bioelectric field is the
link between celestial forces and human somatic and psycho-
logical functions (23).*

Cove of
Brohmo

4th
ventricle

cerebellum

s p i n a lc o r d

"The diagramshows "the Cave of Bramha" at lll referredto


in the Sanskrittexts as the seat of resonancewith the ONE
ocean of cosmic vibrations, lt manufacturesthe cerebro-
s p i n a l f l u i d i n l V w h i c h f l o a t st h e w h o l e b r a i n a n d s p i n a l
nerves. The chemical Ph of the fluid determines the
resonance."ChristopherHil ls, Supersensonics.

t06
Several biomagnetic investigators have verified that if the
natural polarity of a dog's brain is reversed by attaching
electrodesconnected to a low voltage battery to the skull --
positive in the front and negative in the back -- that uncon-
sciousness results. Researchersmaintain that a similar reversal
in the caseof the human brain can cause a state of depression,
while electrodes placed in accordance with normal brain
polarity induce feelings of serenity and contentment. In
fact,. it is speculated that the day is not too far off when
the manipulation of brain currents will be used as a means of
general anesthesia for surgical operations. Upon completion
of surgery, normal polarity would be restored with patient
feeling a minimum of post-operative pain.

The possibility of using magnetic therapy to correct


behavioral abnormalities caused by neural dysfunctions has
not escaped biomagnetic investigators. Dr. Bhattacharya of
India reports on two casesinparticular,one of brain palsy and
the other of epilepsy, where magnetic energy provided relief
(22, P. 77, and 78-90). In both instances,a serious deviation
from normal behavior was evident when Bhattacharya first
examined the patients. But with the placement of pernlanent
magnets at certain locations of the head and/or spine, the
pathological symptoms were eliminated, without recurrence
(22,P.77).

Together with the brain, the spine, as part of the central


nervous system, cannot be excluded from consideration as a
possible mediator of magnetic-influenced behavior, although
its role in this regard is presently much less clear than that of
the brain.

t07
Medical research by Dr. Aaron Friedell, M.D. and others
has shown that spinal fluids are largely alkaline in composi-
tion, and that alkalines Ireelectrically negative' while acids
are positive. Further investigations reveal that there are seven
energy vortices located along the spine. When the individual
is ill, these centers appear to slow down in their movement,
but are said to speed up with the application of magnetic
energy. The locations found to respond in this manner are
1st, 5th and 1th cervicals, 2nd, 4th and 6th dorsals, and the
5th lumbar spine (22, P. 143). A magnet applied to these
spots supposedly energizes the nervous system as a whole.

D r . A a r o n F r i e d e l l ,M . D .

Author of "May You Live in


Health", $3.95, availablefrom
University of the Trees Press.

108
BRAIN RHYTHMS We have discussed the interaction of the central nervous
system with magnetic fields, mainly from the perspective of
external fields being imposed upon the neural structures. But
it is not to be forgotten that the brain itself generatesregular
enegy waves of an electro-vibratory character, which are
detectable by the electroencephalograph (EEG). In the
parlance of the medical field, these brain waves are termed
"bioelectric", and the method by which they are recorded is
quito similar to oscillatory wave detection by the electrocar-
diograph device, in that the waves emitted are first amplified
and then recorded as graphs (F).

It is generally accepted that the brain's complex functions


are overwhelmingly electrical in nature, several different
frequencies being emitted from distinct parts of the brain's
surface. And while there seems to be some minor difference
between authorities as to the precise limits of the main
recognized oscillations, the table on page I I 1 can be taken
as representative of the principle frequency demarcations.

1 second

N o r m a l r h y t h m( a b o u t
1 0 c y c l e sp e r s e c o n d ) .
S u c h r e g u l a rb r a i n
w a v e s ,c h a r a c t e r i s t i c
of the relaxed state,
a r e c a l l e da l p h aw a v e s .

A l p h a b r a i nw a v e
a c t i v i t yi s h e r e b l o c k e d
w h e n t h e s u b j e c to p e n s
his eyes (arrow).

B r a i nw a v e s d u r i n g
rapideye movement
( R E M )s l e e p .

109
The strength of these emissions rangesfrom about 25 to 125
microvolts (F).* Each individual is recognizedto have a basic
oscillatory pattern peculiar to himself. This individualized
pattern will alter slightly from the brain's frontal region, to
the occipital region, to the parietal region, and so on, thus
producing minor frequency differencesat each section of the
brain, but all the while retaining its overall identifying charac-
teristics. Consequently, a brain wave reading on the EEG for
a particular individual would be shown as a single waveform,
but representingthe combined oscillations of all the brain's
distinct areas.

It is also generally establishedthat one's rate of breathing,


as well as sound vibrations and externally imposed magnetic
fields, can considerably alter brain-generatedfrequencies(F).
And according to some authors, every mental activity can be
identified with its own peculiar frequency. Thus the modes
of altering, orientating, and discriminative behavior would
each have their specific rates of vibration,just as would fear,
joy, love and hate.x* Following this view, no human emotion
or mental activity should be without its associated and
characteristic vibration.
" In an experimentalsituationat the M,l.T., Dr,DavidCohenhasa
roomshielded from the earth'smagnetic field,in whichhe canstudy
magnetic as smallas that producedby the AlphaBhythm
fluctuations
of the humanbrain.This frequencyis detectable justoutsidethe head
andis saidto measureaboutoneten-billionth of a gauss(C-2).
** Currentresearch
doesnot fully supportthisclaim,sinceapparently
under some circumstances differentmental activitieshave similar
frequencies,
andsincethe samefrequency is sometimesassociatedwith
differentmentalactivities.
InventorLeeTracyand the BritishElectronics firm of Allen Interna-
tionalhaveproduced a machinedesigned for controllingriotouscrowds
or unruly individuals.
The devicereportedlyemitsultra-sonic sound
waves,in conjunctionwith ultra-visiblelight waves,which interfere
with the normalAlpha and Betawavepatternsof the humanbrain.
Personsexposedto theseemissions aresaidto experience vomit-
illness,
ing,anda generaldisorientation
of theirwillfulbehavior(211 .

110
T

BRAIN WAVE FREQUENCY


IN HERTZ
Delta Rhythm Ito 3ll2
Theta Rhythm 4to 7
Alpha Rhythm 8 to 13
Beta Rhythm l4 to 30

character|stic outpUt r q uenc|es


o EEG waves in Various regions
of the scalp (1 Hz = 1 cycle per
s e c o n d) .

Dr. Christopher Hills in his book Nuclear Evolution: The


Discovery o the Rainbow Body, carries these ideas over into
the theory that the human nervous system is both an absorber
and radiator of light energies and cosmic rays and that these
are controlled by the level of consciousnessof each individual.
He explains that the brain operates as a small radio transmit-
ter and receiver, the wavelength or frequency on which it
operates varying with the individual's physical and mental
development. He feels that what we call intelligence is largely
governed by the stage of the brain's development, and its
consequent frequency potentials.

Davis considers that the magnetic fields produced by the


human brain, in effect, act as invisible receptors, antennae,
which pick up various signals from the environment and
translate them into emotional attitudes. moods. and intuitive
esponses'

111
Nevertheless, the four major frequency plateaus known to
be produced by the human brain are also known not to travel
more than a few inches, or at most, a few feet away from the
surface of the skull. Hence, any information impressed upon
these carrier frequencies would also terminate just beyond the
brain's outer boundary. However, the Russians are reported
to have recently discovered a brain-generated frequency of
one hundred million (100,000,000) cycles per second, and
have named it the "Ultra-Theta". Vibrating at this rate, in
excess of the rate of television waves, Davis confirms that it
would be capable of extending around the world, and could
provide an explanation for telepathic transmission from brain
to brain, over extremely long distances (D)*. This then,
suggests an incredible range of frequencies attainable by the
human brain -- vibrations extending from I to 100,000,000
cycles per second - truly an astounding thing to ponder!
And if, indeed, this latest alleged discovery is fact, then it
suggests that the popularly recognized rhythms detected by
the EEG are merely the beginning, that there may be multitu-
dinous frequencies intervening between the Beta Rhythms
and the "new Ultra-Theta." One can only imagine to what
behavioral modes or states of consciousnesssuch frequencies
would correspond.

Having mentioned brain rhythms, a brief consideration


should be given to those structures thought to be responsible
for their production. The popular view held by most EEG
specialists is that the hypothalamus and the reticular forma-
tion are major emission centers of brain waves, and that the
cerebrum has a damping effect on the vibrations emitted by
these lower parts of the brain.

* Physicist
Zoltan Tarczy-Hornochpoints out that not only frequency
but also field strengthmust also be consideredin this instanceand that
the |ow fe|dstrengthof known brainwaves wou|dmake it unIike|ythat
they would be transmittedfar from the surfaceof the head.

tt2
The cerebrum, then, acts as a kind of modulation center,
gathering distinct oscillations from several sections of the
brain into a single waveform, the end product (F). Com-
menting in connection with work carried out in his labora-
tory, Dr. Becker explains that galvanomagnetic effects, how-
ever small, are obtained in the human nervous system; these
effects, he explains, are the result of interaction between the
flow of direct current electricity and steady or pulsating
magnetic fields. Becker believes that the brain stem reticular
formation is responsible for the creation of these neuro-
biological currents. He further suggests that the magnitude
and perhaps the polarity of cerebral current-flow directly
determinesthe level of consciousness.( 18).

It is curious to note that our level of consciousness


("awakeness"), and possibly our level of intellectual or
mental awareness, is associated with definite brain wave
patterns. EEG investigators know that when the subject
being tested is sleeping, the brain frequency is slower and the
amplitude higher than when awake (F). Dr. Becker has
elaborated on animal experiments which positively show that
a magnetic field of proper magnitude and orientation can
reduce consciousness to levels associated with general anes-
thesia, as judged by the EEG (18). In every instance when
field strengths of 2,500 gauss or more were applied, the EEG
pattern changed from that of a moderate amplitude Alpha to
a high amplitude Delta type wave, which is characteristic of
moderate to deep anesthesia. [n such cases, the animal
remained immobilized within the field of the magnet (18).
An additional implication growing out of these same experi-
ments was that certain magnetic fields might be capable of
changing the level of neural irritability sufficiently to
produce a deterioration in the performance of complex
tasks. And in this connection, we are reminded of the
magnetic researcher'sclaim that one's level of mental develop-
ment is greatly governed by the brain's frequency potentials.
If this assessment holds, it may eventually be possible to
evolve a system of determining certain mental faculties
according to cerebral frequency emissions.

ll3
Dr. Christopher Hills, in his book Supersensonicsrsets out
the specific frequency of each chakra which he claims operates
in a "subtle matter" range and outlines new instruments
which record the neuro-muscular detection of these energies.

NEURAL STIMULATION Various kinds of instruments and procedures have been used
DEVICES to administer magnetic treatment to the human nervous
system. The three situations described below involve perma-
nent magnetic or geomagnetic energies, and are reportedly
effective therapeutic approaches.

In t92I, A.E. Baines first describedhis therapeuticinvention,


called "Vitic." This device consisted of two horseshoe-shaped
magnets mounted several inches apart so that their poles
attracted each other. In the middle of the field created by the
two magnets, a steel rod was mounted. For treatment, a
subject merely placed his left hand around the steel rod,
while his right hand grasped a rod of graphite, which was also
an integral component of that Vitic apparatus. Once the
hands were in position, waves of magnetic energy were said
to suffuse the entire body. It was recommended that Vitic
treatment be administered once a day for ten minutes only,
as excessive use of the device was supposed to cause over-
stimulation, with insomnia as a result. The beneficial effects
claimed for Vitic were both biological and psychological.
Aside from the toning and generally increased vitality of all
the body's internal organs, the Vitic was thought to stimulate
''nerve
the body's force,'' thereby yieldng positive results in
c a s e so f n e r v o u sb r e a k - d o w n( 2 2 , P . 1 2 5 - 1 3 1 ) .

The picture shows a Hefigar, a modern


version of the Vitic apparatus,that incor-
poratesconceptsof stimulatedwave propa-
gation. 1t42,P. 1311

tt4
In conversations with Dr. Sierra, he revealed that it is
possible to use magnetism in the treatment of irritability and
depression associated with menopause. And in basic concept,
Sierra's application of the magnetic force is similar to that
described above with the "Vitic" device. The subject is
situated so that five magnets of 3,000 gauss each can be
placed at various locations surrounding the body; she remains
relaxed in this field for a half hour. Sierra explains that either
abnormal depression or elation, represents a disturbance of
the optimum frequency of the woman's own biomagnetic
field. The objective of the magnetic treatment is to restore
the individual's normal somatic magnetic balance. As a rule,
treatment of emotional disturbancesrequire that both negative
and positive polar energies be applied simultaneously. To
pEvLCt, accomplish this, Sierra uses permanent horseshoe-type
magnets(C).

Another technique, but involving a preventative rather than


a correctional therapeutic approach, was related by the
Russians. Apparently, in some of their hospitals, they have
constructed special rooms shielded with nickel, cobalt, and
steel.* At times of solar disruptions or solar-generated
magnetic storms, all critical heart and mental patients are
moved into these shelded rooms. Evidently, doctors had
observed over a period of time that patients suffereing from
mental and heart conditions, experience particularly violent
reactions during solar disturbances. The effect of the shielded
room is to cause the magnetic energy emitted by the sun, to
flow around the patients, rather than to penetrate their
bodies, as it otherwise would, thereby worsening an already
precariously balanced condition.

* D r . R e i t e r o f t h e P h y s i k a l i s c hB i o k l i m a t i s z h eF o r s c h u n g s s t e l l e ,
Skistadion,Westtor,81'Garmisch-Partenkirchen, Germany,refutesthis
c l a i m a n d s a y s i n B i o m e t e o r o l o g yv, o l u m e 5 , p a r t l l l , t h a t s u c h
shieldingmakesno difference.

115
BIOCLIMATOLOGY
AND
IONOTHERAPY
LII
'(ay)
ffi'upuilns'g'J'rG'suollceor
snourouolns 'outJcopuo
pue enttrelaben Jno lco+leuec suo!'lty '6uteq
-lloM Jno uo ocuanllur punoloJd e seq oqlpoJq 0M Jlp oql leql selPJls
.uoulop qcrqnn'e6pe1nnou) |ec|pauJ}o p|al} Mau }se^e sl 6o1o}eut;cotg
suor JT?Jo slceJJe eql
dVuaHIoNoI oNV coToIVWIfJoIfl
Man's notion that his meteorological, geophysical surround-
ings impinge upon the shape and direction of his social
behavior, has probably persistedfor as long as has man himself,
Oral and written folk traditions of many cultures and many
ages speak of regionalized personality differences between
groups of people, owing to variations of environment. Plato
is reported as once having expressed the idea that people
from areas of abundant sunshine exhibited more buoyancy
of spirit than did individuals from areas of persistent cloudi-
ness. Even today, such axiomatic expressions as "hot-natured
Latins," "the cold British," carry with them the inherent idea
that climatic phenomena somehow condition human person-
alities and behavior.

Researchers of our scientific age have compiled voluminous


data and theories suggestingthat the industrial and intellect-
tual activity and creativity of homo sapiens bear an intimate
association with such meteorological parameters as temper-
ature, environmental air pressure, and sun-spot cycles. But
establishing infallible scientific evidence for a causal relation-
ship between isolated meteorological features and general or
specific aspects of human behavior is a fairly complicated
business. The innate truth of colloquial folk axioms is one
thing, but the truth demanded by science is quite another.
Dr. Reinhold Reiter, Chairman of a Study Group of the
International Society of Biometeorology, Lieden, Holland,
and Director of an Institute for Atmospheric Environmental
Research in Germany, has pointed out that a causal connec-
tion between atmospheric phenomenaand human biological/
behavior processes is by no means clarified, not even now in
the era of large-scaleexplorations of our atmosphere(I), (I-l).
For Reiter, atmospheric forces are complex and interde-
pendent - likewise are the multitudinous variables deter-
mining human behavior. And thus far, no experimental
research model has been devised which is capable of control-
ling all the variables involved except those under investigation.
He explains that the human organism is exposed to the total
complex of the "bioclimate," and that the concept of bio-
climate cannot accurately be isolated into individual groups
of elementsfor separatescrutiny (I-1).

il8
The production of air ions varies not only in space, but also
in time. Dr. Reiter advises that the rate of ionization is
influenced by air pressure. As air pressure changes from day
to day and from season to season, the rate of ionization due
Numbcr of iong Per to solar and cosmic sourcesalso varies (I).
cubc centrrneter o t d t F
In addition to identifying natural air ion-producing sources*
and their variation with time and geography, investigators
|0 0 0
pay close attention to the relative values of ion concentrations
and ion ratios -- how these two factors differ under varying
circumstances. The period of time over which small ions
maintain their effective radiation (their "half-life"; depends
on the amount of pollutants in the air. The cleaner the air,
the longer the half-life of small ions, especially on high
mountains (I). Clean air means high concentration of small
50o ions, providing there is an ionization source present. A simple
rule given by Reiter is: the lower the visibility the lower
the small ion concentration; this is because low visibility
means the presence of many large particles onto which the
small ions very readily attach. Foggy or dusty environments
are low in small ion concentration (I). Usually small air ions
exist in a proportion of 5 positive to 4 negative ions. In the
l0
open country in conditions of sunshine,400 to 500 air ions
l\\\\\l per cm" are found. Values can go up to 1,000 in the
crowded oprn sunng mounfain
c ifies countrg fops mountains and down to 10 in crowded cities (K-2).
Air ion ratio variations, Dr. Reiter reveals, occur in the free
atmosphere under normal conditions, the ratio depending on
the strength and polarity of the environmental electrostatic

" Accordingto researcher CharlesTopley,thereareseveralplacesin the


worldwherecascades arecapableof producing
or waterfalls a finespray
whichholdsa negative charge. of sucha spravcanhavea
The inhalation
curative,calming effect(K),
Anotherauthor.JosephB. Davis,M.D., reportson repeated measure-
ments,takenat the healthspa,Bad-Gastein, whichrevealed thatin the
vicinityof waterfallstherewereup to 37,000smallnegatively charged
ions/ccof air. whereascontrolmeasurements on the samedaysof a
distancefromthefallswereconsistently 800 or lessions/ccof air (K-6).
Basedon measurements he has taken,Topley also confirmsthat
coniferous treesgiveoff a considerable
amountof negative ionsintothe
surrounding atmosphere, more than does any othertree he has yet
investigated(K).
124
field. The normal electrostatic polarity of an outdoor
++++++ environment is that of a positive charge in the air space above
P o s i t i v e+ + the earth, and a negative charge at the surface of the earth
++ itself. Between the two polarities of this electric atmospheric
Atmospheric Charge field, there is a continuous movement of ionic charges,both
+ + + ++ + towards the positive air space above and the negative earth
below. The ratio of positive to negative ions is known to
remain fairly constant under normal conditions.* But with a
disturbed atmosphere, such as a thunderstorm, the polarity
of the atmospheric field can be teversed, which correspond-
ingly reverses the flow of ionic charges. Under these condi-
tions the ratio of positive to negative ions is altered, with the
Eorth
negative ions gaining in activity, as compared to normal (I).
Reiter further pointed out that the electrical conductivity of
the atmosphere is related to the small ion concentration. Any
reduction in small ion concentration results in a correspond-
ing reduction in atmosphericconductivity (I).

-L --1-
lt is obvious that air pollution is an anathema to small ions.
|
| -)- '-T- If one begins with a clear air mass having a relatively high
Tl
concentration of small ions and adds to it a pollutant, e.g.
cigarette smoke, the concentration of small ions drops
extremely (I). Large ions predominate where the air is most
polluted, viz. the smog and dust of factories and cities. Large
ions tend to have a long half-life and low mobility (I). In
Earth
many instances large ions are formed at the expense of small
ions (35, P.243). Measurementstaken by Reiter at various
Negativelychargedcloud induces
positivechargeon Earth'ssurface.
factory sites confirmed the predominance of large ions. All
types of combustion, Reiter clarifies, yield charged particles
which tend to be large;the polarity** of the charge,however,
depends on what is being burned (I). Reiter believes that air
pollution s a major cause of changing ion ratios in the
environment, disturbed atmosphere being another.

* The ion ratio,thoughmoreor |essba|anced production,


nnatura| is
affectedby the fact that negativeions are more mobilethan the
positive(l).
** Air brushing pasta metalsurfaceis positively charged.Positiveions
increaseif the surfaceis heated.As a result,air in the neighborhood of
a functioning iron stoveor centralheating pipesis richin positive air
ions(35,P.243).Enclosed spacesin buildings. automobiles,airplanes,
etc. are thoughtto be frequentlyover-saturated with positiveions.

t25
IONS AND HUMAN Our knowledge of air ion behavior in the open environment
BIOLOGY receives further illumination from clinical, laboratory
findings involving human subjects accumulated since the
1920's. In Moscow, around 1919, Prof. A. L. Tchyevsky
began the first systematic large scale investigations of human
responsesto air ions. Then, in about 1920, Prof. F. Dessauer
of Frankfurt, Germany began similar studies. Subsequently a
number of researchers in several countries embarked upon
such investigations. Basically, what both Tchyevsky and
Dessauer discovered was that individuals alternately exposed
to negative and positive ions under experimental conditions,
reported effects to the nervous system, the blood stream, the
respiratory system, and the endocrine glands. And the large
majority of the subjects tested evidenced beneficial effects
when exposed to negative ions, but undesirable effects*
when inhaling positive ions (26,P.29\, (35,P.259).

Those first air ion discoverieshave been supersededby more


contemporary investigations, the results of which, broadly
speaking, confirm the earlier findings. One of the foremost
authorities on air ion effects is Prof. Albert P. Krueger,
Microbiologist, who resigned his position as head of the
Department of Bacteriology at the University of California,
Berkeley, to form an ion research group. He writes that upon
initial observation,

there is something of an intellectual effort involved in accepting


the idea that an atmospheric in can exert any sort of biological effect.
After all, it is only a group of 4 to 12 gaseous molecules clustered at
random around an electrically charged atom or molecule of gas; it
moves slowly, and as a consequence, wreaks no physical damage on
impact' Furthermore, it occurs n strikingly sparse numbers. In an
artificially ionized atmosphere, for example, the ratio of ion groups to
non-ionized molecules is of the order of I to 20 trillion. That the body
can detect these ionic clusters among the astronomically more prevalent
ionized molecules and react with them seems something more than
improbable at the first glance. Nevertheless, one can advance reasons
that make this possibility a good deal more acceptable. "(K-1).

*
l t h a s b e e nf o u n d t h a t t h e l a w o f o p t i m u ms t i m u l a t i o nw, h i c hs e e m s
t o d o m i n a t ea l l e l e c t r o - b i o l o g pi ch e n o m e n ai,s a l s o a p p l i c a b l et o t h e
influence of air-ion currents.The effect might be favorableup to a
certain maximum value, but this changesinto a reverseeffect if the
o p t i m u mi s s u r p a s s e(d3 5 ,P . 2 5 9 ) .

126
Enlarging upon his position, Krueger observes that negative
air ions have been demonstrated to have an accelerating
effect in certain physiological processes associated with
breathing. By contrast, inhalation of positive ions has been
found to produce swelling of the nasal mucosa and irritation
of the upper respiratory tract (K-l). Krueger asserts that all
trachael changes attributed to positive air ions can be
duplicated by the intravenous injection of the neurohormone,
serotonin. Like positive ion effects, the serotonin effects can
be reversed by treatment with negative air ions (K-1). On the
basis of these facts, Krueger thinks it is reasonable to postulate
that positive ions are "serotonin releasers," and that a local
accumulation of serotonin in the trachea is the immediate
cause of positive ion effects (K-1).

DR ALBERT KRUEGER

t27
Sparked by Prof. Krueger's results, Prof. F. G. Sulman,
Pharmacologist, the Hebrew University, Jerusalem, has gained
international recognition for his experimental work involving
air ion effects upon human biology and behavior. Sulman
relates that both positive and negative ions in the lungs are
taken up into the blood stream, and whereas the erythrocytes
of the blood pick up air oxygen, thrombocytes react to the
positive ions releasing their neurohormone serotonin (K-2).
Sulman also refers to the findings of two other researchers,
Winsor and Beckett (1958), which showed that the inhalation
by humans of air containing 3.2 x 104 positive ions/cm3,
reduced maximal breathingcapacity by about 30 percent(K-2).

Further clinical evidence for the physiological effects of


ionized air comes from Dr. I. H. Kornblueh, who has been
engaged in experimental work with air ions for over 20 yean.
During this time he has treated hundreds of patients and a
variety of complaints with air-ion therapy. In conversation
with Kornblueh he maintained that there are constitutional
differences in the way that various humans respond to
ionized air, i.e. that natural physiological biochemical
differences between individuals can cause different individual
reactions to ionized air. and that there are some persons who
do not respond at all.

However, of those who do respond, the vast majority


respond to negatively ionized air; a small percentage respond
only to positive ionization. Thus, from his research evidence,
Kornblueh concludes that "not all people have the same
electrical sensitivity; it is a very peculiar thing for which we
have no satisfactory explanation" 1L). Continuing, Kornblueh
pointed out that the following categories are particularly
sensitiveto the inhalation of smal1air ions;children; the old;
the sick; persons under stress. And in treating patients for
burns with negative air ions, it was discovered that mental
alertnesshad also increased.

Dr. Kornblueh offered an interesting observation on the


effects of air ions upon gatherings of people. According to
him, where there is a number of people, e.g. in an enclosed

128
space, the number of negative small ions gets used up quickly,
leaving a preponderance of positive ions. The concentration
of positive ions tends to make people feel uncomfortable.
The introduction of negative ions, he says, improves substan-
tially the environment wherein a group of people are
congregated (L). At present, Kornblueh explained, most
places in the world do not keep a record, nor have any idea
of their environment ion count. Nevertheless,he reckons that
within the next few years ion counts will be made routinely
at all meteorological stations in the United States. But for the
moment, reliable instruments for good measurements are
lacking (L).

DR IGHO KORNBLUEH

129
IONIZING WINDS It is recognized,andgenerally accepted by many researchers*
of "ion phenomena," that a cettain type of wind present in
seveal areas of the world, but known by different names,
depending on the country, is associated with significant
physiological and psychological effects upon local human
. H*..'. populations. Typically, this wind is hot and dry and brings
"b, o-- with it an invasion of positive ions. Listed below are several

io'1.#lI /+
geographical locations showing the name by which the wind
is known in that area:
\/ 1-\
Dipole mornent ,.'4L\0,
F---)

7 +\
(o) LOCATION NAME OF WIND
Hr0
a \ \. -/ emany Foehn & Tramontana
HrO- Austria Foehn
\t ,/
(b) Israel Sharav
Egvpt Khamsin
Posltlve lonlzation ls the maln cauge of
Italy Sirocco
suff6rlng from Foehn, Sharav, Sharklye
Central France Autan
and simllar hot dry wlnds, Formatlon of
posltvs ions ls facI||tatd by fr|ctlon California Santa Ana
between the incoming wind and the
exlst|ng alr Iayers: (a) deplcts a Watr Argentina Zonda
molecule wlth dlpole moment, changlng
at (b) lnto a model of a small ('prlmary') Canada Chinook
multimolecular atmospheric water vapor
lon, conslsting of a positlve H^O lon with
Malta Xlokk
thre attached neutral po|azrized H^o Java Koebang & Gending
molecules' The ov r a|t resu|t is that thir
conglomeration displays a positive charge Northern Sumatra Bohorok
towards the environment.
Libya Sharkia
New Delhi The Desert Wind
Australia The Desert Wind (K-3).

*
Dr. R. Reiter feels that many of the claims made by some of his
colleaguesare inadequatelysupportedby rigid scientificexperimenta-
tion. He is, nevertheless,
scientificallyobjectivein his skepticism,as he
does not say that the findingsreportedby others bear not truth, but
only that, in order to be acceptedwith scientific certainty, these
reports should be supportedby a largernumber of experimentsand
greatercontrol and precisionin experimentalmethodoloSy(1).

130
British Research Engineer and Inventor Charles Topley, who
works in close liason with a team of medical researchers on
various uses of air ion therapy, believes that the effects of the
"ionizing winds" are mainly of "mental" (psychological)
significance (K).
During a visit by this writer to Topley's laboratory, he
explained that as a result of exposure to the ionizing winds,
human mental processes are slowed down. This occurs, he
maintains, because the "negative feedback" mechanism of
the body's metabolic process is affected (K). Symptoms
begin, says Topley, as a kind of "nervous sickness," excess
migraine and sick headache. Everyone, ill or healthy, is to
some degree affected. In illustration of his point, Topley cites
a situation apparently present in parts of France where, with
the coming of the Autan, a certain increase in anti-social
behavior is anticipated among local populations, irritability
and short tempers being recognized concomitants of the
Autan (K).
For many years inhabitants of mountain areas, particularly
in the vicinity of Germany, Austria, and Switzerland, have
talked and complained about "mountain sickness," a peculiar
assortment of depressive illnesses believed to accompany the
cyclic appearance of the Foehn winds. It has even been
suggestedby some that Foehn-type winds have, on occasions,
reached London, causing ill health and discomfort to unwary
victims in that city (14).

But Dr. Reiter, who manages an ion measuring station just


at the foot of the Alps outside the small town of Garmisch-
Partenkirchen, Germany, holds a more conservative approach
towards the many claims attributing ill health to the Foehn.
Elaborating upon his position, Reiter explained that originally,
earlier this century, it was thought that Foehn might bring
high concentrations of positive and negative ions which could
affect man, but that recent measurements show that there is
no specific variation of the small ions (I). Foehn, in Germany,
descends from the Alps and is characterizedby high tempera-
ture (25oc) and low humidity (20 percent). It is a clear wind,

l3l
with most of the particles having been washed out by precipi-
tation on the southern, Italian side of the Alps before enter-
ing Germany. The concentration of ions both positive and
negative, is relatively high, but the ratio of positive to
negative is normal. The same, Reiter says, is true of any clean
air mass, for example, a polar air mass has a high concentra-
tion of small ions. Foehn, Reiter maintains, cannot be
regarded as an isolated meteorological situation because there
are associated with it other phenomena, e.g. squall lines, cold
fronts, or thunderstorms, which might also affect certain
human biological responses. Consequently, he feels that any
biological/behavioral effects attributed to Foehn cannot be
explained solely in terms of ion concentration(I).

Mr. Topley, however, does not fully share Dr. Reiter's view
about the effect of Foehn winds. Topley explained that the
electro-environmental conditions of the city of Munich are
such that they attract the Foehn to it. By contrast, nearby
open country areas around Munich, like Garmisch-
Partenkirchen where Reiter's ion measuring station is located,
may not feel the effects of Foehn so intensely because of
their different electro-environmental circumstances. (K).

HUMAN WEATHER The Sharav of Israel representsan ionizing wind occurring in


SENSITIVITY a different topographical and climatic setting from that of
the Foehn of Germany. This Sharav, named after the desert
weather referred to in the Bible, is prominent mainly in the
mountainous areas such as Jerusalem and Safed. It is a dry,
warm wind with a strong positive ion concentration with
"low" air pressure.Dr. Felix Sulman is both a medical doctor
and a department head in Jerusalem and as such is in an
excellent position ta observe the Sharav's effects, since
Jerusalem has up to 150 days of Sharav a year. Half of the
city's population suffer, For many, the misery is minor, such
as swellings of the extremities. Others develop headaches,
nausea and occasionally become violent. Wth this problem
on his doorstep, Dr. Sulman has become a pioneer in this
field.

132
Over the last nine years he has conducted controlled experi-
ments, as well as general empirical observations of persons
exposed to Sharav, and describes typical complaints associat-
ed with its presence: depression, irritability, insomnia, and
tension --- these, together with a multitude of additional
physiological complaints (K-4). Even among healthy persons,
Sulman has reported decreasedaltertness during Sharav (K-5).
"Weather-sensitive" people studied by Sulman and his
research assistants started suffering one to two days before
the onset of Sharav (K4). From this, researchers surmised
that their complaints were due to changes other than heat.
Suffering began at a stage where there was neither increased
heat nor decreased humidity, which, to the researchers,
meant that subjects were probably reacting to the weather
front with its typical changesof air ionization (K-2).
Positive ionization always precedes the weather front by
one or two days because electricity moves faster than air.
This, Sulman states, accounts for the particular sensitivity
to weather of many people who maintain, and with reason,
that they are weather prophets.* The resultant diagnosis of
the research team was that reactions may be due to hyper-
thalmic serotonin hyperactivity, or hyperproduction provoked
by a steep increase in ionization of the air which the changing
weather front pushes ahead before it arrives (K-4). Sulman
concludes that the underlying problem of Sharav is a stress
reaction exerted on the entire endocrine system, and in this
connection he especially notes the adrenal cortex and
medulla (K-5).
Referring to the behavioral effects brought on by the
Khamsin (the equivalent of Sharav, in Egypt) Time Magazine
has reported that " . the Khamsin can also madden men.
Automobile accidents are far more frequent when it is
blowing, crime rates increase by as much as 20 percent .
judges in some Arab countries take a lenient attitude toward
B e e r s h e bdau r i n gt h e K h a m s i n . crimes committed during the Khamsin (26, P. 73).
Excessof positiveions.
* ChristopherHills. who lived in the West Indiesfor severalyears,
confirmstheseresultsand maintainsthat one to two days beforea
hurricane or tropicalstormhe alwaysexperienced headaches
depressive
or dull feelingsassubjective
indicators weather
of an oncoming change.
He also reports restriction of the nasal sinuses.

r33
NEGATIVE ION THERAPY For an indoor environment, the artificial production of
negative ions has been found to be an effective means of
counteracting the effects of excessive positive air ions.
Mr. Charles Topley, who worked for many years on ahcraft
electrical and mechanical design in England and who has
patented several inventions, has developed a negative ion
generator which he believes is the most effective yet devised.
The ion generator, which Topley says took him seven years
to develop, is a rectangular-shaped,self-contained unit, just
a little larger than a conventional table-model radio, and is
powered by standard home voltage. [n explaining some of the
theory underlying the therapeutic value of his invention,
Topley points out that it is the negative small ions which
are the most beneficial to all forms of life -- botanical, as
well as animal and human. With most existing ion generators,
Topley continues, the ions do not travel much beyond the
emitting orifice of the device. Consequently, to receive any
benefit, subjects would have to sit close to the machine for
long periods of time.

From an engineering point of view, Topley says, the chronic


problem has been that "ion recombination" takes place so
close to the source of generation that little or no effect was
realized several feet away (K). Thus, a unique feature of his
machine is that the negative ionized air-gas molecule it
produces is contained within an "envelope" of moisture. The
advantage of this is two-fold. First, it enables the negatively
charged air ion to be carried throughout the room rather than
be dissipated soon after its emission from the generator. And
second, the "moisture envelope" facilitates a more effective
negative ion assimilation by the respiratory system and
ultimate absorption of the ions into the blood stream (K).

The University of the Trees research team does not hold to


this view, since Drs. Sulman, Krueger, etc. have found that
even small generators fill an average size room with negative
ions in about 30 minutes to a density of 1,500 to 2,000 ions
per c.c., which is an ample ratio.

t34
Mr. Topley's assertionthat negativeion therapy has no value
unless a hydroxyl ion is used is only half the story. Whereas in
some areas of medical work it has been reportedthat the water
coatedion has a more beneficial effectin relievingailmentssuch
as asthma and bronchitis, other researchers report they can
reduce bacteri4 fatigue, irritability, tensiorl migraine, nausea
and hay fever without coating the ion in a water envelope(see
later work in the chapter).

Some people ask whethernegativeions can be detectedwith


the nose.The answeris no. The odor is ozone,which affectsthe
mucous membranesand the alveoli (airsacs in the lungs) and
over a long exposuredamagesthesemembranes,causingthem
to operate ineffectively.The toxic rate for ozone in air is 0.05
partsper million (ppm).Exposureto ozoneover a longperiodof
time causes emphysema.If you can smell the ozone from a
negativeion generatorthis oftenmeansyour nose is too close to
the ion emittersbut the toxic level shouldbe testedin all cases.
It is a fairly simple matter to contact a local university or air
pollution control authorities who are quite likely to have an
ambient air monitor for testing ozone concentrationsin air.

What happens in a negative ion generator is that the ions


streamoff the tips of several"emitter" needles.The cause of
this streamis what electronicspeoplecall a highvoltagecorona
dischargeof electronsinto the surroundingatmosphere.When a
materialmore conductivethan air, such as the humanbody with
its large percentageof water, is close to the emittersit attracts
more current than the surroundingair and thus intensifiesthe
coronadischarge.(Generally speakingit is bestnot to getone's
nose closer than seven or eight inches from the tips of the
emitters).This leads to an increase in the production of ozone
and consequently its distinctive odor intensifies. Naturally
occuringozone such as thatproducedby the action ofsolar rays
ionizing the atoms of iodine in seaweedare not harmful and are
producedby a differentprocess.*

*
P u b l i s h e r , sn o t e : S e e p a g e 2 7 5 o rd e t a i | so n t h e U n i v e r s i t yo f t h e T r e e s N e g a t i v e | o n
Generators.

135
Dr. Sulman states that a preponderance of positive ioniza-
tion of the oxygen molecules in the atmosphere is also a
feature of foggy and polluted city air, because the water
drops and the dust particles are primarily positively charged
and thereby quickly neutralize the negative oxygen ions.
Sulman suggestsa solution would be to apply negative ioniza-
tion to the ar conditioning of modern high-rise blocks, in
which the air to be breathed is enriched with negative ions,
thus actually representing a social step forward.*

Even the air in open country areas, Mr. Topley feels, is


predominantly positive because it probably received wind-
carried pollutants which originated in distant industrial zones
(K). one electric powe station alone, he says, produces
enough sulphur-dioxide (SO2), with its affinity for positive
electricity in the atmosphere to extend over vast areas of the
earth's surface (K). In the home, Topley explains, the viewing
surface of a television set gives off into a room, electric
emissions ranging in magnitude from about 7,000 volts to
about I 1,000 volts. These emissions,he says,have the effect
of producing a positive charge into the air and on the surface
of all items within immediate range of the T.V. set (K). But
upon switching on fus negative ion generator and measuring
the ratio of small air ions in the room on a special device

D
which he designed for that purpose, Topley claims that the
meter moves gradually away from a positive reading towards
neutral, and eventually registers a full negative reading as the
negative ion saturation of the room becomes complete (K).
His negative ion generator functioning in a T.V. room,
Topley says, neutralizes positive emissions as they are
produced by the T.V. set (K). The medical director for the
Atomic Energy Commission (AEC) in Washington told
Christopher Hills in 1963 that it has been well known for
many years that T.V. screens produce harmful X-rays up to
two inches from the surface of the screen. The effects of this
radiation are cumulative.

* KargerGazette,publ.
S. Karger,Arnold-Bocklin-strasse
25, Ch-4O11
Basel,
Switzerland.

136
Most ion researchers corroborate an observation given by
Dr. Kornblueh to the effect that sick persons evidence a
quicker biological response to the presence of negative ions
than do healthy persons (K), (L). Topley's explanation for
+- this is that illness constitutes a kind of deficiency, an
\+-
qt imbalance of the body's bioelectric energies, which negative
c
o ions help to restore (K). As a supportive example, he offers
co the complaint of insomnia, particularly among older people,
who as a group apparently have difficulty remaining asleep
through the night. [n an atmosphere of negatively ionized air,
Topley asserts, a futl night's sleep is virtually guaranteed.
Ex?rlqre me (mins)
Topley, who is himself a vibrant 73, says that since he
developed his negative ion generator he no longer has diffi
culty in getting adequatesleep (K).
Dr. Massy, while working with a negative ion generator for
over three years, found for healthy young people with no
sleeping problems that short exposure to negative ions --
between 20 and 40 minutes -- increased their vitality, enabling
+- them to work longer and sleep less. For them, sleepingin a
Y
negative ion atmosphere had the effect of producing too
o much stimulation. They awoke several times during the night.
U

Topley maintains that the most important application of


negativeions is its prophylactic aspect,treating "well" people
to ,9 30 r1o & 70 80 90 too
eo
by preventing illness before it occurs. The obvious advantage
Exposure Trme (mins) of negative ionization to healthy persons, he asserts, is to
strengthen those organs in the body which are responsible
for natural immunization and protection against disease, for
Topley believes that in alarge majority of people such organs
are sluggish and malfunctioning (K). "We go about," he said,
"thinking that we are well, but we are not generally as well as
we could be" 1K1.Dr. Sulman and Mr. Topley both conclude
that negative ions have both prophylactic and therapeutic
applications.It preventsas well as restores.
There is yet another provocative dimension to the experi-
mental work now underway by Mr. Topley and his medical
associates, and which could have direct behavioral implica-
tions from both a psychological and a sociological standpoint.
This concerns a theory which seems to be evolving, centered
on what Topley calls the "recalcitrant child".
137
Such a child is defined as "badly behaved," and differs from
the autistic child, or from children whose abnormal behavior
is due to obvious physiological impediments. Topley is
satisfied, on the basis of clinical evidence yielded by British
medical researchers, that the causal factor for bad behavior
in recalcitrant children is an excess of the lead deposits
retained in the body. These findings, Topley says, revealed
that when lead deposits were reduced, behavior improved (K).
Elaborating, Topley holds that the bioelectric charge of the
human body is basically more positive than negative, but that
recalcitrant children are even more positively charged than
normal. This excess positiveness, Topley feels, is somehow
responsible for the retention of greater amounts of lead (and
to some extent nickel and other elements) for long periods
of time within the circulatory system (K). Topley contends
that pollutants which make our bodies over-positive enter our
systems primarily through eating, drinking, and breathing --
some foods, and some environments being more detrimental
than others.

The therapeutic solution which Topley proposes for this


situation is exposure to the negative air ions produced by his
generator. This, he says, will have the effect of neutralizing
the body's over-positive condition and returning it to a more
natural bioelectric state, which he believes is slightly more
negative than positive (K).

As an outgrowth of his findings with "recalcitrant children,"


Topley is inclined to believe that to a certain extent even
some adult anti-social behavior*, including some crimes,
might have a basis in excess lead deposits retained in the
body (K).

" Experimental useof Topley'snegative ion generatorin somemental


in Englandis yet in its initialstages.
institutions Consequently, thereis
no experimental evidencelinking psychopathic disorderswith lead
depositsin the body, nor any clear assessment of how mentallyill
personsrespond to negative
ion therapy.

138
Another compelling observation concerning air ions and
social behavior was offered by Mr. Topley. According to him,
a negative ion generator unobtrusively operating in a
conference room would tend to produce a calming, soothing
effect in such a setting where nervousness and conflicts are
often manifest. If, for example, two different groups, e.g.
labor and management, had convened to discuss particularly
difficult issues wherein considerable tension could be expect-
ed, the presence of a negative ion generator could not guaran-
tee an amicable consensus of opinion, but it would lessen the
amount of tension during the meeting. This application of
negative air ionization, Topley feels, would be useful in any
social gathering where negative ions can be made to saturate
the environment (K). After extensive tests the University of
the Trees research team has also verified the above statement
to be true.

Considering the foregoing evidence for an air-ion/behavioral


tie-in, particularly in light of his latter observation, this writer
queried Topley as to whether or not, by altering the natural
concentrations and ratios of ambient air ions, human behavior
was in any way controlled or manipulated. Topley responded
emphatically that the human will, that human behavior, is in
no way controlled, but that what negative ionization helps
achieve is the creation of a physical environment wherein the
most difficult issues between opposing parties can be handled
with greater rationale and tranquility, and with less
emotional tension (K).

SULMAN'S IONIZATION Professor Sulman states that of 300 people who applied for
TREATMENT help, 129 were suffering from tension, migraine, swellings,
palpitations, dyspnea, asthma, flushes, vasomotor rhinitis,
hyperperistalsis and pollakisuria, due to the Sharav causing
large amounts of serotonin to be secreted in the nervous
system. Of the 129 subjects tested, 96 reacted favorably to
negativeion treatment. Of these 96 patients, l6 found equal
benefit from positive air ionization. Thus 80 of the 129
subjects found relief from their serotonin complaints by
negativeionization treatment,i.e. 75 percent.*
* lnk.J. Biometeor, 4, pp.313-318.
1974,Vo''18,number
t39
Later, in 1975, Dr. Sulman reported that not only did
negative ionization cure 75 percent of serotonin cases,but it
also cured 45 percent of hyperthyroid cases * . The data for
this conclusion was gathered over five years on over 500
patients. The following table summarizes his results.

The problem of the weather-sensitivepatient is so acute in


Jerusalem that Dr. Sulman and his colleagues have, over the
years, developed a complete system of patient management,
the successof which is controlled by urinalysis.

CONTROLLING In 1974, Dr. Sulman exposed bacteria of escherichia,


DISEASE proteus, pseudomonas, klebsiella, staphylococci, strepto-
cocci, and candida to a negative ionized atmosphere. His
results showed the germ counts are reduced by 50 percent
within six hours and 70 percent within 24 hours ** by the
negative ions. This suggeststhat negative ionization is a way
of controlling disease.

Eectof Ionizing Treatment of Room 4 x 4 x 3 m


on Bacterial Count of Agar Plates.
Each measurementrepresentsthe result of eight experiments(means +S.E.M.).

Number of colonies counted before and after ionization

Exposure lonotron 20 with air filter Ionotron 50, no air filter


(h) Before After Before After
6 23+2 t2! t* 20+1.5 10i1*
t2 19t2 12+l* 22+2 11+l*
t6 36+3 1211** 49+3 t2+l**
20 1 7t 2 9 + l* |4+l 50.5*x
24 19t2 6*0.5** I',ltI 510.5*x

Significanceof differencefrom respectivecontrol *P <0.01,


**P<0.005.

**
S u l m a nF . G . e t a l . I R C S 2, 1452(19741.
*
I n k .J . B i o m e t e o r1, 9 7 5 ,Vol 19,number3, pp. 202-209.

140
Three bypes of reactlons to beat gtress tu 500 weaber-eeneitlve
patients and their improvemeut by uegatlve alr tonisatlon.
Evaluation by Student's l.eet.

Percent of patlents mproved


SSmdrome Symptoma by negative ar ionlsatloo
Good Falr Poor

Serotooiu hyper- Sleepleesness, lrritability,


production: tenslon, auorexla, electrile< 75% L0% L5%
halr, migraine, naugea,
vomiting, scotoma, amblyopla
syndrome tinnibus, oedemata, rbeumatic
pain in scars, muscles and
[Urinary seroto- Jolnts, palpilations' precordal
nln and S-HIAA pain, dyapuoe, flushes wlth
lncreased) gweat or cbllls, vasomotor
rhlutls, conJunctlvltle,
patients laryngitie, tracheltls, vertigo
tremor, byperperistalste,
potyurla, pollakisurla, pboto-
pbobia, olfactophobia, audlo-
pbobta.

Ldrenal Hypotnsion, fatigrre, apa'thy, L% L% e8%


leflclency: exbausllon, blackout,
0xhaustlon depreselon, confuslou, ataxia,
lyndrome adSmamla, psychlc impedt-
iUrlnary adren- ment to perform tasks, hypo-
rline, noradren- glycaemic spells
lne, l?-KS'
L7-OH decreased)
120potlents

llyperthyrotdlsm Asomnla, irritabillty, tensloa, 4s% 3% 52%


rForme fruatcr Bausea, vomittng, palpltatlons,
Urinary precordial paln, dyspnoe,
byroxlne and aweat, tremor, abdominal
stamine tn- paiu, diarrhoea, polyurla,
)reaoed, geroto- pollakisurla, allergic react-
rln sometlmes lons, reddenlng of skin,
ncreased) alopecla, orexla wlth welgbt
i5 patienta loss, overactlvlty, fatigue,
er(baustlou, depreselon,
ad1mamla, conrrslon.

C'ood - obJective: serotouln aud S-HIAA reduced to uormal values;


subtectlve: abolltiou of most complalats (p<0.005).
Falr - obJectlve: sorotonin and 5-HIAA dimlniebed;
subJectlve: degree of suerlngless incapacitating tbau before (p<0.05).
Poor - obJectlve: serotonln (s0.95 uglo and 6-HIA 110-15 ugld) Etiu h|8h;
eubJectlve: no lmprovement of symptomg (p>0.05).

r4l
ALPHA WAVES In a paper dedicated to Dr. Igho Kornblueh, the original
pioneer of ion therapy, who passed away in 1973 in
Philadelphia, Dr. Sulman reported on a carefully controlled
experiment in which electroencephalogramrecords of human
subjects exposed to negative ions showed a drop in the
frequency of the alpha waves.* This appeared to be of the
order of 0.5 to 2.5 cycles and represented a decrease of
about 20 percent. Sulman reports the decrement of alpha
frequency began in the earliest case after 10 minutes of
negative air ionization. It reached a maximum after 30
minutes and persisted as long as air ion exposure was applied,
then followed with one hour of gradual return to the indivi-
dual rhythm pattern of the subject. Professor Sulman feels
that the decrease in alpha frequency is a manifestation of the
general relaxation induced in the patients by negative air
ionization.

There was also an amplitude increase in the EEG of about


50 percent or l0 to 15 microvolts which Sulman interpretsas
an improvement of perception and apperception, i. e. intensity
due to negative air ionization.

Subjectively, Sulman continues, all subjects experienced the


following reaction during exposure to negative ionization:
initial relaxation, followed by alertness connected with the
moving of the alpha-wavesfrom the occipital to frontal brain
areas.

Swami in the laboratory Since this last effect is also observed with accomplished
from Newsweek magazine meditators while meditating, one might surmise that negative
ion atmosphereis beneficial to good meditation.**

*
l n t . J . B i o m e t e o r 1. 9 7 4 , V o 11 8 . n u m b e r 4 ,p p . 3 0 6 - 3 t 2 .
** Dr.
Basu K. Bagchi,a professorat the Universityof MichiganMedi-
cal Center, Ann Arbor, conducted EEG readings in "Newsweek
Magazine,'on SwamShantanandaand conc|udedthat the Swami was
g e n u i n e .S e e " N u c l e a r E v o l u t i o n : D i s c o v e r yo f t h e R a i n b o w B o d y "
(pp.494-496).
142
Effects of exposure to negative air ions (3,5 x 105 ions/(cm3. sec)
at 1 m distance) on EEG parameters. Means of the analysis of a
100 sec epoch of each of I EEG channels.

Exposure to air ious

Spreading of alpba
waves area

I 7-8 20 30-35 fernp.- pariet.-


occip. front.
'temp. - pariet. -
I 8 20 30
occip. front,
10 I 20 30 temp. - pariet. -
occip. front.
9 a 20 35 temp. - parlet. -
occlp. front.
10 I 20 30 temp. - pariet. -
occlp. front.
10 I 20 31 lemp. - pariet. -
occip, front.
11 9 20 34 temp.- paret.-
occip. front.
10 ,I 20 30 temp. - pariet. -
occip. front.
9 8 20 32 temp. - pariet. -
occip. front.
10 n 20 33 temp. - pariet. -
occip. front.

I - lr-t - 11-1
tl

Ll - U't
-tatlkr*ut* , , ,&4

tt'Y - ll+l

!a.? - l*l
rwvr!ErYll-'--- - --r-l.ql

eh-? - tlr r}" ...}'. ... '' l


r '- vtr ttt!'- ' r-r r t- r -!

u+t - .Lll ti.t . tll


' ' r- 'rl
t^^-flLtu^-a- L....b1. ...el.L^^..li^.|
'-
. -.t
tr
TF!rt-'

l"'r " la lFt .to


!. ,

!}t LD

16rl, rlrt sLJ_=.._ t6.rr $.r"1 a*".

EEG of normal subject (S. G. male, 65 yr).


left: before; right: during negative air ionisation.
Note four effects: (a) alpha frequency slowed down in all leads,
(b) amplitudes increased in all leads, (c) spreading of alpha
rhythm from the occipital to the frontal area, (d) marked syn-
chronisation of right and left hemisphere.

143
i '

These findings confirm the beneficial effects of negative air


I ionization observed in serotonin-engendereddiseases,such as
I
hay fever and stress due to positive atmospheric conditions.
Relief from these serotonin ailments appears within ten
minutes after starting negative ion treatment. The findings
that these changes are transient is of practical importance,
says Dr. Sulman, since it suggests the need for long-term
application of negative ionization if a thorough anti-serotonin
effect is desired. In Sulman's laboratory a negative ion gener-
ator is in operation the whole working day, and the people
involved find much relief and improved working capacity on
days when they are harassedby the positive ions of incoming
desert winds.

Elecfrode
Fon Dustfiller for corono dschorge

a
l'l
...-.> h
Air
sTreom 1,1
A
n

Design of a simp|e lon|zlng apparatusWhich from mainsof 11o.22o V. builds up a o KV


t e n s i o n ' | t s o u t | e t p r o d u c e s p o s i t v ea n d n e g a t i v e i o n & T h e p o s l t l v e | o n s a r e r o t a l n g d b y
a negatlve|y charged nst and a||ow thg emission o negat|ve ion6, thg so-ca||ed'corona
discharge'. Th|s in ltBe| produces an lon air current up to a d|stance of 2 metors and, f
requlred, can be extended to 4 meters.

144
DR FELIX GAD SULMAN
SUMMARY
AND
DISCUSSION OF PART I
LbI
aernrpNr
"rr8"ruy
I IuVd o NolssnJslo oNV uvnnns I
Part I has sought to explore the concept that there exists a
level of "electro-vibratory" reality to man's physical being,
to examine the possibility that the entirety of matter -- our
material, biological universe - upon which all subsequent
behavioral/social systems are necessarily predicated, might
share in a common and fundamental network of electro-
vibratory forces.

Each electron, each atom, each cell, is seen to have its own
magnetic environment, balancing and intermeshing within
that single Energy-Matter continuum, "vibration," as postu-
lated by Einstein and others. At the atomic level there
appears to be a sustained interaction between the magnetic
properties of matter and other field forces present in the
environment, thus suggestingboth a continuous and a contig-
uous inter-relationship between all physical substances, an
inter-relationship facilitated by, and mediated by, field forces
of an electro-vibratory nature.

Biochemically speaking, the electro-vibratory reality of


human biology is apparent in the body's high percentage of
water, wherein the hydrogen proton is thought to be especially
responsive to magnetic influence. This electro-vibratory per-
spective is also supported by the presence of charged particles
Dr. Albert Einstein flowing in the bloodstream, which should produce a certain
degree of "somatic magnetism." Too, the transmission of
messages along neural pathways, by means of sodium and
potassium, which discharge electric voltages across cell
membranes, adds further to the body's electromagnetic
character. Then, there is preliminary experimental evidence
which suggests that certain damaged enzymes, which could
impair biological functions, can be restored through the use
of electromagnetic energies.

Viewing human biology from a slightly different angle, we


find that basic electrodynamic principles such as frequency,
resonance, and harmonics, apply to all matter, and conse-
quently to all biological systems. Thus, each man's physical

148
ELf,t{ENTS
ceysTALs
ETDIES

body emits its characteristic electro-vibratory fields which


apparently surround and interpenetrate that same body,
making for a kind of self-contained field complex for each
human body, but one which can also attain resonance with
other systems. It is conceivable, then, from a behavioral point
of view, that the phenomenon of harmonics wherein each
entity is said to radiate infinitely into space a series of
associated frequencies capable of achieving resonance with
other independent sources of electro-vibration, could account
for the distinct, but non-rational impulses (intuition?) which
one often sensestowards individuals, or towards other stimuli
presentin one's environment.

Other researchers have postulated the existence of "nodal


points" within the force-fields produced by all vibrating
entities. Nodal points are said to be vortices of energy and to
function as resonance bonds between different life systems
throughout the universe of physical/biological substances.
This concept is expanded by the theory of an "east-west
flow" of energy which Hills claims facilitates resonance
between systems by acting upon the nodal points, thus
enabling each entity in a kind of sensing of its surroundings,
a balancing of its field force within the total complex of
electro-vibratory forces present in the environment. The
east-west force-field is not thought to be electromagnetic
itself, but it apparently acts upon, and conditions electro-
magnetic energies. Following this view, the east-west flow
would be responsible for one individual achieving vibratory
resonance with another individual or for an individual
experiencing resonance with other sources of vibration
external to himself.

Looking further into evidence which argues for biological


man as an electro-vibratory entity, we find experimental
results which indicate that the central nervous system gener-
ates distinct electro-vibratory patterns, and that this system
is capable of responding to force-fields imposed upon it from

t49
external sources. Specific brain centers including the cerebral
cortex, hypothalamus, and reticular formation, seem to be
involved in the transmissionand reception of electro-vibratory
energies between the brain and external energy fields. Even
one's level of consciousness is found to be expressible in
electro-vibratory terms, as measured by the electroencephalo-
graph. And, experimental evidence with both animals and
humans suggeststhat properly applied magnetic fields of the
correct strength and frequency can reduce consciousness to
levels of sleep or even general anesthesia.One experimenter
has treated such bio-emotional conditions as irritability and
depression resulting from menopause with electromagnetic
energies.

It is claimed that recently discovered brain-generated


frequencies,measurablein the range of 100,000,000 cycles
per second, are capable of extending over vast distances.If
this claim proves to be accurate, it could provide an electro-
vibratory explanation for the non-verbal, telepathic trans-
mission of information between two or more individuals.
Over the past several years investigative attempts to under-
stand the phenomenon of telepathy in electromagnetic
terms have generally concluded that all the oscillations
known to be emitted by the brain travel only a short
distance (usually less than l8 inches) away from the surface
of the head, and could not therefore, be responsiblefor the
long-distance communication of information. Moreover, it
was suspected by researchers that telepathic thought trans-
mission involves energies which cannot, according to popular
scientific deinition,be called electromagnetic.Nevertheless,
this alleged new brain-generated"u1tra-theta,"if not strictly
electromagnetic, is certainly "electro-vibratory" in nature,
given the brain's overwhelming electro-vibratory modalities.

Still other possibilities for biological/behavioral tie-ins


with electro-vibratory forces are suggested in the recent
evidence supporting the theory of periodic reversals of the

150
earth'sgeomagneticfield. lndications are that the occasional
reversalof the earth's field could bring about mass faunal
extinctions, cause mutations in existing biological systems'
and usher in entirely new species. Other researchershave
gone on to suggestthat theremight be a positiverelationship
betweenthe size of the earth fauna and the strengthof the
earth's magneticfield, that millions of years ago, during the
mesozoic era, the strength of the basic geomagneticfield
was far greater than its presentaverageof 0.5 gauss.It is
thought, moreover,that there may be a continuouspattern
of oscillation in geomagneticfield strength with the fre-
quencymeasurablein thousandsof years.

H = 2.4gauss There are provocative, though indefinite, experimental


findings hinting that human behavior might be subject to
some degreeof influence from localized geomagneticforce-
fields. The independent findings of Abrams, De La Warr,
Brown, Barnothy, and others seem to have establishedthe
acute sensitivity of biological systems,including humans,to
the presenceof subtle magneticfield forces having strengths
in the neighborhoodof the earth's0.5 gaussaverage.Added
to this is the explanationthat in certain geographicallocations,
the strengthand complexity of field forces can be modified
considerably, owing to localized conditions of soil, ore
deposits, and topography, together with the presenceof
assorted extraterrestrialield influences. Could it be, as
implied in Lakhovsky's observation, that certain snviron-
mental vibratory conditions are responsiblefor cancer, that
likewise, certain other physical/behavioralabnormalities
might result from an imbalance of those electro-vibratory
forces operatingwithin and upon particularhuman popula-
H = 0.5 gauss tions?

Yet another dimension of possible geomagnetic field


influencesupon human biological/behavioral systemsmay be
foreshadowed in the preliminary findings of bomagnetic
researchersand relates to the qualitative difference that they

151
claim exists between the energies of the north and south
magnetic poles of a single, unified field. Their laboratory
results reveal that the cognitive, temperamental, and be-
havioral modes of small animals can be predetermined, and
permanently modified, by exposure to specific north or
south polar energies.

Extrapolating directly from experimental results obtained


with animals to possible effects upon the human system is
usually a risky and unadvisable procedure. But perhaps with
due caution we might be allowed brief speculation in that
direction. Although humans are thought to be sensitive to
very subtle electro-vibratory energies, as yet there seems to
be no firm evidence that the north and south polar emissions
of the earth's magnetic field could produce noticeable and
distinct effects in human behavioral patterns.

But the idea is not to be lightly dismissed. One wonders


what might be the human biological/behavioral response
(perhaps already subtly built into the existing geophysical/
biological network of nature) to geomagnetic field forces of
differing polarities. Might people of a given geographical
area exhibit biological/behavioral patterns peculiar to them-
selves, owing to the unique character of the geomagnetic
field which exists in their region?

There is a baffling report which borders on this area of


speculation. During 1973, Reuter's London international
news service (20), carried a story about a British Anthro-
pologist, Dr. David Davies of London's University College,
who was engaged in research n a remote mountainous
region of Ecuador, called Vilcabamba ("The sacred valley").
According to reports, Davies had authenticated proof that
an inordinately high percentage of the villagers lived to be
100 years old. In fact, Davies is supposed to have met and
talked with men of I23 and 140 years of age, still active
and who had records of baptism in the Catholic Church to

t52
verify their dates of birth. The report went on to explain
that the whole pattern of longevity in Vilcabamba was
completely uncanny, with sizable sections of the population
in their 90's, 80's, and 70's. A life span of 100 was regarded
as "unexceptional."

In looking for possible explanations for this incredible


phenomenon, diet and living habits were closely examined -
but revealed no answers.In fact, inhabitants engagedin some
practices not recommended by modern medicine to increase
longevity. They smoked heavily (40 to 60 cigarettesper day),
and drank liberal amounts of alcoholic beverage, on the
average, 2 to 4 cups of rum per day. But even more con-
founding was a epotwhich reached Davies that there were
other villages nearby where the incredible longevity of Vilca-
bamba was reversed!Where most people lived much below a
normal life expectancy, and "a man of 37 looked like a man
67"1. At last report, Davies was returning to Ecuador to pur-
sue his investigations.

Could it be that there is some unique electro-vibratory


or radiational phenomenon in the valley of Vilcabamba,
which accounts for the astounding longevity of its inhabi-
tants? Perhaps some strange combination of radiations from
the local terrain, in conjunction with extraterrestrial radia-
tions? The fact that there seem to be nearby other villages
where the averagelife span is less than normal is suggestive
of the laboratory results obtained with animals using
alternate north and south pole energies. But whether or not
some peculiar geomagnetic field condition predominates in
these remote villages of Ecuador, still awaits more detailed
investigations.

Perhaps the most salient message contained in this chapter


on bioclimatology is that the human biological/behavioral
apparatus seems to have the inherent faculty of responding
to certain very subtle electro-vibratory forces occurring in

153
one's natural, day-to-day atmospheric environment - that
possibly, under given conditions, even some aspects of social
behavior might be shaped by such forces.

Thus far, there seems to be no experimental or observa-


tional evidence indicating that static electric fields, of them-
selves, have a direct effect upon human behavior. But the
magnitude of some static charges at the surface of the body
(as high as 10,000 volts per centimeter) suggeststhat these
fields should be further investigated for possible biological/
behavioral influences. However, other alternating atmos-
pheric frequencies, "spheric pulses," have been established
theoretically and statistically to enter the human body, and,
to some extent, to modify behavioral modes. Understandably,
researchers may want further experimental confirmation of
spheric effects; but meanwhile, on the basis of present
information, it would not seem premature to speculate on
spheric pulses as being a kind of built-in geophysical control
mechanism for biological systems, an electro-vibratory means
whereby homo-sapiens bio-behavioral modalities are geared
into an evolving, cyclic pattern of planetary forces.

The whole question of the human response to various types


of force-fields is an engaging one. In the context of this
present work, we have the affirmation of science that the
degree of human neurological sensitivity to certain electro-
vibratory forces, electric fields in this instance, varies from
one person to the next. Later, in our discussion of clair-
voyant faculties, the idea is again advanced that clairvoyant
individuals realize a higher than normal degree of sensitivity
to a different range of "electro-vibratory" frequencies. A
significant point here is that the groundwork for compre-
hending what occurs in clairvoyance seems to be, in part,
contained within current scientific theory. In one sense,
science may have laid excellent foundation for a single
edifice of unified human understanding which, at base, is
founded upon laws governing physical matter, but which at

154
its upper regions, extends into esoteric realms - still main-
taining the integrity of the whole.

Reflecting further upon possible geophysical/bio-behavioral


tie-ins, we find that the ion researchersagree that the electro-
vibratory force-field of a given geographical area largely
determines the character of air ions in that area.Thus we see
that there is a direct link between the nature of geomagnetic
force-fields and the character of the ionized air inhaled in
a given geographical region. In fact, areas such as waterfalls
producing a ine Spray' or of abundant coniferous trees' are
claimed to have curative, calming effects because of the
higher ratio of negatively charged small air ions generated
in such environments. Ionized environmental air, then, would
seem to be yet another means whereby the human bio-
logical/behavioral system is intermeshed with, and perhaps to
some extent even governed by, the naturally occuring electro-
vibratory forces of nature.

The ion researchers are in further agreement that air


pollution is a major cause affecting the quality and quantity
of atmospheric air ions. Certain indoor and outdoor environ-
ments are found to have an over-abundance of positively
charged air ions which, tests show, can produce undesirable
physiological and behavioral effects upon humans. It is
common knowledge to ion researchers that crowded cities,
areas of industrial combustion, fog, or dust, have a relatively
high concentration of heavy air ions existing at the expense
of small air ions. It s also believed that the natural and
correct balance of these electro-vibratory forces throughout
nature - including the human body - is slightly more
negative than positive, but that generations of industrial
Industrial Pollution pollution have resulted in a relatively more positively charged
earth environment, to the biological/behavioral detriment of
humankind. Thus, while the precise extent to which environ-
mental air ions affect human behavioral systems is still an
open question, the preponderance of available evidence
indicates that, under specified conditions, the inhalation of
ionized air can produce significant modifications in behavior

155
patterns.

Experimental evidence further indicates that depending on


the polarity of the predominant air-ion environment,
behavioral responses also differ, with irritability and
depression being the general symptoms of an over-positively-
charged environment, while calm and relaxation are
associated with a more negatively charged air-ion ambiance.
Again, this differential response to polar influences, in this
instance air ions, lends added support to the findings of
biomagnetic researchers who consistently maintain that each
polar force-field imparts its own biological/behavioral
influence, as distinct from that of the opposite pole.

Various regions of the world during certain seasons of


the year experience "ionizing winds," hot or warm periodic
winds which apparently usher in large amounts of positively
charged air ions. Behavioral symptoms attributed to ionizing
winds include a slow-down in human mental processes,de-
pression, irritability, tension, and a general increase in anti-
social behavior. It has been found that the cyclic appearance
of ionizing winds occurs with predictable regularity, and still
other measures of small air ions indicate that their concen-
trations vary over a 24 hour period, with the highest quantity
occuring during hours of daylight. This again reinforces the
concept of periodicity as a central feature of nature's geo-
physical - bio-behavioral interrelationships; and at the same
time it suggeststhat there s a positive relationship between
solar energy and abundant health-giving small air ions.

In this connection, one is reminded that most deaths


resulting from "natural causes'r occur during hours of
darkness, between sunset and sunrise. It is also during this
period that existing illness tends to become worse. One
wonders if this phenomenon might not be explainable as
follows: for sick people, whose life forces are in a state of
delicate, precarious balance, the diminishing of the sun's
life-giving radiations and associated small air ion concen-
trations mean that these people no longer have that critical

156
amount of environmental electro-vibratory energy to draw
upon and thereby to sustain the force of their own electro-
vibratory organism. In a kind of reversesituation, something
akin to the foregoing explanation is suggestedin the Russian
practice of placing critical mental and heart patients in
shielded rooms so as to guard the deleterious effects of
excess solar radiations during solar disruptions.

There is a consensus of opinion, among those researchers


interviewed for the present work, that the behavior of groups
of people can be beneficially altered by the artificial intro-
ducton of negatively charged small air ions into an enclosed
living space. The over-abundance of positively charged air
ions, which seems to frequently prevail when many people
are congregatedin an enclosed space, is thought to contribute
to feelings of discomfort and irritability which often occur
Negatrve ions under such circumstances.
produce
colm nesg Thus, a practical application would be the introduction of a
negative ion generator into enclosed living spaces, and high-
rise office buildings. This could create an ambient atmos-
phere wherein a stuffy, over-positively-chargedroom or com-
partment would not be a contributing factor to abrasive
human relations. Under these conditions any ill tempers
manifesting in conference rooms, offices, large commercial
passengervehicles, and the like, would not be further magni-
fied by a deficient ion component of the inhaled air. To the
contrary, both improved health and improved social relations
would be expected in environments properly saturated with
negatively charged small air ions.

But even with these impressive pioneering efforts, it would


be of great benefit to both the physical and the social
sciences to have more exact experimental data available as to
the extent to which ionized air influences human social
behavior. Are we continuously and unconsciously influenced
by the character of the air ions we inhale? If so, what is the
most desirable air ion atmosphere for human well-being, and
how can this best be maintained in both indoor and outdoor

157
situations? Is it possible to establish specific limits and
threshold values for determining possible social/behavioral
effects of ionized air upon inidividuals or populations? Are
there cultural or natural behavior patterns which are gov-
erned by the air ion environment? [f so, to what extent do
these behavior patterns influence the quality of international
relations? What is the feasibility of establishing regularized
remedial treatment schedules for behavioral disturbances,
using negatively charged small air ions? These are some of
the questions which await the outcome of future investiga-
tions, by today's new age researchers.

IA
N.{ Kl Sharav,Foehn
Salt Sugar Prevention

Therapy

serotonIn
{ Antagonist3
I Neg. lonlzation

I tlttrlum carbonato
I followedby:
lPropylthlouracll
I Mothylthlouracll
lMthimazo|o
I carbimazo|
I Beta-Blockers

Courtesy Dr. F.G. Sulman

158
69I
slroM slq lo uolllpa tunluec
qrgl uP ol uolle.rlsnll! sltll u! ^poq uPurnrl oql
lo serluec lel!^ oql sP slaueld lo sloqu^s eql
ocueq ,osla^lun aql pue poo lo do3 oJnlelulu.t
e s! uPul lPql lolleq plo oql peldacce ouqoo8
PART II
DIMENSIONS OF HUMAN BEHAVIORAL
FIELD S-PHYSICAL AND META.PHYSICAL

"Vibration was everywhere present, but it was


nowhere fathomable. It was past, it was present ---
and yet, too, it was future. A force? A field? An
intelligence? An essence - elusive yet substantial
. Man himself yet distinct from himself .
Divine yet worldly. Intermeshing dimensions of
whirling pulsations throbbing to the cadence of a
single universal tone, so bearing witness to the
layered plateaus of truth -- the tiered realities of
man and his mental makings. The produce of his
yet hobbted mind manifesting in the stupor of his
social vehicles, in the unenlightened torpor o his
mundane doings. The Grail ever-present but
constantly receding from his insensitive grasp. So it
was in the darker days of humankind, before man's
perception cleared -- before the fullness of Cosmic
vibrations emerged." ( v . R . B).

161
INTRODUCTION In this section are presented various data obtained through
the use of clairvoyance. It might be useful, therefore, to take
a brief instructive look at the faculty of clairvoyance, as
understood by the clairvoyant himself. We are reminded that
clairvoyance is but one of several faculties often contained
under the heading of "extra-sensory perception" (ESP), and
that psychometry, psychokinesis, telepathy, clairaudience,
and precognition also come under this general category.

Mr. Geoffrey Hodson, widely recognized as one of the most


competent contemporary research clairvoyants, has noted
that clairvoyance operates under the same laws which govern
ordinary sight, and is, indeed, an extension of the standard
means of cognition (38, P. 59). The difference, he claims,
between ordinary vision and clairvoyant vision lies in the
faculty of developed vision to detect the vibrations of the
"sub-ethers" which underlie the ordinary electromagnetic
ether. Or stated differently, the clairvoyant is one who
possesses a considerably wider range of bratory response
than is normal for most persons(38, P. 26).

:;
.)

162
Hodson goes on to point out that the effect of tuning the
consciousnessto sub-etheric wavelengthsis roughly analogous
to a similar effect achieved with the better known energiesof
the X-ray. According to his reckoning expressed in terms of
difference in potential, the ordinary electromagnetic vision of
light rays corresponds to a quantum energy of 2 electron
volts, and the X-ray corresponds to a potential difference of
a few hundred volts to 300,000 electron volts. But there is
reason to believe that the vision of the clairvoyant employs
excedinglyshort wavelengthsand corresponds to a difference
of potential of about 120,000 million volts, or 800 times
greaterthan that of the cosmic rays* (38, P.24).

Dr. Christopher Hills states that the background radiation


with wavelengthsof 13 cm to 80 cm is absorbed by human
beings according to the working of the chakras. He likens the
human absorption of cosmic rays to that of a black hole
sucking in the radiation of the stars and the 2l cm hydrogen
radiation as an illuminating beam for a hologram of conscious-
*-- ness. This 2l cm radiation is consideredby most astronomers
and astrophysicists to be the residue of the creation of the
*s
rF-

N
Universe in the primordial big bang. The clairvoyant sees the
functioning of the seven psychic centers and their radiations
as the human aura (44, P. 160).

Mrs. Phoebe Bendit, another contemporary research clair-


voyant of establishedability, once commented that "the seer
requires to be as critical, impersonal, and objective as the
scientist . ,. metaphorically, science and seership are like
two separate pillars, each of which can rise to a certain
height, but they are completed only if they support the arch
of total knowledge which rests equally on both" ( 15).

* PhysicistZo|tanTarczY.Hornochnotesthat from the point of view o


classicalphysics such a large amount of energybeing associatedwith
clairvoyantvision is viewedwith skepticism.

163
SUBTLE ENERGIES
SUBTLE ENERGIES

* wavefieldsand supersensonics.
Subtle energiesinclude L-fields,radionicand radiesthesic

165
THE L-FIELD* " So far as our present information goes, there is unequivocal
evidence that wherever there is life, there are electrical
properties" (P.47). This is an assessmentmade by the late
Professor Harold Saxton Burr, the distinguished Neuro-
Anatomist, who, for 43 years, was a faculty member of the
Yale University School of Medicine.

Measurement by modern electric instruments developed


within recent years has "revealed that man -- and, in fact, all
life forms -- are ordered and controlled by electro-dynamic
fields which can be measured and mapped with precision"
(P. 11). And according to Burr, "It does not make any differ-
ence whether these fields are called electro-static, electro-
magnetic, or electro-dynamic. The name is always a conse-
quence of the methods which are applied to its study" (P. 95).

What is important is that these bioelectric changes relate to


overall biological functioning. As early as 1935, in his
Electro-Dynamic Theory of Life, Burr proposed that all
living organisms have electric fields which govern their
growth and decay. For the next 38 years until his death in
1973, he proceeded to prove his theory. Since these fields
control life they are called Life fields or more commonly
L-fields.

Though complicated, these L-fields are of the same nature


as the simpler fields known to modern physics and obedient
to the same laws. Like the fields of physics they are a part of
the organization of the universe and are influenced by the
vast forces of space. "Like the fields of physics, too, they

*
A|| the nformationand ideas contained in this sectionon L.ie|ds
resultfrom the researchfindings,concepts,and projectionsof Dr. H. S.
B u r r , a s f o u n d i n h i s b o o k " B l u e p r i n tf o r l m m o r t a l i t y " ( 3 9 ) . T h e
totality of Burr's investigations extendsover40 yearsand embracesthe
broadestspectrumof life forms, rangingfrom unicellularanimals,to
the complex human neuralsystemwith its myriad behavioralnuances.

t66
DR HAROLD BURR

have organizing and directing qualities, which have been


revealed by many thousands of experiments" (P. 12). Burr
maintains that L-fields are invisible and an integral part of the
cosmos (P. 12). "But these field properties are not mysterious
phenomena; they are measurable characteristics not only of
the universe but of the immediate environment of the earth"
(P. 106).

t67
Dagram shows a spher|ca|
sgm3nt of the obsrver,s
Antakarana consisting of
groups of nterconngct d
noda| points o subtlg
en r gy as mapped by th
radionic nstrumonts o
Supersensonics.

As an example Burr points to the human body. lts rnolecules


and cells. are constantly being torn apart and rebuilt with
fresh material from the food we eat. But, thanks to the
?7:, controlling L-fields, the new molecules and cells are rebuilt as
before and arrange themselves in the same pattern as the old
ones.

Evidence collected over several decades of study conirms


that an "organism possessesa field as a whole which embraces
subsidiary or local fields representing the organism's
component parts" (P. 80). Additionally, the body's L-field
'shape'
"serves as a matrix or mould which preserves the or
aTangementof any material poured into it, however often
the material may be changed" (P. 17). Burr says that numer-
ous experiments substantiate that the behavior of living
systems is a consequence of the pattern of organization
provided by the L-field (P. 106); he points out that an illustra-
tion of this is seen in the fact that abnormalities in L-field
voltages can give advance warning of future symptoms before
these are evident.

For example, malignancy in the ovary has been revealed by


L-field measurements before any clinical signs could be
observed. Such measurements, therefore, could help doctors
to detect cancer early, when there is a better chance of treat-
ing it successfully. This applies not only to the early detection
of cancer, but also to the forecast of certain psychological
and psychiatric conditions (P. 16).

Inspection of L-fields is done with special voltmeters and


electrodes which reveal different patterns or gradients in
voltages in different parts of the field (P. l7). Measurements
are taken of the "difference in voltage between two points on
-- or close to -- the surface of the living form. " For example,
"In men and women, L-field voltages can be measured by
placing one electrode on the forehead and the other on the

168
Burr found the precise moment of ovulation in a woman
can be measured by these voltage gradients. Ovulation is
preceded by a steady but substantial rise in voltage, which
falls back to normal after the egg's release. Burr's recordings
have shown why the rhythm method of birth control is
inadequate since they have revealed that some women may
ovulate over the entire menstrual period; ovulation may
occur without menstruation; menses may occur without
ovulation.

L-field measurements make it possible to measure the


effects of various stimuli to the nervous system (P. 93). And,
as Burr intimates, whatever we do to the human nervous
system we cannot change its individual and inherent design as
determined by the L-field (P.129). "Human behavior," he
says, "is the consequence of the activity of the nervous
system -- not the result of the imposition of legal and moral
laws upon the biological laws of the organism" (P. 93). "In
the case of man, . . to the physical factors of environment,
the ideological environment must be added, because an idea
is just as valid a stimulus to the nervous system as a kick in
the teeth." In fact, Burr assertsthat it can be shown without
much question that ideas are actually more important as
stimuli to the human nervous system than are other types of
stimuli. "Ideas are - or induce - emotions which evoke
energy in the nervous system" (P. 90). The well-known
Research Psychiatrist Dr. Leonard J. Ravitz, emphasized this
fact with his observation that, "Both emotional activity and
stimuli of any sort involve mobilization of electric energy as
indicated on the galvanomete. Hence, both emotions and
stimuli evoke the same energy. Emotions can be equated with
energy" (P. 89). In fact, Dr. Ravitz has discovered that strong
emotions recalled during hypnosis can cause a voltage rise of
as much as from 15 to 50 millivolts. This, Burr feels, suggests
that psychiatrists of the future will be able to measure the
intensity of grief, anger, or love, electrically (P. I 7), and that
consequently, electro-metric study of this phenomenon
seems relevant to the studv of human behavior.

169
According to Burr's findings, L-field voltages reflect mental
and emotional states as demonstrated in the fact that for
healthy, normal people, voltage rhythms can be plotted as a
steady curve which alters little over long periods (P. l8). BV
contrast, with emotionally unstable people, voltage variations
cannot be plotted as steady, regular curves; Burr confirms
"they display an erratic pattern which, in many cases,can be
detected within a few days" (P. 18). From these curves,then,
it is possible to predct in advance when the individual will be
at his best and when he will be feeling "below par" (P. l8).

Burr highlights one test situation wherein, in the group


under investigation, there was a particular student who
consistently showed a higher L-field voltage than all the rest.
It was subsequently learned that the boy had a history of
emotional instability. A few months after the experiment, he
became definitely psychotic and had to be remanded to an
institution (P. 85-86).

As part of the same experiment mentioned above, Yale


psychiatrists divided patients into three groups: (1) obvious
deviates from normal behavior, (2) those that were reasonably
normal, and (3) an intermediategroup. L-field measurements
were carried out, but without the electro-metric investigator
knowing to which group an individual belonged. At the
conclusion of the experinlent, the patients were again divided
into three groups: (1) those with markedly changed electro-
metrics, (2) those with relatively little change, and (3) an
intermediate group.

Finally, the groups selected by the psychiatrists were


compared with the groups selected by the electro-metric
investigator who - it should be emphasized - knew nothing
about the psychiatric diagnosis. Burr notes that the "results
of the study showed clearly that the goup consisting of
those markedly deviated from normal behavior by psychiatric
examination also showed a similar deviation in electro-metric
examination"(P.86).

170
But beyond conditions peculiar to specific groups or indivi-
duals, L-fields, Burr asserts, " . . . by their very nature must
be influenced by the all-powerful fields of the cosmos* and
must, therefore, be an integral part of its overall design, In
'chain
other words, L-fields are links in a of authority.'
This starts with the simplest living forms, runs upward
through all life on this planet to the most complex form we
know - man - and then extends outward into space and
upward to an infinite authority, about which we can only
\f speculate" (P. 114). And, "since it is common knowledge
that one field cannot exist within another field without an
interaction between them, and that the field properties of
the ionosphere are modified by the bursts of sunspot activity,
the effect of these extraterrestrial fields on the electrical
characteristics of the environment of the earth are really no
more than might be expected "(P. 105).

Burr proved this by measuring the change in voltage


gradients of a number of trees over a 30 year period. He
found that the L-fields of the trees fluctuated with sunlight,
darkness, sunspots, magnetic storms and moon cycles. From
this we can extrapolate that human L-fields are similarly
affected.

"Since the field of a living system is an ordered pattern,


it must be a part of the overall or general pattern which
represents the Universe. [t can be argued, therefore, that the
Universe is an electrical field and that everything that exists
in it is a subsidiary or component part of the total field"
(P. I27). Thus, it is submitted, "That we are fully justified
in regarding the ields of life as the instruments of physical
evolution, of which - on this planet at least - the human
nervous system is the masterpiece"(P.129).

*
Dr, Oliver Reiser,with conceptsand languagevery similar to that of
Dr, Burr, has written about the possibleeffects of guiding fields of
influencewhich emanatefrom a cosmic source,and which direct the
architecturalpatternfor earth'sorganisms(3,P.4421.

t7l
RADIONIC ENERGY The theory underlying Radionic Energies, or the practice of
Radiesthesia, embrace some of the same key principles upon
which Dr. Burr's L-field theory is founded. A further consi-
deration of Radionics and Radiesthesia should serve to
illumine this point.

Radionics is a branch of Radiesthesia; and Radiesthesia


may be defined as "sensitivity to radiations" - to radiations
from any source - living or inert*. Dr. Robert Massy explains
that since the atomic and molecular structures of all
substances are in a state of motion they emit radiations that
can be detected by the radionics operator and the radi-
esthesist.(48, P. l4).

The late George De La Warr, a veteran radionics pioneer,


once explained that "a basic idea in radionics is that each
individual, organism, or material, radiates and absorbs energy
via an energy-field peculiar to itself. The more complex
the material, the more complex the waveform. Living things,
like humans, emit a very complex wave spectrum of which
parts are associated with the various organs and systems of
the body" (9).

Radionics differ from other branches of Radiesthesia, e.g.


Divining and Dowsing, in that electronic equipment is used to
help the human "operator" detect the particular radiation
under investigation. Mark Gallert, N.D., an American, is
internationally known as one of the leading authorities on
the use of radionic equipment. He explains that the elec-
tronic parts used in the "Radionic Analyzer" are essentially
the same as those found in most popular electronic equip-
ment, but that the circuitry is quite different from conven-
tional electronic systems, since the "analyzer" works on
principles not generally known to electronics or electricity
(G).
George de la Warr

* In the presentcontext,theterm"radiation"embraces theconceptof


',rateof vibraton',
and thusis takento be virtua||y
synonymouswith
theterm"vibration."

172
Dr. Gallert reveals further that radionic energies are subtle
energies which are not usually considered by conventional
science, and that the nerve tissues of the hands of the
"operator" are used to detect these energieswhich have been
"tuned in" by the Radionic Analyzer. Dr. Gallert explains
that to successfully operate the Radionic Analyzer requires a
kind of "sensitivity" latent or undeveloped in most people.
Each person in a healthy state, Galbrt elaborates,has his own
electro-chemical balance. When illness or disease occurs,
this balance is upset (G). The radionic equipment, when used
for treatment, "tunes"radionic energies to the individual and
thereby restores a healthy balance. According to Gallert,
the outstanding principle of radionics is that of "resonance,"
i.e. establishing resonance with the radiations of the indivi-
dual, measuring their amplitude and then finding the remedy
which best resonates with a particular malady. Thus the
organ or system is returned to its healthy vibration (G). The
strength of the energies used in radionic treatment is on the
order of nerve cunents, and not the large currents normally
used for therapeutic treatment (G). Gallert maintains that
one big advantage of radionics is its ability to go beyond the
effect and find the cause of complaints.

Dr. Mark Gallert

173
While much of radionic diagnosis and treatment deals with
physiological conditions, there are vast and significant non-
physiological domains of the human personality into which it
also delves. Particularly, Dr. Gallert's equipment, which is
unique among radionic devices in that it has a much larger
tuning panel (45 separate tuning dials), is capable of a broad
scope of diagnostic work. The "analyzer", Gallert reveals,
detects emotional stress by revealing the relation between
the conscious mind and the sub-conscious mind. Under
normal waking conditions, he explains, the rate of activity
of the conscious mind should exceed that of the sub-conscious
mind, but within certain definite limits. But Gallert maintains
that seriously disturbed people show a reversal of this rela-
tionsfup with the sub-conscious mind showing a high rate of
activity as compared to that of the conscious mind (G), (G-l ).

Another behavioral aspect of radionic energiesinvolves what


Dr. Gallert terms "white light." This phenomenon was origin-
ally discovered by A. Stanley Rogers under whom Gallert
studied.

Dr. Gallert's "Radionic Analvzer"

r74
One of the means by which Gallert detects the presence of
"white light" is by placing the pick-up electrodes, connected
,,ana|yze,,,
to the directly in the sunlight. With the proper
dial setting on the instrument's tuner panel, a maximum
"white light" reading is established. Maintaining this dial
setting over a 24-horr period, it is discovered that some
amount of "white light", albeit less in intensity, is continu-
ously present, even in darkness (G). From this Gallert
concludes that, while the sun is the continuous source of
''whit
light'' its presence is not restricted to the visible wave-
lengths of solar radiations, but that some additional, all-
pervading, sun-generatedenergy factor is present upon earth
at all times (G), (G-l l).

Elaborating on this phenomenon, Gallert asserts that all


of the earth's organisms, all humans, absorb varying amounts
of "white light," depending on factors apparently inherent
within the organism itself. Moreover, the amount of "white
light" will also vary depending on factors apparently inherent
within the organism itself. Moreover, the amount of "white
light" will also vary depending on geographical location (G).
Gallert, who has been engaged in radionic research for over
27 yearc, says he has confirmed this latter peculiarity over a
period of years by taking readings as he travelled throughout
the United States and abroad, and that some cities, towns,
and communities do not have as much "white lieht" as do
others (G).

Dr. Gallert explains that the biological significance of


"white light" is that it is a constructive energy and helps to
insure good health. But "white light" is not associated with
physical well-being alone, it also has a bearing on one's
emotions and mental state. Gallert reports, on the basis
of results obtained on his Radionic Analyzer, primarily with
adults, that a happy, constructive person measures greater
"white light" than does one who is morose and negative in
attitude (G-1).

Thus far, we have reviewed aspects of radionic energies


as they might pertain to the physical and psychological
dimensions of human behavior - but the matter does not
t75
Photographof the standard radionic diagnosticinstrumentused by the De La Warr
(CourtesyDe La Warr Laboratories).
Researchers.

t76
end there. Dr. Gallert points out that besides the visible
physical body, man has a series of finer bodies (not normally
visible) - the Auric Bodies. These are graduated according to
the density of their constituent material - the lower the
density, the higher the speed of vibration of the atoms
forming the material of a particular auric vehicle (G), (G-1).
After man's physical body, and in order of decreasingdensity
and increasing "fineness," the names given to the various
auric bodies are:

l) etheric body (or vital body)


2) astral body (or emotional body)
3) mental body
4) causal body (G-1)*

Gallert notes that auric bodies interpenetrate the physical


body and each other, and that there is no spot inside the
physical body that is not also inside and a part of each of
the auric bodies (G-1). It would be an error, Gallert says,
to think that auric bodies are only nimbuses that surround
the physical body. Weaknessesor adverse conditions existing
in an auric body, which hamper the flow of energy at that
level, can have a corresponding adverse effect upon the
physical body or upon human behavioral modes (G-11**.

The "tuned electronic analytical equipment" devised by


Gallert can be used to determine the auric level at which
any trouble or damage is located, , and treatment directed
selectively to the appropriate auric'level (G), (G-1). Gallert
confirms that the principle of "vibratory resonance" applies
to man's auric bodies, just as it does to the grosser (denser)
physical vehicle (G). A term which Gallert has used in con-
nection with radionic analysis and treatment of human auric
levels is "Esoteric Electronics" (G-l).
* Otheraspectsof humanauricfunctionsarediscussed in succeeding
pages,wherewe see that the humanaura consistsof sevenbodies,
according Hills.
to Dr. Christopher
** Dr. RalphSierrahassuggested factorsassocia-
that electromagnetic
ted yvithsomeweather conditions
mightalsoaffecthumanauricbodies
(c-21.
177
An obvious and perpetual question that arisesin Dr. Gallert's
work is, "What kind of energies are being dealt with?"
Gallert replies, "That is difficult to say," but, "in my view it
is a complex of energies including some known factors and
probably some unknown ones" (G). Gallert explains that
radionic energies interact with a number of known energies--
magnetism, light, static electricity, and radio waves - but
cannot be identified as belonging to this group of electro-
magnetic forces (G). Aqd further to this, he observes that
radionic energies manifest differently at each level of the
human make-up. Concluding, Gallert says, "I know how to
use it, I know how to get the effects I am after" (G). But
precise detals of what radionic energy is, and exactly how it
is governed, still elude Gallert, even after 27 years work in
the field.

Interpenetrating Auric Bodies

178
RADIESTHESIA* Radiesthesia differs from radionics in that the operator
realizes that the instrument of detection is his 37-mile long
nervous system, which in turn is tuned to different vibrations
of this subtle energy by the power of his consciousness
(48, P. z4f '*rne raiesthesist does not shun radionics but
realizes that the radionic analyzers are merely extensions of
the operator's consciousness. In this regard the radiesthesist
chooses to use the more convenient pendulum as his ampli-
fier and selector of this subtle energy.

Unfortunately, most people,on first use of a pendulum, do


not know the above principle, nor are they aware of the
necessity of tuning the pendulum to resonate with their
own nervous system, and hence their results are not consis-
tent. Dr. RobertMassy's Alive to the Universeis a handbook
which leads the reader step-by-stepinto becoming a radies-
thesist, including the tuning of the pendulum with the aid
of a compass (48, P. 40) and the detection of positive and
negative magnetic energies from the north and south poles
of the compass(48,P.42).

ln extensive tests over a ten year period, Dr. Christopher


Hills has shown that 80 percent of the population can
readily develop the sensitivity needed to tune into these
subtle radiations (42, P. 68 ). He has made this easier by
developing a line of selective pendulums pre-tuned to
specific energies and containing amplifiers inherent within
their design. The pendulums and their specific wave fields
are shown in the following table. The success of this
approach is summed up by Yanni Toussulist who, on
completing a weekend seminar on Aura Balancing by Massy,
noted that, to his amazement, everyone of the eighteen

" The ideas presentedin these pages are taken from "Alive to the
Universe"by Dr. Robert Massy(48).
** George
and Marjorie De La Warr are the first to admit that con-
sciousnessis the power behindtheir instruments.
Y a n n i T o u s s u I i si s a c o u n s e | i npgs y c h o | o g i satn d instructorin trans-
personalpsychologyat Antioch CollegeWest.

179
PENDULUM WAVE FIELD USES 4 8 ,P . :

Merkhet Thought waves Thought reading and l0l


insight validation
Spectrum Mirror Auric energies Positive & negative 97
conditions of the chakras
Hills Positive Green Life force & Charging with life force 89
pyramid energies & measuringorganc
qualities of foods
Left-hand Spiral Mirror Negative fields Evaluating teachers,authori- 94
ties, political leaders, etc.
Pi-Ray Supersensor Cells, Tissues Disease, cancer 99
and biophysical electricity
Plain Wood, Point Below Emotional fields Changingmoods, recording 92
the chemical secretions from
the endocrinesystem
Turenne Magnet-fitted Horizontal magnetic, The radiesthesistsbasic 86
Pendulum Vertical electric & researchtool for subtle
East-Westflows energies

180
participants accomplished :

a) use of the Hills Positive Green pendulum to


detect life forces from people, plants and foods,
b) use of the Ankh divining rod to locate under-
ground streams of water,
c) use of the Spectrum Mirror and Positive Green
pendulums to detect and balance auric fields,
d) visual ability to see each other's auras and the
subtle changes in the aura colors with mood.

Massy states that although he carries a complete set of


pendulums, as pictured on the previous page, some of their
functions overlap. He cautions beginners to choose their
pendulums according to their needs.

MASSY'S LAWS I asked Massy to explain his laws of radiesthesia in terms


OF RADIESTHESIA of the content of this work. The five laws are:
First Law
IF IT EXISTS, IT IS KNOWN.
Since everything vibrates it gives off radiation. The radia-
tions of all thoughts and all entities from the past or the
present are contained in the universal field. Radiesthesists
can tap into this storehouse of knowledge (48, P.I27).

Second Law
THE PENDULUM WILL RESPOND TO WHATEVER
CONCEPTS ARE IN YOUR MIND.
Words convey different meanings to different people
depending on their experiences. So seeming inconsistencies can
arise due to different levels of consciousness(48,P.53).

Third Law
WHAT WORKS FOR ONE PERSON DOES NOT
NECESSARILY WORK FOR ANOTHER.

t8r
Fourth Law
IF IT WORKS FOR YOU, USE IT.
ln laws three and four, Massy is referring to technique.
Their purpose is to allow the radiesthesist to become his
own authority and not be under pressure to conform to
another'sreality (48,P. 57).

Fifth Law
THE ACCURACY OF YOUR RESULTS IS PROPORTION-
AL TO THE QUALITY OF YOUR CONSCIOUSNESS.
Doubt, anxiety, overconfidence, wishful thinking, etc. in
the radiesthesist all create wave fields of the same order as
those being detected and hence interfere with the results.
Clear consciousnessgivespure results.(48, P. 104).

DR ROBERT MASSY
AURA BALANCING Using a Spectrum Mirror pendulum, Massy detects the
rotation of the vortex of energy emitting from one chakra
at a time. If the rotation is clockwise indicating a positive
field he leaves it alone. Anticlockwise rotations of negative
energy are interpreted on a proportional scale, e.g. two
swings indicate a problem of the same order of magnitude
as a common cold, four swings: flu, twenty: breakdown of
tissues, continually negative: cancer. These readings are
taken over each of the seven chakras corresponding to the
physical, social, intellectual,emotional, conceptual,intuitive
and imaginative parts of the aura. For each reading the
pendulum is tuned to the color that resonates with that
chakra, and the energies recorded. Then the radiesthesist
tunes into the person's subconsciousto determine the true
cause of the manifested problem. Massy says, "There is no

P^an
Julum 9win3 Posilivc Combinafion .a',ral.enissions
+Tllows Vorex chokro ehergy 'pSewn.dr un lguSm

As vieweJ Chongilo
'rop cond i|on
fro- U"***n
Senal 3wt^gs
2,1 " ..e
uil,*a-T6i
@ a
2(d,,sl,ght r.coY*y 2(), a coU

@@
*""t"ujl'*r'"F'o"o ncgafrve
4{-),{lu
^dicot'"9 d3rees of
N ega r ve
rrrrbolance
heallh or d,seose

183
point in removing the negative energies and replacing them
with positive ones and making the person feel great for a
few days, if a few weeks later the problem returns because
the causehas not been worked on."

Once the cause has been determined the energies are


changed using the Hills Positive Green and the person feels
a tingling, light, peaceful sensation over his entire being. The
process of problem identification is so fast it has been
likened to two years on the psychiatrist's couch. More and
more medical doctors and psychologists are using this
technique with or without the patient present since a
witness of the patient in the form of a bloodspot, photo-
graph or hair gives the same results.

LOCATION EXPERIMENTS When asked about location of missing people, places and
objects by map dowsing, Massy comments that there is a
difficulty with scientifically documenting the results, because
of the human variable and the fact that most people do not
report back the results to the diviner.

The most recent person who did report back was Delores
Crayton who consulted Massy with a map of the Washington-
Vancouver, British Columbia area and asked where she would
find a new home for her and her children. Divining over the
map, Dr. Massy pinpointed. a corner of Orcas Island. Three
weeks later, he received a note from Mrs. Crayton from
which the following is extracted.

. . "My new homeis exactlywhereyou saidit wouldbe. . We


found the house the first day and also a place to live for a few weeks
while we are in escrow - both happenings apparently considered
'impossible'here . . Thanks for being there when I came by."
SUPERSENSONICS In his book Supersensonics Hills takes the subject of subtle
energies into the deeper realms of consciousness. He says,
"Supersensonics is a practical tool for developing direct
perception into the mysteries of Nature. This new science is
an awesome tool limited only by the user's own conscious-
ness. If this Aladdin's lamp should fall into the hands of
one whose consciousness has been refined and purified,
Supersensonics can bring him close to omniscience." Hills
continues in his book Nuclear Evolution.

"Throughout history there have been few diviners who developed


the Supersense and found the secret of color and the chakra functions.
For probing the nature of our self we can save ourselves years of work
by using the colors of our aula as an indicator of our evolutonary
level, the levels of light and color intake we lack and need to work on,
plus the levels we can relate to others on effectively and ineffectvely'
We can learn how to extract from light the particular colors we need
Supersensonics -- the to synthesize for health and growth of the Supersense in us.
radiesthesists'
encyclopedia

Colors have been associatedwith chakra


unctionsfor centuries,but al|ofthis mater- /a
ial has been contradictory and based on 7 Violet limaginationl
unreable opinion unsupportedby research
ChristopherHills maintainsthatthe theory 6 I n d i g o( i n t u i t i o n )
of Nuclear Evolution is the first systematic
correlation of chakra functions with the Blue (concepts)
spectmmand the first to provethat levelsof
consciousnessnot only have direct corres- 4 G r e e n( e m o t i o n s )
pondencewith specificpersonalitypatterns
but also with colors. Various tests and
3 Yellow(intellect)
checkswith clairvoyantswho seethe colors
agree that the Hills system is the only
Orange(social)
reliable outline. since most traditional
chakra colors were used as teachingdevices.
Hills arrived at his resultsby Supersenson- Red (physical)
ic methods which were then checked out AIt these rspretent diront leve|s of physi.
with psychologists and other scientists. ca| and menta| unctioning which interace
W i t h o u r s p i r i t u | | o v a | 3o f p e r c e p t i o n .
Hence he has come up with a completely
original system which correspondsto the
realities of physics and the experience of
time and the nature of light

185
By taking a Supersensonic instrument and measuring our own color
emanations, dvining our physical needs and psychic needs, we can
learn to mx all the light colors in our environment as well as the
inner worlds of psychophysical energies. The effects of reflected
colors from was, flowers and objects in the environment can pro-
foundly affect the flow of psychic electricity through the chakra
system even though they do not have the power to condition and
create our level of consciousness the same way light colors do. We can
actually take in the vibrations of color like we take in food to nourish
the body. So it is important to be able to detect with the Supersense
just what colors we need at different times of the day and whether
they are the colors of light from radiant sources such as sun or lamps
or stars, or are reflected from pigment light sources.

The neuro-muscularresponseof the


diviner's instrumentis caused bV a
r e s o n a n c ep h e n o m e n o nw i t h l i g h t .
The aura oendulum reactswhen the
cursor is set to a pigment color
b e c a u s et h e u n c o n s c i o u sm i n d c a n
sense the different colors of the
chakra functions when the thought
o f t h a t c o l o r i s h e l d .I n t h e s a m ew a y
a witnessof the color can be held in
t h e h a n d . l t e n a b l e sa n y o n et o u s e
their sixth sense (the Supersense)
w h i c h i s h i g h l yd e v e l o p e di n a n i m a l s ,
birds, insects,etc. and latentin man.
D r , C h r i s t o p h eH
r ills
"Su persenson ics"

186
Hills' research shows that the human body is a resonating
system whose aura can be measured according to the excite-
ment of the electron shells around the atoms of our bodies.
Various reactions can be detected with the instruments of
Supersensonics, such as dowsing rods, rules and pendulums,
which react at specific distances away from a psychic center.
These centers set up edges or outlines of spherical wave-
fields depending on the health of the person and the number
of chakras functioning. In a healthy person, Hills states, the
pendulum reacts at approximately 13, 19,25,50-55, 62,68
and 80 cms. away from the center of a sphere around each
chakra center.

L-field of L-l3 to L-80 nodal


points around a healthy human.

68 62 55 50 25 19 13

187
The earth itself receives light from the cosmos like a giant
chakra and within its magnetic field there are subsidiary
vortexes spiralling around several centers which resonate
with different types of crystal structures upon the earth.

According to Hills the spherical field which surrounds the


earth corresponds to the universal ield that surrounds the
human body showing an L-field of 13 to L-80 -- resonant
nodal points which make the pendulum "come alive" when
passed over the invisible field edges at seven points which
correspond to one of the colors of the spectrum. Horizontal
or vertical polarity of the color is determined by its being in
phase with the vertical electric plane at right angles to the
horizontal magnetic plane. The human consciousness
resonates to vertical electric energy at mental levels of mind
PITUITARYGLAND energy and horizontal magnetic relates to emotional chemical
energies in the human body. These in turn correspond to the
THYROID
neryous system's seven plexus electromagnetic energies and
GLANO the endocrine system's seven chemical hormones.

ADRENAL GLANDS

PANCREAS

THE ENDOCRINE GLANDS


SEX GLANDSI E n d o c r i n eg l a n d s r e g u l a t em a n y v i t a l b o d y
OVARIES processes. The thyroid helps control
energy production; the parathyro.d distibutes
calcium between blood and bone. Adrenal
g l a n d s r e g u | a t es a | t a n d w a t e r | e v | s
and secrete stimulants; cells in the pancreas
control blood sugar. Sex glands govern
reproduction and secondary sexual
characteristics.The pituitary controls some
o f t h e o t h e r e n d o c r i n eg l a n d s .

188
DR CHRISTOPHER HILLS

189
CHAKRA ENERGIES
CHAKRA ENERGIES

physical body
etheric body
emotional body
astral body
mental body

The traditional idea that man had five bodies or sheathsof different statesof subtle
matter did not take into account man's ability to use the Supersensewhich adds two
more dimensionsof consciousness on the intuitional|eveIand the imaginaton Ieve|.It is
now known that energiesin the electromagneticspectrumvibrate in bands. Different
individualsare tuned to different parts of this spectrumand thereforemay disagreein
their descriptionsof reality.The continuumof consciousness extendsthe electromagnetic
spectrumand is divided into transpersona| bandswhchcorrespondwith theseseven|eve|s
r i l l s ," N u c l e a rE v o l u -
o f e n e r g yw h i c h c a n b e c a l l e db o d i e so r v e h i c l e s-.D r . C h r i s t o p h eH
tion" l44,P.35).

t9l
THE ENERGIES Earlier, in our discussion of radionic energies, mention was
made of man's auric bodies. A predominant aspect of the
human auric structure, particularly of the etheric body, is
that of the Chakra System.* The term "chakra" is derived
from Sanskrit and means a revolving wheel. Researchers agree
that there are seven principal chakra centers located along
the spine and they are generally described as a series of wheel-
like energy vortices in the surface of the etheric body of man,
force centers of a saucer-like depression which provide points
of connection at which enegy flows from one of man's
vehicles or bodies, to another. The late Bishop C. W.
Leadbeater, noted clairvoyant and Theosophical investigator,
observed that these chakra "wheels" are perpetually rotating,
and into the hub or open mouth of each, a force is always
flowing, and that without this inrush of energy the physical
body could not exist (41, P. 5).

*
Throughout the remainderof this volume, referenceis made to
numerous accounts given by individuals possessingthe "psychic"
faculty of clairvoyance.The writer feelsthat to try and "make a case"
for the existenceof supra-normal perceptionis not within the intentof
,,proo,,of the exist-
this work, Thus, shou|dthe readerdesirefurther
ence of c|arvoyance,he is referredto some of the sourcesIistedin the
presentbibliographicreference,or to the authorsor publishersof those
works for additional explanativetexts, Some observationson the
faculty of clairvoyanceare offered in the introductionto this section.

t92
According to reliable clairvoyant observations, the chakra
has numerous lines of force radating outward from a
common center -- this is seen to result from a "primary"
force of external origin which enters the center of the chakra
(41, P.7). The words of C.W. Leadbeater continue the
narrative of the effects of this incoming force:
'The energy which pours into each chakra center from without sets up

at right angles to itself, secondary forces in undulatory circular motion,


just ai a bar magnet thrust into an induction coil produces a current of
electricity which flows around the coil at right angles to the axis of the
magnet. Each of the secondary forces which sweep round the chakra
has its own characteristic wavelength, just as has light of a certain color;
but instead of moving in a straight line as light does, it moves along
relatively large undulations of various sizes, each of which is some
multiple of the smaller wayelengths within it. The secondary force
weaves itself under and over the radiating currents of the primary force,
just as a basket-work might be woven round the spokes of a carriage
wheel. The wavelengths are infinitesimal, and probably thousands of
them are included within one of the undulations. As the forces rush
round in the vortex, these oscillations of different sizes, crossing one
another in this basket-work fashion, produce a flower-like form."
(41,P. 7-8)

As previously indicated, the seven major chakra centers are


located along the etheric counterpart of the physical spine,
and the energy which flows between these centers ties them
into a single system with constant nteraction between each
unit. Moreover, Dr. Christopher Hills, a widely recognized
authority on chaka energies and their effects, reports that
the whirling vortex of energy within each chakra is actually a
spiral, and that the energy passing through that spiral does so
at a different angle for each chakra. Although it is the same
energy coursing through the system, this difference of angle,
Hills claims, produces a different manifestation of the energy
in each chakra (J). Continuing, Hills reports that there are
also present and flowing within the human chakra system,
polarized energies: positive and negative. These are comple-

t93
mentary forces which exert a mutual stimulation, one upon
the other; once the flow is completed for one side of the
chakra system, the energy then moves back down the
opposite side of the system, thus continuously alternating
between the positive and negative channels (J). Further,
according to Hills, in each chakra there is a definite cross-
over point for the positive and negative flows of energy. If, at
this cross-over point a balancing of the two energies occurs,
an "exalted state of consciousness" results, the nature of
which depends on, in which chakra the balancing occurs. But
to achieve such an effect, both forms of energy must flow at
equal amplitude and frequency (J). Balancing at the root
chakra is a result of climaxing during sexual intercourse.

Dr. Hills has also contributed observations regarding the


interaction between the chakras and the external environ-
ment. He explains that chakra energy of many fine bending
lines spirals outwards from the center of the chakra creating a
force-field which is constantly interacting with the environ-
ment and detecting electrical tensionstherein. Consequently,
when clouds pass overhead carrying static charges, these
forces are naturally but unconsciously picked up by the
human body. In a like manner, Hills maintains that, as the
sun's rays impinge upon us at different times of the day, we
are affected differently by them, the chakra system being the
detecting apparatusn both above instances (J). The fact is,
Hills expounds, an individual's intake and utilization of
incoming solar and cosmic radiation is determined by the
internal conditions of energy flow within one's own chakra
system. Thus, if an individual is properly "polarized," he
soaks up more of the cosmic radiation than one who is not
properly "polarized," in which case the cosmic energy simply
passes right through this latter person's body (J). Hills'
observation is corroborated by the work of Bishop Leadbeater
who has pointed out that the efficiency of the chakra system,
e.g. how much energy is taken in from environment, how
well this energy is distributed and utilized within the system
itself, varies with the individual (41 , P. 5).

r94
'-:r'-
-L-'
t-,

The second chakra is a six-petaled lotus. It has six whorls of energy, whereas the bottom
chakra has four and the top chakra has one thousand, The movements of this energy in each
chakra are you. If the vortices are swirling to the left, the entire lotus will also spin to leftward
like a turning ferris wheel, and the life-force of the universe wll be sucked in negatively. The
aTowsof the left.hand diagram show this sucking in or absorbing of the light of consciousness:
..getting'' ..taking'' vibration of a
the or selfish person. The same chakra with its eneryes
spinning in right-hand spirals and turning like a wheel to the right, takes in the light of the
universe in a positive way and radiates it out in love and selflessness. Such a person has a
bright aura.
Diagram and caption courtesy of Dr. Ann Ray, "Journey Into Light" (50, P. 79).

19s
Symbolic representation of the chakras and their distribution io.the etheric counterpart
of the human physical organism. Note that from numbers I through 7, the symbols depict
increasing complexity of design - this reportedly reflects an actual graduated complexity
in chakra function and ateof bration, with th cown center being the most complex
and having the highest rate of vibration, whilethe sacral or root center is the least complex
and with the lowest rate of vibration. (Courtesy Astara)

196
CHAKRAS AND ASSOCI- As already suggested, chakra energies are not phenomena
ATED BTOLOGTCAL/ which are limited to assessmentand understanding exclusive-
BEHAVIORAL SYSTEMS ly witfun a framework of vibrations, radiations, and undula-
tions. Physical health, as well as emotional and mental factors
are intimately associated with the various functions of the
chakra system.

Dr. Gallert tells us that the chakra centers are points of


interchanging energies between man's etheric* and physical
bodies. And besides that, that there are currents of energy
flowing from one chakra to another at the same auric level.
These energy flows, Gallert asserts, are vital to the continu-
ance of the state of "aliveness"of the physical vehicle (G-1).
Ideally, Gallert resumes, the flow should be equal for each
current at each of the life centers. However, many things
occur in life which tend to set up blockages or restrictions to
full flow, and most individuals show a gradual narrowing or
lessening of the flow from one chakra to the next. [n persons
having serious problems with health, emotions, or thoughts,
one finds sudden drop-offs, large reductions in the flow of
energiesat one or more of the chakra centers.

*
Another researcher,Phoebe Bendit, reports as follows: "Occult
scienceteachesthat the energiesinvolvedin etheric phenomenaare,in
nature, the same as those of the remainderof the electromagnetic
range.They are subtlerand have a shorterwavelength,while potential
differencesare very much smaller.Here we are dealingwith energies
possiblyexpressiblein terms of micro-microvolts,
or one billionthof a
v o l t " ( 3 7 ,P . 1 6 ) .

Still further, C. W. Leadbeaterhas noted that the particlesof the


ethericpart of man's body are constantlychangingjust as are thoseof
the denserphysicalbody. This ethericmatteris allegedlythrown off via
the pores, as is gaseousmatter, so that when two persons are close
togethereach necessarilyabsorbsmuch of the physicalemanationsof
t h e o t h e r( 4 1 ,P . 6 6 ) .

197
It becomes apparent, then, that there are several different
kinds (wavelengths) of energies with varying degrees of
admixture or compounding, flowing through man's chakra
system. And one of the principal energies in this regard,
noted by Bishop Leadbeater,is that of the "vitality" radiation
whose source is the sun, and which manifests itself in the
physical, as well as the emotional and mental dimensions of
the human make-up (41, P. 35 & 42). Leadbeater contends
that the "vitality" force emanating from the sun is not to be
confused with electricity, though it in some ways resembles
electricity (41, P.43). Extending this view, Dr. Gallert has
noted that the vital life energy needed to keep the human
body alive, is progressively stepped down in intensity through
the various auric bodies of increasing density, with the final
step-down and energy transfer occurring between the etheric
and the physical body (G-l).
Virtually all researchers of chakra phenomena recognize a
further linking between the chakra complex and man's
physiological/behavioral systems. This involves the associa-
tion of particular chakra centers with specific ganglia of the
autonomic nervous system, and with specific glands of the
body's endocrine system. One distinguished clairvoyant
researcher,Mrs. Phoebe Bendit, has noted that the "relation
between the chakras and the autonomic and endocrine
systems . is more than merely spacial or anatomical, it
is also functional. And when a major endocrine change such
as that of puberty takes place in the body it is accompanied
by -- indeed, preceded by -- a coTesponding change of
consciousness, or psychic activity, and the chakras are
directly related to the psychic state of the individual" 137,
P.26). A chart in this section shows the various correspond-
ences between the chakras, the nerve plexuses, and the
endocrine glands, as generally accepted by researchersin the
field.
Several observations are available on the functional nature
of the chakra-neural-endocrinetie-in. Mrs. Bendit has written
that the chakras, taken collectively, ae a manifestation of
the whole of the individual in action.

r98
Nothing, she maintains, of non-physical man becomes effec-
tive in the dense worlds except through the chakras. Illustrat-
ing this point, she notes that if the chakra associated with the
solar plexus becomes paralyzed, whether from psychic inhibi-
tion or by the misuse of drugs, emotion will not be felt in
physical consciousness, while inhibitions of the head centers
will cancel the expressionof thought orintuition (37,P.24).
It is now well established that the pituitary gland functions in
a controlling or governing role with respect to the other
glands of the endocrine system.Bendit assertsthat the chakra
corresponding to the pituitary gland is also extremely import-
ant in maintaining the general balance of the lower chakra
centers (37, P.26). Continuing her assessmentof the various
chakra functions, Bendit reveals the following: "A highly
intellectual person who had remained emotionally infantile,
may have a labile, shallow, unprotected solar plexus chakra
which makes him prey to hysteria and lack of control. One
who may be very intelligent, but who has no creative ability,
may find himself with an immature throat center, and hence
liable to temporary loss of voice. Physically, functional heart
-25 trouble, and emotionally, the inability to love may be linked
with the chakra corresponding to the heart. Sexual aberra-
tions are often associatedwith the sacral center" (37,P.29).

Another outstanding contemporary clairvoyant, Mr. Geoffrey


Hodson, relates that the solar chakra is the receiving station
for all sub-conscious emotional vibrations, which are
conveyed by that chakra to the physical solar plexus nerve
ganglion. Further, Hodson reports that one of the basic
functions of the spleen chakra is the absorption, assimilation,
and distribution of life force. According to him, lowered
vitality and nervous debility can frequently be traced to
malfunction of this chakra (38, P. 125). This view of the
spleen center's function is supported by the perception of
Leadbeater, who observed that that particular chakra
"specializes" "vitality" radiation whose source is the sun
( 1 4 ,P . 3 5 ) .

r99
CHAKRA-NEURAL-ENDOCRJNE CORRESPONDENCES

Sanskrit English *Surface


Nameof Chakra Name of Chakra Location NeuralPlexus EndocrineGland

Sahasrara Crown Top of Head Brain Dendrites Pineal

Ajna Brow Mid-Brow Carotid,Medulla Pituitary


Oblongata

Vishuddha Throat At the Throat Pharyngeal, Thyroid and


Plexus Cervicus Para-Thyroid
t\)
o Anahata Heart Over the Heart Cardiac Thymus
o

Manipura Solar Area of Solar Plexus Coeliac,Solar, Adrenals(and


Plexus Epigastricus possiblePancreas)

Swadhisthana Spleen Over the Spleen Splenic,Plexus Spleen


Hypogastricus

Muladhara Sacral Baseof Spine Coccygeal,Sacral Gonads

*The
root of each chakra energy vortex is reportedlycenteredat a definite point along the etheric counterpartof the human
spine and not in the organ itself. Nevertheless, the chakra mouth, the bell-likesurfaceopening,is often describedas being
generallylocated near or over a specific organ,hence the name given to a particularcenter.
THE CHAKRAS AND THE NERVOUS SYSTEM

(7) Crown Center

(6) Brow Center

Carotid plexus

Superior cervical I cervical spinal ganglion


sympathetic ganglion

Pharyngeal plexus

(s)Throat Center
I thoracic spinal ganglion

Spinal cord
Pulmonary plexus

Cardiac plexus
(4) Heart Sympathetic trunk
Center
Diaphragm
Splenic plexus
(3) Solar Center

I lumbar spinal ganglion


Solar plexus
(2) Spleen Center

l sacral spinal ganglon

Pelvic plexuses Coccygeal spinal ganglion


Coccygealplexus
Sacral Center (1)
TIE-IN MECHANISMS It would be useful to include in this overview of chakra
energy, some discussion of the possible linking mechanisms
between the chakras and their corresponding physiolog.call
behavioral systems. Three leading researchers of chakra
phenomena provide us with further insight into the matter.
First, Professor William Tiller, Chairman, Department of
Material Sciences, Stanford University, has offered the follow-
ing tentative explanation of the chakra/endocrine tie-in:

"The function of these chakra/endocrine pairs is very much like that


of power receiving stations and transmitting stations in our vehicles.
Both power and information are tapped from a cosmic or environmen-
tal source into the etheric. It is transduced into a different form into
the physical, is used to function in lfe and, in transmuted form is
radiated through the endocrine lchakra unit back into the envronment.
The currents in the individual circuits provide important energies for
various parts of the body. In princple we can think of great energy
streams flowing through space and passing through our bodies
unabsorbed and unnoticed unless we tune the chakra to couple with
this power source and transduce some of its energy into the etheric
system (40, P. l7-19).

These seven endocrine centers have been called our sacred centers, and
through them we radiate transmitting information of a quality
(frequency) associated with that center. As an example, the thymus
gland is supposed to be the center that controls the quality of love in all
its spectral range from hate through the various expressions of what we
call love. Now, I postulate that an entity radiates from ths gland a field
that is broadcast through space and is absorbed in the similar gland by
another entity. This stimulates the gland and generates some biological
activity within the organism. If the second entity radiates an in-phase
vibration back to the first, then the love consciousness can form a bond
between them. Now, if the first entity radiates at small power and over
a very limited range of expression, then only a few selected individuals
will receive this radiation and be aware of this love. However, if the
entity has built himself to radiate at large power and over a very broad
band of the spectral distribution, then many, many entities will receive
this radiation, be aware of this love and be nourished by this love. Snce

202
most of the audiences of Christ did not understand him intellectually,
I suspect that the reason they had such a great response to him was
because he was transmitting from this gland at very, very high power
levels with very, very broad transmission which was received by,
absorbed by, and served to nourish, many people. They were aware of
it only at an organismic level" (40,P.20).

Next, there is the suggestionof Bishop Leadbeater that, so


far as. the emotional and mental dimensions of rnan are
concerned, the chakras apparently serve as a kind of transmit-
ter/receptor, in that certain emotional energies generated
within the individual are released via one or more of the
chakras into the surrounding environment. And, reciprocally,
emotional and mental energiesalready present in the external
environment are detected, and are frequently internalizedby
the individual, also by way of one or more of the chakra
centers.(41, P. 48-50).

-L Violet
6 lndigo
5 B l u e ..
4 Green
3 5
2 Oronge. l9
J. Red ... r3
Supersensonic rules and wave-guides
H u m a nC h a k r a s y s t e m a c t s a s a record the proportional
wave-guide for cosmic rays
relationships in the
and refracts them into
wavefields of a sphere
levels of bio-electrici ty
o f p s y c h o - p h y si c a l
cal led Consciousness

203
Finally, Dr. Christopher Hills provides his interpretation of
the chakra-physiological/behavioral systems link-up which, it
will be noted, happens to be firmly supportive of that
previously given by Professor Tiller. According to Hills, the
etheric chakra system is connected by way of invisible (i.e.
to normal vision) forces to the body's endocrine and nervous
systems. And certain of the body's chemicals and nutrients
are governed by these interrelated functions of chakra-nerves-
glands. Consequently, special chemical secretions in the body
are regulated by what is occurring in the chakras. And hence,
one's personality is determined by chakra/neural regulation
of particular glandular secretions. Hills maintains that to
change a single component of the endocrine secretions is to
change one's personality, and that the triggering element
behind the controlled secretions of the endocrine glands is
the "psychic chakra electricity" (J).

\ /,

\\J
/

\\
\
/rr, /
K4

Christopher Hills conceives of our


consciousness in his theory of the Nuclear
Self as an absorber of all radiation and
lighl He likens it to a black hole in which all
outlines are eventually annihilated so that the
nucleus becomes one homogeneous yolk or
Dlasma

204
CHOWN CHAKRA
( P i n e a3l r d

,-L=,:.:".''''"'
BBOWCHAKBA ;
(Pitultary G. Vagur -;
f
Hypothalamus Evesl :
3rd VENTBICLE OF
BBAIN

THROAT CHAKRA
(Thyrold, Pharynx, -
Mouth, Nose. Eerr)

HEABT CHAKRA
(H a rt, Thymu3)

COELIAC PLEXUS,
Adrenalr, Pancreaa)

SPLEEN CHAKRA
(Spleen, Pancreag)

PELVIC CHAKRA
(GEnltal Organs) *
SACBAL CHAKHA
(Anue)

205
CHAKRA SOCIAL
MANIFESTATIONS
CHAKRA SOCIAL MANIFESTATIONS

207
THE CHAKRAS AND As a metaphysician and philosopher, the research of
TIME PERCEPTION Dr. Christopher Hills extends far beyond the physicali
biological domains of human existence. His investigations
deal with man's social, behavioral motivations of the temporal
world, as well as with causal factors which are not time-
bound. The chakras, Hills explains, are very definitely associ-
ated with man's behavior as a social being, with the funda-
mental drives peculiar to each person, and with man's percep-
tion of time. It is this latter chakra association, with its
behavioral implications, that concerns us in the present text.

As suggestedin the preceding discussion of Chakra Energies,


each chakra has its own rate of vibration, its own frequency
as distinct from the others. Moreover, according to Dr. Hills,
the human chakra system mediates man's experience of time,
each person having an innate tendency to experience time
predominately through one particular chakra more than the
others. This means, then, in Hills' view, that each individual,
without being aware of it, has within himself a time world
which is somehow conditioned by the rate of vibration of his
most prominently active chakra (J).

Thus, a conceptual framework is laid for understanding how


the flow and vibration of chakra energiesmight have immedi-
ate implications for human behavioral patterns, thereby
influencing one's perspective of, and reactions to, events
occurring within his social environment.

What follows is a brief general discussion and condensation


of Dr. Hills' concept of Chakra/Time Perception, Personality
interrelationships. Portions of Hills' theory, as presented
here, are available in his book, Nuclear Evolution,* while
further explanations were obtained from Hills himself by way
of lecture and private conversation. Also, a chart in this
section offers an additional comparative presentation of these
chakra factors.

* Dr.Christopher hisbook"Nuclear
Hillshassinceexpanded Evolution:
Discoveryof the RainbowBody" to includeall the pointscoveredin
privateconversation
with Dr. Beasley.

208
DR CHRISTOPHER HILLS

209
SACRAL CHAKRA This is the chakra which deals with physical sense percep-
tion, and its time world is now -- the immediate Now. One
functioning through this chakra is mainly concerned with
physical inputs, sensual stimuli of the present moment. This
personality tends to incorporate past and future events into a
response pattern dealing with the tangible present. Practicali-
ty, quickness of response and effectiveness in dealing with
the physical environment are characteristicsof those manifest-
ing the prevailing energies of the sacral chakra. Operating
through this center, an individual's actions usually do not
derive from any intellectual grounds or predetermined plan.
These persons experience time from moment to moment, a
First Chakra need for the stimulus of activity, to experience continuously
(Root or Sacral) new and novel situations. Consequently, gratification of an
impulse is not to be deferred until some later date, but to be
satiatedin the immediate now.

SPLEEN CHAKRA The time world of this chakra is the Now as it relates to the
Future, what is happening in the present as it conditions and
"sets the stage" for the future. This is the chakra of social
awareness, of deferring personal gratification in the present
for the ultimate good of the group or community in the
future. The personality dominated by this chakra is eminent-
ly concerned with social contact and expansive group activity:
the next party, the next election, the next social function. It
is at this chakra level that homo-sapiens as a cooperating
species becomes apparent -- the millions of years of social
evolution which have made it possible for man to maintain
complex social structures requiring the interdependence of
many component sectors. The personality of this chakra is
Second Chakra
(Navel or Spleen) generally ambitious, gregarious, outgoing, and savors large-
scale social involvement. He will react to immediate stimuli,
when presented in terms of the wider community, and where
these activities promise to widen his sphere of social involve-
ment. For this person, things past practically do not exist --
only the now as it might apply to the future.

210
SOLAR CHAKRA Here the time world is linear, a time line -- past leads to
present leads to future. All events occur logically, sequential-
ly, and any variance from this orderly process is sorely
tolerated.This is the time concept of the analyst,the intellec-
tual, the scientist, the planner. This personality divides events
into neat little categories, all systematically arranged accord-
ing to plan. If the present is considered,it is seen to extend
back into history and into the future -- both in strict linear
fashion, and all understandable in an organized step-by-step
manner. This person constantly seeks and compiles informa-
tion in quest of novel solutions. The mind is restless,
continually flitting about from one question to another, and
Third Chakra always starting at the beginning and ending at the end, all the
while maintaining an orderly process. Joy is produced by the
wide sweep of knowledge and fact, which lnks up so many
different events in the whole scope of past, present and
future. Conclusions are drawn on the strengthof hypotheses
and theoretical proofs. Scrutiny and close attention to detail
is typical of personalities characteized by this chakra.

HEART CHAKRA The focus of time in this center is moving back and forth,
shifting from present to past to future, depending on
emotional attachment or threats to self-security. At this
level the person's consciousnessattaches itself to things: to
food, to money, to material objects, to job security, to
individuals, to emotional security. The tendency is to possess
whatever the consciousnessbecomes attached to, to wonder
whether the love object is really secure,or if it is about to be
lost, ruining the personality's self-security. Thus, any threat
to the love object causes shifting of the time world: to the
past where the love object was Secue;tothe future where its
loss is certain to bring a decline in prestigeand self-image;to
the present where action must now be taken so as to restore
Fourth Chakra
past self-security and protect against future loss of it. If the
love object is indeed lost, then the future uncertainty
mmediately becomes the present, but the consciousness
reverts to the past trying to convert it into the present.
Receiving support, recognition from others, external objects

211
as a vehicle for one's self-assurance,are here characteristic.
And whatever is happening in the heart center will influence
the workings of the other centers.

THROAT CHAKRA The past is the time world of this center. The personality
functioning herein tends to associate present affairs with
some event of the past which remains firmly stored in his
memory. This is the conservative, tradition-oriented, hind-
sighted, historically-focused individual, for whom the real
importance of presently occurring events is how time will
bind them into history, into the past. This is the person who,
for confirmation of a particular set of facts and ideas, relies
primarily on accumulatedknowledge,the "lessonsof history,"
or the established authority. One functioning through this
chakra is usually good at conceptualizing, handling abstract
concepts, associating seemingly unrelated information and
Fifth Chakra experiences into a single concept. This center is the home of
the contemplative, the idealist, for whom confrontation and
uncertainty are disturbing and who prefers peace -- at any
price. Thus, the new, the novel, the strange, are met with
firm resistance for they do not fit into a time-bound frame-
work of the past which bears the stamp of authoritative
approval. Here, "feeling" is the predominant experiential
mode, as opposed to "sensation" at the sacrallevel, or "social
contact" of the spleen center, or "possessiveness"in the
heart chakra.

BROW CHAKRA Here we find the time world of the future, with intuition
the major mode of experience.The person dominated by this
center experiences now, yesterday, and is experiencing
tomorrow, today. His time world has no past or present, his
mind is always around the corner; consequently, such a
person is often impractical in dealing with tasks of the
immediate moment. It is through this center that one knows
without knowing how one knows, intuitive "psychic" impres-
sions are received, yielding information not available via
normal sensory channels. The frequent inability of this type

Sixth Chakra
212
Diagram
6hows chakras
r c eiving but
not radiating
oxcept on on6
level.

of personality to fix his concepts in a logical process, or


relate them to historical precedent, or apply them to a
current situation, engenders the criticism of personalities
dominated by other chakra centers who see the intuitive
as unreal and divorced from concreteness.However. there is
a reality which is practical and realistic within its own
framework of anticipation and foresight and which can
equal any of the other types in their own special perceptual
mode. The intuitive has difficulty in adjusting and returning
Bluechakraopen, Blue excreted. to the present where he has to wait for chronological time
to catch up to his perceptions.Thus, there is no awareness
of time as an instrument, but rather there tends to be little
consciousnessof time as structured by the clock, thereby
making this personality somewhat unpunctual and unable to
make a schedule that is in anv wav reliable.

CROWN CHAKRA This center governs the awarenessof timelessness-- an all-


pervading Now, which embraces all time worlds -- past,
present, and future into an enduring Divine universal order.
Here, imagination is the outstanding experiential mode --
"primordial imagination" -- knowing and relating by way of
images or patterns which could represent an entire celestial
galaxy, or a system of the human body, dependingupon the
perspective from which the universe is viewed. At this level,
the prevailing condition of consciousness is more like that
which relates to the dream state, or the hypnotic state,
wherein the mind is more open and responsive to suggestion
than during normal waking consciousness.This chakra is the
time dimension of the great mystics, the visionaries, those
masters of imagination who, through metaphors and power-
ful imagery, establish patterns of behavior which often carry
Seventh Chakra mortals into realms of supra-mental thought and Divine
order. The perceptual vantage point of the crown chakra is
one which enables the viewer to observe what is occurring
at all other levels -- it is the point through which one
obtains at-onenesswith the universe.

Lt3
Further to the above chakra/personality sketches, Dr. Hills
has noted that each man is really all of the chakras and time
worlds, but that usually one or two chakras tend to
predominate in the personality. Thus, it is seen that while
the energies flowing in the chakta system are conditioned
by each of the seven centers through which it moves, one's
personality according to Hills' analysis, is ultimately deter-
mined by which of these seven centers is most active.

Then, there is the additional observation of Dr. Christopher


Hills that difficulties in social communications -- between
individuals and between groups - frequently occur because
the parties involved in the interchange are speaking, as it
were, from different chakra centers, different time worlds.
If, for example, an intuitive-type personality, speaking from
the brow chakra with his future time orientation. treats an
issue with a sensation-type whose perspective from the
sacral center tells him that the real, concrete present is the
only basis for dialogue, obvious communication barriers
arise. Or, consider the situation, Hills offers, of a married
couple where each partner experiences time in a different
Dia.
shows rocsving and conflicting manner, each through his own dominant
and hardly chakra -- perpetual marital conflict might ensue; whereas,
radlatlng at all.
by contrast, if the two respective chakra frequencies are
similar, or different but complementary, marital harmony is
more easily facilitated (J).

According to Dr. Hills' interpretation, the whole matter of


chakra-determined time perspectives, as related to social,
inter-cultural communications, really reduces to a considera-
tion of the relative frequencies of the chakra involved in a
given social interchange. Two persons, for example, both
with a time-consciousness and personality determined by
the throat chakra, could still fail to understand each other
on a given issue, simply because they are speaking from
opposite ends of a wide frequency spectrum which exists
for the Throat Chakra -- and, ndeed for all other chakras.
Consequently, in any social interaction, it is the relationship

214
of the chakra frequencies that really matters - their relative
degree of "complementariness" or cancellation and not
their absolute identification as belonging. to the throat
center as opposed to the spleen center, and so on (J). Thus,
again we find the persistent theme of the resonant inter-
action of frequencies, applicable in this context to chakra
energies,personality, and social interrelationships.

Dr. Hills maintains that chakra/time world factors are also


important variables in matters involving the social conduct
of groups, organizations, and governments, for unconscious-
ly, there is the tendency for such bodies to take on the
chakra-time world qualities of its leadership -- and herein
lies much of the cause for large-scalegroup social conflict.
But while the conflict may eventually come to involve large
numbers of people, the animating "chakra perspective"
invariably begins with the individual (J). Further, Hills has
observed that the ineffective decision-making of many
organizations is often because the key decision-makers all
tend to function primarily through the same chakra, thus
obviating a more balanced solution which could otherwise
result with the presence of other complementary "chakra
types" (J).

215
GENERAL PRINCIPAL
CHAKRA TIME WORLD PERSONALITY TRAITS EXPERIENTIAL MODE

CROWN The External Now, Imagination (internal "Primordial imagination"


including all time worlds; vision); Awareness of an (akin to the dream state)
past, present,and future enduring order; Makes wherein the universe is
combined into a single all- effort to display charm perceived in images or
pervadingNow; Focus on goodness, and sympathetic patterns; Knowing or
a Divine, enduring universal emotions; Tries to influence experiencing via images
order. others with spiritual or or analogies; Contact
magical images; Love of with supra-mental intelli
withdrawal and self- gence; Identification
humiliation. with an enduring uni-
versal order.

BROW Exclusively future Intuitive sensitivity ; Intuition; Intuitive


oriented,havingno Desire to broaden knowledge, knowing
past or present. horizon of self l Lives without words or rational
in the futurel Not Psychic impressions;
punctual; Somewhat Identification with the
impractical in everyday emotional needs of man-
affairs; Lacks concrete- kind; Sense of union
ness and adherence to with humanity; "Falling
details; Visionary; in love" with an idea;
Anticipatory. Identification with the
idea of "fusion", or of a
more inclusive universal
order.

THROAT The past; Backward- Tradition oriented; Feeling; Established emo-


looking; Historically Contemplative; tions; Reality of nostal-
orented ; Hindsighted ; Authority-seeking; gic memories; Peace at
Experiences time as Introspective; any price; Resistive to
binding all events Conceptualizing; the new and untried;
into memories of Association of varied Dependence on authori-
emotional and experiencesinto a ties; Security of small
mental concepts. singleconcept; group with estabtshed
Passive;Tolerant; authority image; Love of
Contentment; established ways, princi
Idealistic. ples, ethics and morality.
HEART Shifting; Neither fixed Focused on self; Self- Accumulation of, and
nor linear, but moving security ; Self-measuring; attachment to physical
from past, to present, Self-confirmation ; Pride and emotional objects;
to future, depending on of possession;Possessive Confirmation of self via
emotional dictates, attachmentsto love
objects outside self; Rela-
tionships with others
which tend to confirm
and enhance opinion of
self.

SOLAR Linear time-line; Analytical; Logical; Thinking; Analysis;


Sequential progression Theoretical ; Intellectual ; Planning; Linking the
of time; Time as a contin- Categorizing; S cientific ; past with the present,
ual flow of process from Self-expansive; Desire for with the future; Consis-
past, to present,to future. change and novelty. tency of events;Logical
time-order;Adherenceto
process.

SPLEEN Now as it relatesto, Expansive; Outgoing; Social contact, Group


or conditions, the future; Ambitious; Community activity; Large-scale
Extension of the present conscious; Gregarious; social involvement; Love
into the future; Deferring Explorative; Strong of one's own class,com-
the immediate to some communal tendencies. munity or nation.
future date.

SACRAL ImmediateNow; Present Aggressive;Impulsive; Sensation;Physical


moment; Little awareness Quick-acting; Practical ; contact; Touch, Concrete
of the past,or of the Skill in manipulating reality; Immediateexter-
future. physical environment; nal stimut; Sensual
Power conscious;Active; events.
Reluctant to defer gratifi-
cation.
PSYCHOLOGICAL Much of the research and theory of Dr. Christopher Hills
PERSONALITY TYPES is based largely upon "metaphysical" investigations,
methods that, as yet, are neither fully understood nor
accepted by more conventional lines of scientific inquiry.
Nevertheless, in the physical and social sciences, the work
of many modern researchers seems to be destined to
ultimately bring about a general redefinition of what
"science" is, and what constitutes legitimate scientific
endeavor. In this vein, the work of Professor Humphrey
Osmond of Princeton University, New Jersey, is significant.
And considering, too, the ever-diminishing conceptual
barriers between "science" and "para-science,"it is not
especially astounding to find that the psychological person-
ality types identified by Osmond and his colleagues,
Drs. Harriet Mann, Richard Smoke and Miriam Siegler, bear
what seems to be an almost direct tie-in with some of the
chakra personality types as recognized by Hills.

Professor Osmond's work is built upon an earlier system of


personality typology devised by the famed psychologist,
Dr. Carl G. Jung. Osmond described Jung's classification
system as being "the product of a brilliant intuition, which
correlates personality variables in a way that other observers
can confirm" (H-l). Osmond reports that in studying
individuals who belonged to the different Jungian-type
categories, four basic temporal orientations were observed.
Osmond's innovation has been to recognize the importance
of the time dimension -- or individual views of time - in
relation to Jung's classification of personality types (H-1).

Fundamentally Jung's system postulates that there are


four functional personality types: Sensation, Thinking,
Feeling, and Intuitive (H-1). Below is a brief, basic discus-
sion of each of these types, according to Osmond's analysis
and as taken from the paper: The Many Worlds o Time*
by Osmond et al.

* For a fu||errendtion
of this paper,see,,Nuc|ear (44,
Evo|ution,'
whichis a condensation
P. 896-914). of theyet-to-be-published
book,
"WorldsApart" (tentative
title)by Osmond,et al.

218
SENSATION TYPE Sensation is the function which is concerned primarily
with that wfuch is current and immediate. No other type
has such a well-developed ability to perceive the present
moment in all its shadings and ramifications. Events which
take place now, which are tangible, concrete, visible, and
sensual are the events which take priority for one who is
present orientated. Events are met in terms of their existen-
tial reality, with little concern for how they got that way.
Life is a happening. Where it comes from and where it is
going is of minor importance, that it exists; and can be
perceived, is paramount. It is from this lack of concern with
the past or future, an almost total reliance on the present,
that the sensation type's primary personality traits derive.
Sensation types are superbly effective in dealing with
concrete reality. Nothing hampers them from facing the
object before them and dealing with it. They tend to
respond without hesitation to environmental stimuli. To
this type, that which is real is only that which can be
perceived by the physical senses.For the sensation type, the
present is all of life. Those having sensation as their first
function tend to be weak in intuition.

rPI
l#l*

*i I .rl

BRIGITTE BARDOT

219
THINKING TYPE Here, the directionality of time is a flowing from the past
through the present and into the future, No particular
dimension is of central importance, rather it is the flow
itself and the continuity of the process which is the crucial
issue. The concern is to see the process through to comple-
tion, and to extend the time line as far into the past as
possible, and as far into the future as they can project. An
issue cannot be discussed. nor can it be understood without

an
=
o
c0
q
a
{

BERTRAND RUSSELL

220
it being stated where the event originated, how it developed,
and when it concluded. Spontaneous or tangential events
are not dealt with unless they fit into the system of continu-
ity. This type is unwilling to recognize events which come
from nowhere or "out of the blue." Everything has a
history, came from somewhere, and exists only insofar as it
is heading in a specific direction.

Another characteristic of thinking types, is their tendency


to live according to principles, a tendency to try and grasp
the whole situation in ideal terms. Nor does this type trifle
with time. For them, time is serious, real, and demanding.
The attention to process, the love of planning, the respect
for principles -- these major characteristics of the thinking
type are directly attributable to their temporal orientation.
No other type can equal them in the ability to plot things
out through time, follow each logical step from beginning
to end. For this reason, either a pimary or secondary think-
ing function is extremely valuable in such tasks as adminis-
tration and organization -- in Western culture this is a skill
highly valued.

THINKING TYPE

JOHN F. KENNEDY

221
FEELING TYPE For the feeling type, time past becomes time present, and
so the present may be perceived as deriving from the past.
For them, time is circular: the past manifests itself in the
present and then is immediately returned to the past as a
memory. Reminiscences, diaries,folklore, heritage, traditions
- all these are major concens of feeling types' They tend
to see situations in terms of what is similar in the current
event to events of their personal past, rather than in terms
of what is unique about the existential situation;they tend
to be uncomfortable in new situations. From middle age
onwards, feeling types are conservatives. They need to
continue to see things in the ways which were popular,
fashionable, and appropriate in their younger days. The
evaluation of things in terms of what place they will take in
the past rather than in terms of what effect they have in the
present, or where they might lead in the future, is one of
the easily observable characteristics which differentiate
feeling types from others whose outward behavior may
seem to be similar. Because they value the recollection of
emotion, feeling types are extremely skillful at assessingthe
exact emotional tone of any current event. But in the
modern world where change is frequent and rapid, their
inability to keep up with the times can be damaging,
particularly in the latter half of life.

MARIA CALLAS

222
MAHATMA GANDHI

INTUTTIVE TYPE lntuition is the function which relates primarily to the


future dimension. The intuitive goes backward from his
vision of the future into the lesser reality of the present,
where he is constrained to wait until chronological time has
caught up with his vision. The actual time flow in their
experimental world is backwards. This is the function which
tries to ascertain that which is possible. The intuitive's
function is precognitive, perceiving by way of the uncon-
scious, relating to the world through hunches and guesses.
They sometimes appear to others to be flighty, impractical,
and unrealistic. This type generally lacks a developed
sensation function. [t has been observed that, in the psyche-
delic movement, there seem to be a large percentage of
people with a primary or secondary intuitive function.
Investigations with introverted intuitives have produced a
working hypothesis that timelessness, that sphere of
temporal experience which mystics and the Taoist Masters
concentrated on, is the normal experiential world of this
particular type. Western culture as a whole has tended more
to emphasize the functions of sensation and thinking, and
to under-value the skills of those who relate to the world
primarily through either feeling or intuition.

223
Elaborating upon his theory and classification model,
Professor Osmond explains that in typology, generally it can
be said that nothing is either totally positive or totally
negative, any typology is an abstraction from reality.
Further, Osmond points out that there is not, nor could
there be, a person who is positively one type. Every human
being, he notes, has the potential for all four functions, and
most people's inner experience and observable behavior
show evidence of all these possibilities (H-1). Invariably,
however, each person has a kind of hierarchical ordering in
the functions; some functions being rnore prominent than
others. So, while bringing all four experiential modes into
conscious control is the optimal situation,this type of intra-
psychic development is not common. The majority of
normal individuals tend to relate to the world essentiallv
through their first two functions (H-l ).

Nor can one function be taken as more real than another,


Professor Osmond informs, for typological studies indicate
that there are four realities: the thinking reality of process
and ideas; the feeling reality of memories and emotions;the
sensation reality of immediacy and concreteness; and the
intuitive reality of anticipation and visions. And within the
framework of this latter reality, intuitives are as practical
and realistic as the other types in their special perceptions
(H-l ). Osmond further cautions that communication
between some personality types can often be difficult, and
that a constructve team effort between types should be
sought whenever possible. The intuitive, Osmond affirms,
because of his general leck of regard for details, should
collaborate with a thinking type who can map out the
procedure and particulars of the intuitive's vision. Because
of the ability of thinking types to tie into each of the three
time dimensions, they are compatible with all the experien-
tial worlds. No other type can do this so effectively (H-l ).
Osmond goes on to say that, in typology there are many
possible collaborations between types, but that some are
more feasible than others. He notes that to achieve a dialoeue

224
between two people, one of whom sees reality as being in
the present and another who sees it as being in the future,
can be a fruitless, though often amusing encounter (H-1).

Only a cursory comparison of Dr. Hills' chakra analysis


against the psychological types of Professor Osmond, reveals
the following correlations :

Hills Osmond
Brow Chakra Intuitive Type
Throat Chakra Feeling Type
Solar Chakra Thinking Type
Sacral Chakra Sensation Type

ln conversation, both Hills and Osmond have confirmed


that there is a direct link between chakra energies and
psychological types. Throughout Nuclear Evolution:
Discovery of the Rainbow Body Hills elaborates on the
intricacies and mechanics of this link (44).

Whatever the ultimate possible tie-in between the two


systems, what must emerge as a most cogent challenge to
both the spirit and the intellect of man is, how at their
point of inception, do these "personality determinants"
become implanted within the human system of chakra
energies, before being passed onto the state of social
nianifestations? What are the determining and governing
sources of input into the chakra system? How is it that with
some four billion people presently inhabiting the earth, no
two persons have exactly the same chakra functions? And
why? What are the details of the chakra mechanisms involved
in group phenomena? What are the areas of frequency
resonance or "complementariness" which bind some pe$ons
together with a common identity in contrast to other groups?
Clearly, at the present juncture of our understanding, we are
at a stage where it is best to first try and ask the right
questions, before launching off to find answers.

225
ESOTERIC ENERGIES
OF
GROUP PHENOMENA
LZz,
NoIJnTo^a uVa.ImN do Tog'{s aHJ
vNrrnoNaHd dnouc do
SAI9UIINTI JIUSIOSA
A SCIENTIFIC VIEW It has been suggested by some thinkers that there is no
OF GROUP PHENOMENA manifest thing which is not a group, that each atom, each
atom grouping, has its own collective and specific rate of
vibration which distinguishes it from other similar groups.
There are, in fact, certain classes of physical phenomena
''cooperative phenomena''
which ae generally termed
wherein the individual entities cooperate with one another
with the result of enhancing a particular effect, as in the
case of ferromagnetism, where the elements of ferromagnetic
matter, iron or cobalt, combine their respective magnetic
moments to produce an overall enhanced effect (A).
Additionally, physics teaches that when two separatesources
of energy, each having its own distinct frequency pattern, are
brought into close proximity of each other, there is an inter-
action, a mutual sharing of their individual oscillations. This
common interchange is represented by a frequency pattern
which is not an exact replica of either, but rather, a combina-
tion of both. If several individual frequency sources are
involved in the interaction, then the resultant wave form is,
necessarily, a combined representation of all participating
frequencies. Once the combined frequencies are again
isolated from each other, their combined waveform is lost,
each entity returning to its own natural frequency (B).

Following upon this general theme, Professor H. S. Burr,


based upon his several decades of biological/behavioral
research with L-fields, speculated that it is not beyond the
bounds of possibility that mankind -- whatever the cause --
is subject to collective "highs" and "lows," times when the
vitality and alertness of entire populations could fluctuate
between maximum and minimum values (39, P. 120). Burr
goes on to suggestthat if it could be determined that such
conditions do, in fact, exist, then world leaderswould be able
to know in advance those periods when they should exercise
special caution, particularly in international relationships.

228
GROUP MIND The reality and the potency of human thought* energy has
been emphasized on preceding pages. We come now to
consider some aspects of collective mental energies, or
"group mind ", as recognized by several clairvoyant
researchers.

Bishop Leadbeater once observed that the power of the


united thought of a number of people is always far greater
than the sum of their separatethoughts, and that it would be
much more nearly represented by the product of the
constituent thought energies (32, P. 48). This view is
mirrored and expanded upon by the late Dionne Fortune, the
widely know British clairvoyant. She reports that the
composite or group mind, once formed,** will contain only
those ideas and feelings which are directed towards the
common object of attention; these ideas will diffuse them-
selves into the subconscious minds of all the people compris-
ing the group and thence influence their conscious minds.

Fortune asserts that at the subconscious level, the inter-


action (the combining of human mental energies with those
natural energiest associated with the object of attention)
between the group and their object of attention is such that
there is an amalgam of energies which flow together produc-
ing a single cloud which overshadows the whole group (33,
P. s9-60).

*
One investigator,E. L. Gardner, reportsthat, to clairvoyantvision,
thought vibrationsseem to have the characteristicsof electric pulses
t h r o u g ha w i r e - - -w a v e l i k ea n d u n d u l a t o r y( 3 1 ,P . 3 1 ) .
**
Generally speaking,esoteristsconsider that a "group mind" is
formed by the collective mental energiesgeneratedby a group of
individualsin mutual associationwith each other, i.e. personshavinga
common mental focus or experience.Such an associationmay be deli'
berateor fortuitous.
t Such naturalenergies,or natureforces,are frequentlyreferredto by
the term, "Deva."

229
Continuing her explanation, Fortune maintains that when a
$oup mind becomes well established, it has a distinct exist-
ence of its own, that it is a separate entity drawing its life
from the group. This latter function appeam to be but one
half of a reciprocal system between the group mind and the
group itself, for according to Fortune, the group mind is also
a reservoir of energy upon which each member of the group
can draw. The group mind, she concludes, can only be
destroyed by dispersing the group (33, P. 60-63).

Another account of the energies involved in group-mind


phenomena is given by Mrs. Phoebe Bendit, who for many
years worked with her clairvoyant abilities in partnership
with her husband, a psychiatrist. The entirety of the follow-
ing report in this section of Group Mind, is hers.

"From a more technical, psychological angle, the human manifests a


mixture between the forces of the collective subconscious and the
collective super-conscous. The former is the garnered collective experi-
ence of animals and lower biological kingdoms, i.e. instinct. The latter
represents those aspects of consciousness which are also collective in
the sense that they are universal - as pointed out by Jung in his
discussion of myth and religious symbols -- but which have not yet
passed through the field of explicit experience (37, P. 105).

To clairvoyant vision, a group.energy field appears as a moving, pulsat-


ing globe of etheric matter which envelops all those present. Through it
the impulses of thought and feeling ripple. While at times the whole
structure is comparatively quiescent, it may also appear turbulent, as if
tossed by a storm. Individuals who remain objective and outside the
collective impulse may be geographically in the group energy field, but
do not become a part of it. Such people are like rocks in a stream of
water - and may, indeed, sometimes cause eddies and cross-currents in
the group atmosphere, in the actual energy pattern whch reflects group
thought and feeling (37,P.123).

230
Seen clairvoyantly, from the point of view of the etheric field, the
difference between individual persons and a group depends upon
whether or not a common energy field exists. A crowd of people walk-
ing down a street conssts of separate individuals, each within his own
energy field. But beyond the level of etheric matter, prope' there is the
dimension of mental matter wherein the individual mind is only partly
personal and separate, where there exists a collective mental level into
which the individual is merged into a general field of thought and feetng.

Two factors faciltate this fusion of the personal mind with the larger
mental field: (l) close physical proximity, especially in a room or build-
ing and, (2) a common mental focus. Thus, it is difficult for people
living in a crowded house, even among strangers, to remain immune and
aloof from the mental atmosphere of the place as a whole. Even in open
country, if the attention of a number of people becomes drawn to some
object or event, there is a tendency for a group energy field to form, so
long as the situaton holds the attention of the group'

There are any number of situations, accidental or contrived, where


people are drawn together with a common focus: a theatrical perform-
ance' an auto accident, a flood, a riot, a relgious service, a political
rally, or a piece of national pageantry. In each instance the nature and
quality of the group energy field will depend not only on the common
temperamental traits of those involved, but also on the object which
draws them together - but in any event, a holistc phenomenon takes
place. And the energy of the group, in whatever direction it runs, is
greater than the sum of the individual energies of those who comprise
the group (37,P. l2-l2l).

An immense thing like the Commonwealth at the time of the Corona-


tion cannot, clearly, have a single world-wide energy field. Each nation
or group will naturally tend to create its own - but on such occasions
there will be a close magnetic tie or link between each part. The
response will possess a basic and universal quality, while each spatially
separated unit will supply a different overtone due to indigenous local
variations (37, P. 123).

23r
'plus' quality in the group energy field which corresponds
There is a
to the quality of the thought and feeling of the group. Where there is a
leader, he is an important pivot in the group energy field. He may be a
lecturer, an actor, a priest, the charman of a company' a governol' or
the ruler of a country. In any case, he is a focal point capable, to a
certain extent, of holding or breaking up a group energy field, and also
of giving it an identifying tenor' This latter function of the leader s
especially pronounced if the leader is put up as an embodiment of
some collective mental movement in a nation, or if he fills an archetypal
role, such as a king or high-priest (37 , P , 121).

When a group energy field forms around constructve discussion, the


'plus' element
can be so strong, that not only are personal differences
resolved, but a higher octave of understanding and insight into a
difficult subject can be reached. On the other hand, fatigue inevitably
comes to a dscussonafter a period of time, and the whole structure of
the group energy pattern falls slack and flags" (37,P. 124).

MRS. ALICE BAILEY

232
ESOTERIC RADIATIONS Shifting our discussion of esoteric energies and human
OF NATIONS group behavior to yet another level of reality, as claimed by
supra-normal faculties of perception, we consider now some
of the findings of Mrs. Alice A. Bailey, an accomplished practi.
tioner of mental telepathy and author of numerous works
on esoteric phenomena(34).

Mrs. Bailey's fundamental contention is that there exist


distinct and particular radiating energies or forces of a cyclic
natue, and of cosmic/divine origin, which are responsible for
the trend of world affairs. The broad perspective of this
system holds that in the last analysis, all history is the record
of the effects of these energy radiations as they play upon
humanity in its numerous and varied stagesof evolution. Her
view holds that all that has happened is the result of these
energies operating through that part of nature which we call
the human kingdom (P. 3). According to this schema,one of
the kinds of influence to be expected with the influx of these
varying cosmic/divine radiations is that the nature of civiliza-
tion and the culture of humanity in any given period is deter-
mined by their presence (P. 116). Bailey contends that the
fundamental law, as expressed by conventional science that
"energy follows thought," also holds in the realm of cosmic/
divine energies as they are received, inculcated and re-
expressed by man (P. 35). The further assertion is that
nations, like individual human beings, react under the
influence of the respective radiations, and that once the
rhythm and momentum of a radiation is established in a
particular group, it can last for a long time just through the
power which it gains through the force of organized numbers
(P.2e).
Mrs. Bailey has identified the energies in question as being
seven in number, and noted they they are called by many
names in different countries. However, the names which she
applies are as follows:

233
The energy of: l. will or purpose
2.love-wisdom
3. active intelligence
4. harmony through conflict
5. concrete knowledge or science
6. devotion or idealism
7. ceremonial order

(P.3-4). The above energies,it is said, can function simultane-


ously in combination with, or in opposition to, each other.
Each radiation is believed to embody an idea which can be
sensed as an ideal (P. 57). While all these energies are cyclical
in their periods of manifestation, some combination of them
is reportedly always present, ceaselesslyplaying upon humani-
ty, and over time, fashioning and modifying nations and
their patterns of relationships, thus bearing witness to the
processesof social evolution (P.4 & 57). And curiously, the
cosmic/divine energieswfuch, it is maintained, affect humani-
ty at the national level, are also suggested to have a direct
correspondence to specific chakra centers along the human
spine (P. 33). The chart on the following page displays the
correlations between the cosmic/divine energies as outlined
by Alice Bailey, and the energies of the chakra centers as
investigated by Christopher Hills.

As stated above, Mrs. Bailey postulated that the essence of


each radiation is the idea which it embodies; from this
premise it is maintained that the present major ideologies
around which nations and societies are formed, are largely
distortions of the cosmic/divine energies as they are sensed
and interpreted by various populations, particularly the
leaders of these groups (P. 16 & 22). The direction of the
currents of men's thoughts, the moulding of their ideas, the
altering of the policies of nations are all attributed to the
cyclic energy radiations of cosmic/divine origin (P. 28).

234
SUGGESTED CORRELATIONS BETWEEN
COSMIC/DTVINE AND CHAKRA ENERGIES

BAILEY'S SCHEMA HILLS'SCHEMA

ASSOCIATED
NO. ENERGY CHAKRA COLOR ASSOCIATEDMODALITY

1 Will or purpose Crown Violet lmaginationand senseof Divineorder

2. Love-wisdom Brow lndigo lntuition and abstractreality

3. Active intelligence Heart Green Vital forces and self security

4. Harmonythroughconflict Solar Yellow Problem solving, novel changes,creativeconflict

5. Concrete knowledge Sacral Red Concrete reality, measurementby senses

6. Devotionor idealism Throat Blue Devotionto authorities,idealism

7. Ceremonialorder Spleen Orange Social patterns,community involvement,consti-


tutionalorder
It is further pointed out that no single radiation with its
accompanying ideology is generally suitable to all nations or
groups, but that these radiation-imposed ideologies may be
temporarily adapted to the populations who receive them
and who mold their national life accordingly (P. 9). Thus, it
is considered that the conflict and antagonism existing
between some ideologies and, consequently, between some
nations, is frequently understandable in terms of different
and opposing cosmic/divine radiations being sensed by
respective groups or nations (p. a5). Hence, according to
Bailey, it is with the turbulent manifestations of various
conflicting radiations upon the social, physical plane of
existencethat the United Nations has to deal (P. 3).

But all is not conflict within Mrs. Bailey's framework, for in


some instances two or rnore nations, because of certain
similar natural vibratory conditions inherent in their
geographicallocations and because of their similar frequencies
of cosmic/divine energy radiations, have a close affinity
between themselves(P. 45-50). This phenomenonof vibratory
affinity between some countries is said not to be an arbitrary
matter, but due to a definite "magnetic" interplay between
them, which follows the law of attraction and repulsion
(P.72, 90). Additionally, it is held that certain definite
geographical locations upon the earth are a kind ofgathering
point or relay station between the incoming cosmic/divine
energies and their diffusion throughout the world, while still
other locations are points of fusion or blending of energies
(P. 12,92 and IO4).

Mrs. Bailey concludes that the instinctual life of nations is a


factor which is amenable to scientific study, and that the
processes of evolution will be much better understood when
investigators gain a fuller comprehension of esoteric enegy
radiations (P. I l6). She surmisesthat when the nature of the
world struggle is considered from the perspective of subjective
causation -- cosmic/divine energy radiations -- instead of
superficial objective reasons, then real progress can be made
in releasing humanity from the thraldom and the naIowness
of the present civilization (P. 35).
THE GROUP CONSCIOUS- n |963 when Life magazine of Japan did a feature story on
NESS EXPERIMENT Professor Hiroshi Nakamura*, one of the world's foremost
experts on algae as a food for man, Nakamura stated that he
was a colleague of Christopher Hills and a student of Nuclear
Evolution. Toru Matsui**, one of Japan's leading philos-
ophers, who lived a semi-reclusive existence on Mt. Hakone
near Mt. Fuji, contacted Dr. Nakamura to inquire "Who is
Hills, and what is Nuclear Evolution? " As a result, the
Japanese wise man began to study Nuclear Evolution and
eventually set up a group to work on group consciousnessas
outlined in Hills' book Universal Government by Nature's
Laws (49). Matsui stated that the Japanese Tendai Sect, a
branch of esoteric Buddhism, expounds a similar idea but, to
his knowledge, no group in history had ever succeeded in
achieving group consciousness.

TORU MATSUI DR. HIROSHI NAKAMURA

* Dr.
H i r o s h i N a k a m u r a h a s a u t h o r e d i n J a p a n e s e" M e d i t a t i o n i n
R e t r e a t , "" F o o d s o f t h e F u t u r e "a n d " T h e U s e f u l n e sosf H u m a n L i f e . "
**
Toru Matsui has authored in Japanese,"Entropee -- Physiology,"
"Physiology of Poverty." "Physiology of Nakedness,"and "The Way
Towardsa SpiritualAwakening."

zJt
f To that date Hills had formed many groups world wide over the
previous eight years in an effort to achieve group consciousness.During
these years he consolidated,refined, tested, and modified his approach
until the working plan for "Universal Government by Nature's Laws"
(49) was developed.This plan contains a flexible constitution that is
changeable in an orderly manner by its members, thus enabling it to
expand and grow with the developmentof the group mind.

In 1966 Hills founded the Centre House Community in London on


these principles and spent the next six years there further refining his
technique to achievegroup consciousnessbefore he came to the United
States. Centre House is still in operation today under the direction of
Malcolm Strutt*, a master of Hatha Yoga, and author of "Holistic
Health and Living Yoga".

1(,!
" i;:

-',"j;'4

CENTRE HOUSE
LONDON

t Extract from the chapteron the History of Group Consciousnessin


"The Rise of the Phoenix" publishedby Universityof the TreesPress.
*
Malcolm Strutt's yoga coursesare standardsfor the British Wheelof
Yoga and the London EducationAuthority.

238
The fall of |973 saw christopher Hills and hs wife Norah moving to
the small village of Boulder Creek, California, just south of San Francisco.
Hills stayed elatively secluded but was still sought out by people who
knew of his abilities as a scientist and clairvoyant. Now instead of
accepting people, his mind was finely tuned as to what it took to get
group consciousness.

He scared off more people than he attractedby confronting theregos


almost immediately. It seemedlike he was in a hurry to weed out those
that labked a quality that he knew it took for an individual to become
part of a successfulgroup-consciousteam. With this sort of welcome,
out of a hundred people who passed through, only one stayed. Hills'
task was, in his own words, "How do you get a diverse collection of
strong individuals to behave as one whole organism without losing their
individuality?"

BOULDER CREEK CALIFORNIA

239
By Christmas 1975 Hills had attracted to himself thirteen extremely
diverse people who had totally committed themselvesto achieving
group consciousness.They ranged from high school graduates to
Ph.D''s, from educators to carpenters,and included a phlosopher,a
physicist, a psychologist, a social worker, an electronics engineer,an
artist, and a computer salesman.Each of these people had some things
in common. They were searchingfor a better way and had a willingness
to learn.They were successfulin their own fields and were not afraid of
hard work.

Hills' method of working toward group consciousnessis multi-


dimensional,from the esotericrealmsof meditation to the practcalities
of selflessaction. The main emphasisis a skill called Creative Conflict @ *
by which ego patterns are exposed,challengedand eventuallymastered,
An individual's ego divides him from another and from the group by
creatnga separationbetween his own and others' levels of conscious-
ness.

The majority of the world's people are not aware of the workings of
the seven different levels of consciousnessand the fact that their
combinations expressed in personalities give rise to many different
realities and time worlds. The ego tends to hold fast to its reality and to
write off, judge, suspect anyone who is different.Thus communication
between individuals,groups, and nations break down, with resultsthat
are only too well known to us all.

With a working knowledge of Nuclear Evolution and skill in Creative


Conflict, the ego can be penetrated constructively, resultngn the
dissolution of separatenessand the creation of selflessness.These
qualities which are essential to group consciousnesscan be better
understoodby experiencingthe group vibration."'*'r'

*@Creative
Conflict, copyright of the Universityof the Trees Press,
see "The Rise of the Phoenix".
*" Further readingon the ways that the Universityof the Treesgroup
is working toward group consciousnesscan be found in the books:
"Hills' Theory of Consciousness"(43) and "Journey Into Light" (50),
writtenthroughthe eyesof two membersof the group.

240
"F
:'r*-';"r,;

UNTVERSITY OF THE TREES


CONSCIOUSNESS RESEARCH GROUP
SUMMARY
AND
DISCUSSION OF PART II
SUMMARY DISCUSSION OF PART II

e
cosMIc/DIvINE RDIATloNs

PLANE'TARY & EXTRATERRESTRIAL

% soLAR RDIATIoNS

N .-.. - / / /I %

s
I I

EIIIERIC
& CHAKRA
ENERGIES
=hltlrr \\t:
t \ \ \ \ \=\ MENTAL
& SOCIAL
ELECTRO.
UEBAIIONS

=\\\\\\\ ttltll=

%
% ffi
ELECTRO-VIBRATIONS OF
ELECTRO,VIBRATIONS
PHYSICAL ETWIRONMENTAL
OF HUMAN BIOLOGY
STIMULI

GEOPHYSICAL FORCE.FIELDS
& AIR IONS

The writer's symbolic conception which attempts a visual, hueristic intergation of the "electro-vibrations" presently discussed.
Here, man is seen enmeshedin, and a part of, a continuous and complex network of nature'sradiatiom - he is both transmitter
and receiverand the soucesof radiation, though distinct are all interrelated.

243
Part II presents an eclectic survey ofvarious kinds of "extra-
physical," phenomena, as possibly related to human behavior
from both scientific and meta-physical areas of inquiry. In
some instances, it has been possible to suggesttie-ins between
different systems as indicated below. In other cases,however,
direct correlations and tie-ins between systems is a more
elusive matter. But in each situation, it should be evident that
the phenomenon under consideration is fundamentally
"electro-vibratory" in nature, and in some way bears upon
human behavior patterns, as understood by the respective
researchers.

Suggested"Electro-Vibratory" Tie-ins
L-field forces. . . . .Extraterrestrial force-fields
Radionic Energies . . . . . .Auric systems
Radiesthesic Enersies . . .Universal field
Chakra Energies. . .Endocrine & Neural systems
Chakra Energies. . .Personalitypattems
C h a k r a E n e r g i e s . . . . . . .Environmental force-fields
Chakra Energies. . .Cosmic/Divine radiations

Focussing first on scientiic research, Professor H' S. Burr,


over a period of 40 years, conducted investigations which
resulted in his postulating the existence of "L-fields," or
fields of life, which according to Burr, are associated with all
life forms. Experimental rsults from both Burr and Ravitz
indicated that an individual's L-field voltages reflect mental
and emotional conditions. [n some tested cases,the pattern
of variation in L-field voltages predicted, in advance, when an
individual would not be feeling his best. Does this, then,
mean that there is some dimension of man's being having a
kind of "electro-vibratory precognition," that "knows,"
ahead of time, what will be one's emotional state during a
given period?

244
Burr maintains that L-field forces play an integral role in
human behavior, with measured variations in L-field voltages
indicating one's responseto both physiological and ideological
stimuli occuring in one's environment. Experimental findings
revealed that ideas and emotions impinge upon the nervous
system with the same reality as a pin prick or slap on the
face. This supports the contention that there are associated
with ideas, force-fields that are, indeed, real, and that these
fields ae capable of releasing within the human neural
system, the same kind of bioelectric currents as do physical
stimuli, as measured by the galvanometer.

Burr postulates further that L-fields are links in a "chain of


authority," part of a universal pattern, that there are other
more pervasive cosmic fields from which L-fields, in effect,
receive instructions. He implies, moreover, that entire popula-
tions could conceivably undergo occasional fluctuations in
vitality and altertness, owing to variations in some aspect of
external, extraterrestrial field conditions. If Burr's assessment
is accurate, this suggeststhat mental and emotional states are,
to some extent, continually, or occasionally governed by
certain types of cosmological force-fields acting through or
upon the human L-field.

Following Burr's lead, one wonders how much better could


we understand the complexities of human social relationships
if we better understood the effects of extraterrestrial force-
fields upon the human L-field. What are the generalized and
the specific behavior{aden aspects of force-field interaction
between man and the cosmos? What is the relationship
between Burr's L-fields and the human auric bodies which
Mark Gallert claims to detect on his "Radionic AnaTyzer?" ---
are they perhaps even the same force-fields, but investigated
by different instrumentation and discussed using different
jargon? And would L-field, radionic and radiesthesic investi-
gations of Osmond's personality types and Hills' chakra types
reveal a further corroboratine tie-in between all these svstems?

245
To what extent can the various corrective energiesemployed
in Supersensonics, radiesthesia and radionics be applied to
social/behavioral situations? We recall the Supersensonics
Magnetron of Part I that worked with radiesthesic energies
and light to change group behavior. Clearly, in order to
answer these questions, there must be further investigations,
indeed co-investigations, team efforts, engaging the mutual
participation of researchersrepresenting different conceptual
approaches.
Clairvoyant investigation of certain human "auric" energies,
particularly chakra energies, indicate additional tie-ins
between behavior and "electro-vibratory" forces occuring at
other, more subtle dimensions of man's make-up.
Clairvoyant vision affirms the presence of chakras, or wheel-
like vortices of energy existing at auric levels of the human
entity. The chakra centers are reported to receive and distri-
bute throughout the system various in-coming "electro-
vibratory" energies of solar and extraterrestrial origin.
Additionally, chakra centers are thought to detect the
presenceof other kinds of force-fieldsor "electro-vibratory"
tensions in the surroundings. The work of Christopher Hills,
involving the chakra centers and the human perspective of
time, particularly when viewed together with the findings of
Humphrey Osmond, suggeststhat personality differences are
really "electro-vibratory". differences, as expressed and
detected through the chakra system. Another investigator,
C. W. Leadbeater, maintains that the chakras apparently serve
as a kind of transmitter/receptor for various mental and
emotional energies present in the environment. This would
seem to suggestthat different types of ESP are made possible
by means of the chakra system. Mark Gallert, in measuring
radionically the flow of energy through chakra centers, finds
that serious emotional problems ate accompanied by a
sizeable reduction in the energies flowing through one or
more centers. In Aura Balancing, Robert Massy shows that
the chakra energies can be positive, negative,or a combination
of the two and that the intensity can be directly correlated to
specific problems in the areasof physical, social, intellectual,
emotional, mental, intuition and imagination.

246
There is a convergence of opnion among leading investiga-
tors that there is a tie-in of the chakra system with the neural
and endocrine systems, and that it is this link-up which
makes it possible for the movement of chakra energies to
exert a degree of determination and control over human
personality and behavior. In fact, both Hills and Bendit agree
that the human chakra system mediates the totality of man's
social/behavioral manifestations.

Our understanding of chakra energies and their relation to


human behavior still rests mainly upon clairvoyant investiga-
tions, which those of "scientific" bent are usually not wont
to accept. Nevertheless, there is an increasing number of
instances where scientific investigation and clairvoyant
perception reinforce each other. Several such situations are
mentoned by Dr. Shafica Karagulla in her book Breakthrough
to Creativity, 196'7, where she relates that there are several
practicing physicians in the western world who regularly
diagnose their patients by means of clairvoyant observation.
This apparently is done casually and informally without the
patient's awareness, and all the while the physician may be
engaged in accepted medical procedures, employing stetho-
scope, X-ray, laboratory analysis, etc. According to Karagulla
who is herself a psychiatrist, some clairvoyant physicians try
to camouflage their extraordinary abilities by always appear-
ing to diagnose by standard scientific practices -- this so as
not to jeopardize their professional status within the medical
community.

If one accepts as accurate clairvoyant reports on the flows


and functions of chakra energies, then a broad and penetrat-
ing range of explanatory possibilities unfolds. For instance,
one could, perhaps, more readily conceive of the finer matter
of man's auric bodies as being more malleable to the force-
fields created by thought energy than is the physical body.
And since it is understood that the auric bodies interpene-
trate the physical body, being in fact inseparable under
"normal" conditions, perhaps it becomes easier to appreciate

247
how a disturbed mental/emotional state, which is "electro-
vibratory," acts upon an auric body, which is "electro-
vibratory" which, in turn, acts upon an electro-vibratory
nervous system, thereby producing physical illness or
behavioral abberations. It s as though there were a series of
"electro-vibratory" links or couplings existing between the
origin of a disturbance at a mental level and its manifestation
as illness or abberation of the physical and social planes, a
kind of harmonic association of frequencieswhere disharmony
(or harnomy) occuring at one level of man's being is succesive-
ly repeated at other levels as well. Could this, then, be the
anatomy of psychosomaticillnesses?

Throughout the range of "electro-vibratory" phenomena,


there is found a dimension of group response which bears
most heavily upon what happens to individual entities exist-
ing as part of a collective. In physics, the magnetic moment
of atoms comprising certain types of substancesbehave in a
distinct collective manne' thereby producing an enhanced
effect which would not be possible without combined effort;
an example of this pattern is found in ferro-magnetic
materials, iron, nickle, etc. Or, stated differently, the resonant
interaction of two or more individual oscillations having
similar frequencies, results in an amplified, combined wave-
form of greater strength than would have been possible with
a single frequency.

Similarly, the importance of group "electro-vibratory"


phenomena is advanced by clairvoyant investigators dealing
with more esoteric levels of human behavior. Clairvoyant
research indicates that when a group of persons come
together, either by design or by accident and share in a
common thought or idea, there is generated a collective
''electro-vibatory,''
semi-autonomousenegyfield, frequently
called the "group mind". The group mind is said to have its
existence in the realm of mental - non-physical -- matter,
and represents an amalgam of the mental energies of those
individuals who have their attention engaged in a common
experience, e.g., an accident on the street viewed by a
number of causal onlookers, or a planried parliamentary

248
discussion on a piece of legislation with the purposeful
participation of government officials -- both situations would
be expected to produce a "group mind", a collective "electro-
vibratory" representation of constituent mental energies.

Once in London, during discussions with Dr. Corona Trew,


an outstanding physical chemist and theosophical scholar, the
writer opened the question of "group vibrations. " The
substance of the query was, how best could one understand
or come to grips with the esoterist's claim for the presence
of an "electro-vibratory force-field purported to exist in non-
physical dimensions, and supposedly reflecting certain
attributes of the group as a whole? Replying as a scientist,
but one with a profound understanding of metaphysical
matters, Dr. Trew suggestedthat the scienceof spectroscopy
-- wherein through the use of certain light frequencies,
individual molecular groupings can be identified as distinct
from other molecular groupings within the same piece of
physical substance -- might be the kind of direction in which
scientific inquiry could proceed on the question of "group
mind" phenomena.

Extending Dr. Trew's speculation, one conceives of a


scientific instrument capable of measuring the subtle vibra-
tions of human mental energies,a device similar in concept to
the spectrographic apparatus, which could register and
identify the "group mind" vibrations of group A, as distinct
from those of group B. If this were possible, it could mean
the objective scientific exploration of the phenomenon of
"group consciousness," or "collective unconsciousness,"as
postulatedin the works of Jung and others.

Viewing group phenomena from a slightly different perspec-


tive, Alice Bailey asserts that the social evolution of human
society is really the manifestation of the cyclical appearance
of seven principal cosmic/divine radiations, waxing, waning,
interplaying, and over the long course of history, imposing
their periodic influence upon earth's populations. Clearly, the
contention that the trend of world affairs is condtioned by
certain definite "electro-vibratory" phenomena of cosmic/
divine origin, carries with it formidable implications. the kind

249
The human vehicle re-radiatesthe
absorbed energies through the
cell which
biological radiomagnetic
acts as a semiconductor for the
transport of electrons into the
human wave-field.

which have for centuries engaged the thought of the worldrs


greatest philosophers, and boggled lesser minds. What is the
Ieality of planetary and extraterrestral influences upon
ABSORPTION OF LIGHT
human affairs? Is there some ultimate Divine source from
*---
Red which all "electro-vibrations" emerge, wherein the planets
oange merely act as energy modifiers or relay stations? Does this
Yellow
mean, then, that all vibrations (man included) are divine, but
merely varying in degree of divineness? Are such matters even
answerable through scientific inquiry? Are such questions
answerable at all't.

Christopher Hills thinks they are. He sees all forms in the


universe as an expression of the unversalfield of intelligence
vibrating at different frequencies in which the human chakras
function as step-down transformers that can be varied with
the frequency of the consciousness we pass through them.
The root chakra crystalizing this energy into the physical
vehicle, the spleen chakra giving rise to man's herding instinct,
the naval chakra manifesting the intellectual drive, the heart
chakra providing our need for security, the throat chakra
transforming this energy into the mind, the brow chakra
RADIANCE. OF LIGHT vibrating at the intuitive frequency and the crown chakra
creating the imagination.

The classical philosophical arguments for the existence of


God or universal purpose.seem almost obsolete when the
universe is viewed in terms of vibration and its various
plateaus of "reality". With this theory of Nuclear Evolution,
,lt
Christopher Hills provides the link between the meta-physical
,. "electro-vibratory" force-fields and human social behavior.
l,

li
tr
The research group at the University of the Trees has, in
the past four years, gone a long way in proving Hills' theory
of consciousness on themselves. The question remains as to
what will be the significance of "group consciousness" as a
new vibration in the world. Will the experience be spatially
restricted governed by the group's location? Or will its effect
be felt world-wide, even by people who cannot directly
perceive that the experiment has finally succeeded?

250
APPENDIx:
A PERSONAL PILGRIMAGE OF SEARCH AND

RESEARCH UNDERTAKEN TO WRITE

THIS VOLUME

This section is included as something of a personal note to


this volume which has relied heavily upon the works of
others. The intent here is merely to offer the reader a bit
more insight into my personal quest and conceptual ground-
ing which have contributed to the realization of this work.

Also, this entry has the added advantage of allowing me to


give fuller acknowledgement to the many individuals, experi-
ences, and written works which helped make this project
possible.

WORKSHOPS & TRAINING From mid 1972 to early 1974, numerous informal and
EXPERIENCES: instructive discussion sessions were held with Drs. Lloyd
Kunar and Fred Campayne, Geophysicist and Nuclear
Physicist respectively of the Physics Department, University
of Guyana (4, B).

Most of these talks were held on the University campus


and involved inquiry into matters of electromagnetics, electro-
dynamics, geophysics, nuclear and particle physics, as related
to my area of inquiry. On two occasions, such talks were held
on the St. Augustine campus of the University of the West
Indies, Trinidad, and in one instance evolved into a lengthy
discussion of several hours. and included various members of
the physics staff.

251
These informal talks provided vital background theory and
data on electro-vibratory phenomena, as understood by the
physical sciences, and served to reinforce, with scientific
understanding, some of the more esoteric concepts contained
in the present volume. Moteover, these conversations were
especially instructive for me as they renewed and expanded
my knowledge of electromagnetics and geophysics, while
introducing me to new concepts in nuclear and particle
physics.

Also during 1972-3, three or four informal discussions were


held with Dr. Neville Trotz, Organic Chemist of the University
of Guyana. These talks centered on the biochemical composi-
tion of the human body and its electrolytic functions, and
were important in helping to focus on the electro-vibratory
aspectsof human body chemistry.

On September 29th and 30th, 1973,I attended a weekend


seminar on "vibrations" held at Centre House, London,
England. This included a lecture on chakra energies by
Christopher Hills, as well as lectures and demonstrations on
various types of vibratory phenomena, including sound,
color, and Kirlian-type photography of "bio-plasmic"
energies. During the same seminar, I also participated in a
lecture-workshop on "toning," which dealt with the influence
of sound vibrations upon' human temperament. This is
closely related to the mantra yoga of eastern tradition. As a
group, we experimented with various voice-emitted sounds,
together with sounds produced by eastem string instruments.

The workshop was led by Mr. Nigel Hamilton, a Centre


House resident, working as a research physicist in solar
enegy at the Trinity House Laboratory, London, and by
Mr. Makunda, a native of India, who is a physicist and a
professional musician. The major importance of this session
was to learn of the definite but subtle relationships which
obtain between sound and the human psyche.

2s2
In August 1972, over a period of four days, I transcribed
several tape recordings from the Centre House Library,
London, England. Subjects dealt with various metaphysical
topics, particularly "group phenomena." The tapes contained
lectures given at Centre House by Christopher Hi1ls and guest
speakers over the last few years. The content of these record-
ings was used primarily as background information.

Viewing and listening to electromagnetic vibrations occurred


in the laboratories of Dr. A. Roy Davis, Green Cove Springs,
Florida, November 1972, and is recounted in this volume
under the section on Polarities - North and South. However.
the substance of this experience is that the two poles of a
single magnetic field have a different tonal pitch (when the
proper sensing instrumentation is used), as well as a different
visual pattern and direction of movement, when seen on
Davis' special viewing device.

During September-October, 1973, over a period of two


weeks, I transcribed additional background material from
tape recordings of the Centre House Library, London.
Subjects related principally to etheric and chakra energies.

During October, 1973, I attended a two-day "vibration


seminar" sponsored by the Carthage Trust Organization in
Cheltenham, England. Among the speakers were Dr. Mark
Gallert, noted authority on radionics, and Father Andrew
Glazefski, Catholic priest, physicist, and an outstanding
"spiritual healer." Otherspeakersdealt with "absent healing,"
healing with color and sound vibrations, and certain esoteric
considerations associated with human illnesses. In addition to
the formal discussions, an instructive film on vibrations was
shown, and several informal conversations evolved around
assorted metaphysical, esoteric phenomena, in particular
one led by Father Glazefski, where he demonstrated " spiri-
tual healing," using my wife and others present as subjects.
Another experience during this period was a "spiritual read-
ing," involving precognition, with myself as the subject; this
was performed by an individual in attendance at the seminar.

253
Another notable experience of the Cheltenham seminar was
the showing of a ilm on vibrations. This film was produced
by a scientific research group in Switzerland, headed by
Dr. Hans Jenny, and its contents were striking and unforget-
table. It demonstrated the effects of vibrations upon matter.
Various sound vibrations, ranging from a single, simple note,
to complicated, classical orchestral music, were fed into a
membrane-like surface which vibrated accordingly. On top of
this vibrating surface was placed a moderately viscous, gelatin-
like substance which moved easily across the membrane
surface as the vibrations were fed into it. For each note, or
combination of notes, causing the membrane to vibrate, the
viscous material assumed a definite geometric pattern. The
more complex the vibration (as in the case of a full symphony
orchestra holding a single note), the more complex the
geometric pattern. In some instances, the pattern resembled
the intricate lace-like designs of photographed snow flakes.

As part of the film's narration, the comment was made that


even the investigating scientists who prepared the film did
not fully understand the mechanisms involved in the
phenomenon, or the extent of its further implications. But
the messagewhich the film conveyed was that vibrations can
structure and pattem matter. And from other sources, we
know that certain vibrations can "destroy" matter, for
example, the sustained high "C" which shatters a wine glass,
or the rhythmical vibrations set up by troops marching across
a bridge causing it to collapse. From the film, one could
extrapolate to the concept that various vibrations - differing
perhaps in kind, but still vibrations -- act upon all aspects of
human physical and social existence, and are responsible for
structure and form throughout the manifest world!

254
WRITTEN WORKS: Many written materials have contributed significantly to
this work, but of particular note are the following:

t. Cosmic Humanism, by Oliver Reiser and the Biological-


Spiritual Transmutation Papers, produced by the Commission
for Research Into the Creative Faculties of Man, when
considered collectively, are unique in that, quite apart from
their wide-ranging wealth of scientific detail involving
physics, biology, and cosmology, there is an overriding theme
of integration, an interdisciplinary weaving together of what
would otherwise be disparate fields of endeavor. Reiser, for
example, draws upon an incredibly broad range of technical,
historical, and behavioral data in formulating his concepts of
a possible interrelationship between the human organism
and a hypothetical "cosmic organism".

) Various De La Warr and Radionic Centre Publications,


contained accounts of some of the pioneer investigations in
radionics, and other types of electro-vibrations spearheaded
by the late George De La Warr of Oxford, England. Much of
De La Warr's work apparently has not yet been duplicated,
and the impression one gets is that his findings, even now, are
in advance of their times. His work on "nodal points," for
example, still seems to be virtually unknown in scientific
circles.

3. Various written works on esoteric aspects of vibrations are


listed below and have provided crucial background informa-
tion, as well as direct contributions to this work. These
volumes are instructive on numerous aspects of extra-physical
phenomena, and they especially advance the notion that an
outstanding feature of metaphysical realms is that of vibra-
tional, radiational, electrical properties and mechanisms -
even though the nature of the "electricity" differs from our
popular concept of it. These works seem largely unknown or
ignored in many scientific circles, but are found to bear
significant relationships to scientific investigations. Several of
these works also appear in the bibliography:

255
The Sacred Flame, Phoebe Bendit
Man Incarnate, Phoebe & Laurence Bendit
The Science of Seership, Geoffrey Hodson
The Etheric Double, A. E. Powell
The Mental Body, A. E, Powell
The Power and Use of Thought, C. W. Leadbeater
The Chakras. C. W. Leadbeater
Thought Forms, Annie Besant & C. W. Leadbeater
Man and His Bodies, Annie Besant
The Esoteric Philosophy of Love and Matiage,
Dione Fortune
The Holy Science, Sri Yukteswar

4. Nuclear Evolution: Discovery o the Rainbow Body, by


Christopher Hills, centers on an examination of the "absolute
self," which lies at the core of man's being. One learns from
this book that there are numerous approaches to, and ramifi-
cations of, an absolute self, including a scientific one. The
author, for example, draws upon physics and biology in
discussing the utilization of primary light vibrations in
sustaining the human organism, and in conditioning human
personality. Also, various layers or levels of consciousness,
and personality types are related to the specific constituent
frequency bands which comprise primary light.

Using Hills' perspective, one comes to view human levels of


consciousness (personality) as being greatly influenced by the
body's direct intake (or lack of intake) of certain primary
vibrational forces which are constantly present in the atmos-
phere. The book instructs on how to identify personality
types which aregrouped according to various color categories,
i.e. red, orange, yellow, etc., and by relating this color
schema to certain mechanical rates of vibration. such as those
produced by a metronome.

Just before this book, Your Electro-Vibratory Body, went


to press, Christopher Hills published a much expanded,lO24
page edition of the original Nuclear Evolution,* from which
extracts have been used in this book. Time did not permit the
full impact of this significant work to be conveyed here.
* ltscoveris usedto introduce on"Chakras
thechapter andSocialMani,-
page2O7 of thisbook.
festations."
256
INTERVIEWS, Dr. Christopher Hills -- Philosopher, Scientist, Metaphysician,
VISITS, TRAVEL: -- 1970 to present.
My contact with Hills extends ove a period of seven years.
During that time we have had numerous private discussions
at Centre House, London and the University of the Trees,
California, on matters related to both the esoteric and the
exoteric aspects of radiational energies.Additionally, attend-
ance at his public presentations, transcription of his tape
recorded lectures, and frequent correspondence, have
expanded my understanding of chakra energiesand associated
phenomena. Hills' suggestions and endorsement are responsi-
ble for much of the content of this work, particularly as
concerns things metaphysical.

De La Warr Research Laboratories, Oxford, England


August, 1972.
During a visit to these facilities, I met with the Director,
Mrs. Marjorie De La War, who explained the radionic and bio-
magnetic work of the centre, and took me on a tour of the
laboratory. I also met with staff engineers and technicians,
and received explanations on the concepts underlying the
workings of their numerous treatment and research equip-
ment. Mrs. De La Warr elaborated on the principles of
radionics and how it was possible to effect "cures" over
distancesof thousands of miles using a radionic broadcasting
device which was seen in operation at the time.

Mrl Mariorie de Ia llan

257
Dr. Ralph U. Sierra -- Biomagnetic Researcher - November,
1972.
A two-day visit to Sierra's facility in Rio Piedras, Puerto Rico
was instructive on a broad range of research activities. Sierra
has an extensive "magnetic garden," which he regularly
waters with polarized water. This is made possible by the
invention of a specially designed electromagnet through
which the water passes before it reaches the plants. Accord-
ing to Sierra, the foliage and produce of his plants are
especially abundant because of their magnetic treatment.
Employing many of the devices which he had constructed for
biomagnetic treatment and research, Sierra also explained the
basic principles of electro-magnetism and biomagnetism and
gave examples and demonstrations of how the two energies
interact.

Sister Justa Smith -.- Research Biochemist -- November,


1972.
While I was in Puerto Rico visiting Dr. Sierra, Dr. Smith was
also in that country at Sierra's invitation. She gave two
lectures on her research with enzymes, magnetic fields, and
"healing hands" - one to ageneral audience at the University
of Puerto Rico, and the other to a small group of profession-
als at Sierra's home. I attended both presentations, and inter-
viewed her following her discussion at Sierra's home.
Dr. Smith talked about the implications of her pioneer
research, indicating that science is really only beginning to
understand some of the subtle forces of nature with which
metaphysicians have been dealing throughout the centuries.
She also explained how electromagnetic force-fields could
influence the reactions of certain neural enzymes, which
could conceivably lead to both motor and behavioral
irregularities in the human organism. Other features of the
interview with Dr. Smith are contained in the present work
under the section of Magnetism and Enzymes.

258
Dr. A. Roy Davis -- Biomagnetic Researcher -- November,
r972.
Many details of my visit to Davis' laboratory in Florida are
contained in this volume under the section Polarities - North
and South. It can be added that Davis was a patient inter-
viewee, generous with both his time and his information, We
spent long hours sorting out the behavioral implications of
his biomagnetic work with animals and humans. Davis was
always careful to explain the technical details of his experi-
mentS and the operation of his various measuring devices.
For me his explanations represented a practical exposure to,
and an expansion of, some of the electrodynamic theories
which I had studied years ago. I continue to maintain contact
with Davis and have consulted him on several specific cases
where biomagnetic treatment was, or might have been, applied.

Dr. Francis Woidich -- Biophysicist and Practicing Physician


-- December,1972.
A brief interview was held at Woidich's home in Mclean,
Virginia. In addition to being a trained scientist, Woidich is
unique in that he is also well versed in various metaphysical
teachings. Our conversation dealt primarily with the border-
line area of investigation found between science and meta-
physics. It is Woidich's contention that when breakthroughs
to understanding the "psychic" world are made, that it will
be the physicist, not the spiritualist, who makes them, since
the primary question about the very nature of matter and
atomic substance,upon which much "psychic" phenomena
rests, must be answered by those who work closely with the
confounding perplexity of subtle, unexplained forces
contained within the atom. Woidich further discussed areas
of extraterrestrial radiations and nuclear forces which were
completely new, and edifying to me, for example, the
existence of unidentified, non-electromagnetic vibrations,
which ae a part of solar radiations, but which are not
associated with either heat or lieht wavelensths.

259
Dr. Eric Austin -- Physician, EEG Specialist -- February-
March, 1973.
Dr. Austin was interviewed on two separateoccasions at his
office in the public hospital, Georgetown, Guyana. The value
of his input was his instruction on the behavior of the
bioelectric frequencies emitted by the human brain, their
specific boundary points as recognized by medical science,
and as registered on the electroencephlogram. Austin's contri-
bution is contained under the section on Brain Rhythms.

Dr. Ingho H. Kornblueh -- Research Physician -- May, 1973.


A tape recorded interview was conducted with Kornblueh at
his home in Philadelphia. Kornblueh is recognized as one of
the foremost pioneers in the medical application of negative
ion therapy. His biggest contribution to my research was his
discussion of some of the physiological effects of small air
ions. Also important was the fact that he directed me to the
works of other researchers,including that of Drs. F. G. Sulman
and A. P. Kruger.

Dr. Reinhold Reiter -- Environmental Physicist -- September,


1973.
A tape recorded interview with Reiter was held during a
visit to his environmental research station in Garmisch-
Partenkirchen, Germany. . Reiter's approach to assessing
environmental electro-vibratory influences is strictly scienti-
fic, relying heavily upon repeated experiments, continuous
measurement of environmental forces, and statistical analysis
of voluminous amounts of data. Reiter's techniques are
"material" and "pragmatic." The value of his views is
precisely that they do represent the classic scientific attitude
of inquiry, which in the present instance, is supportive of
some of the metaphysical beliefs about the influence of
extraterrestrial vibratory phenomena upon human popula-
tions. And, in the broader context, Reiter's contribution is
important in achieving the scientific-metaphysical balance,
which this work seeks to achieve overall.

260
Mr. Charles Topley Engineer-Inventor September-
October. 1973.
On three separate occasions Topley was interviewed at his
home, which also serves as his laboratory in London. It was
very useful to see the theory of ion/behavioral influences
take on applied form with Topley's negative ion generator.
Topley, who was recommended to me by Dr. Sierra, was
engaged in several medical research projects, physical as well
as behavioral, including one particular case of terminal cancer
in a 2l-year old boy, who, at last report, was making a
remarkable recovery with the aid of negative ion therapy.
Conversations with Topley had the added advantage that he
was knowledgeable with other significant works in his field of
investigation, and in numerous cases was in regular personal
contact with other researchersaround the world. Topley, like
Reiter, holds close to scientific method and its practical
applications.

Dr. Mark Gallert Naturopath, Radionics Research --


October-November, I 973.
In addition to two tape recorded interview sessions with
Gallert, we had several other informal discussions on
radonics, plus a lecture given by him during the Cheltenham
vibration seminar, mentioned earlier. Also, a friend, my wife,
and myself, all received a full diagnosis on Gallert's Radionic
Analyzer, which served as further instruction and demonstra-
tion on the theory and methods of radionics. The unique
value of Gallert's contribution lies in the fact that his
radionic techniques bridge the gap between Science and the
Esoteric; for whereas he employs electronic deces capable
of detecting and, in a sense,quantifying radionic energies,he
is also dealing with the more subtle auric bodies of the
human being, which are usually detected by means of clair-
voyance, or other supra-normal faculties, and which are
discussed in the jargon of metaphysics.

The fact that Gallert is trained in both scientific method


(degree in psychology), as well as in meta-physics, and that

261
his methods of investigation also involved both areas of
inquiry, makes radionics something of a natural meeting
place for both scientific and metaphysical researchers.Much
of the information and insight obtained from Gallert appears
under the section on Radionic Energy. His book New Light
on Therapeutic Energies, published by the Radionic Associa-
tion, Burford, England, is a good outline of his approach.

Dr. Corona Trew -- Chemist and Theosophist .- November,


1973.
Private discussions were held with Dr. Trew on two separate
occasions in London at the headquarters of Theosophical
Society in England. Unlike the strict scientific approach of
Reiter and Topley, Dr. Trew, in her thinking on electro-
vibratory phenomena can easily integrate the scientific with
the esoteric. The value of her input was to help focus on
ways whereby the link-up between science and metaphysics
might become more explicit and more practical. She was also
instrumental in directing me to the relevant works of other
researchers,particularly those ofPhoebe and Laurence Bendit.

Dr. Humphrey Osmond -- Psychiatrist -- December, 1973,


The brief interview with Osmond was conducted by long
distance telephone conversation. The value of Osmond's
input lies in his personal .conirmationof his belief that his
Jung-modiied personality types bear a close relationship to,
and probable tie-in with, the chakra-time world schema of
Dr. Christopher Hills. It was also useful to have Osmond's
affirmation that his earlier work, which he now considers
somewhat simplistic, is soon to be superceded by a more
elaborate analysis, thus suggesting that some of the gaps
between our present tentative correlation between the
Osmond and Hills schemas, may eventually be filled in by
Osmond's expanded concepts. The Hills-Osmond correlations
are contained under the section, Psychological Personality
Types.

262
Dr. Felix Gad Sulman,M.D., D.V.M., -- Headof the Depart-
ment of Applied Pharmacologyand Bioclimatology Unit,
Hebrew University.
Dr. Sulman generouslycontributed to this second edition
by respondingto requestsfor publicationsand illustrationsof
fus work on the biological effects of positive and negative
ions in the environment. Sulman's unique geographical
situation for studying positive air ionization, and his highly
respected scientific reputation, make his observationsa
valuableadditionto this book.

Dr. Albert Paul Krueger,M.D., LL.D., - EmeritusProfessor


of Bacteriology and Emeritus Lecturer in Medicine, University
of California Berkeley.
Dr. Krueger, like Dr. Kornbleuh, was one of the original
pioneers in the field of ion research.He has headed the
Universityof CaliforniaAir Ion ResearchLaboratorysinceits
inception 2l years ago and has publishedaround 100 papers
on the biological impact of small air ions. His philosophical
insight into the subjectis an invaluablecontribution to this
book and to all studentsof ion research.

The editors wish to add their appreciation to those people


who so readily responded with additional materials and
photographs to enable this expanded edition to be realized.

An Anonymous Metaphysician
There have been discussions with, and guidance from, an
individual trained in metaphysical systems. This person has
asked to remain unnamed, but has played a pivotal role in the
direction taken in this work.

263
W O R K S A N D S O U R C E SC I T E D

1 . B I O L O G I C A L E F F E C T S O F M A G N E T I C F I E L D S , E d i t o db y M a d e l l n eF . B a r n o t h y .N e w Y o r k :
P|enum Press,964.
2. MIND AND MATTEB, Badionic Centre Organizstion, Oxford, England, March 1966.
3 . C O S M I C H U M A N I S M , O l i v 6 r L . B e i e e r .C a m b r l d g e ,M a s s . :S c h e n k m a nP u b l i r h l n gC o , , 1 9 6 6 .
4 . T H E L I V I N G C E L L , O l i v e r G i l l i e . L o n d o n : T h a m e sa n d H u d s o n L t d . , 1 9 7 1 .
5. COLOR PSYCHOLOGY AND COLOB THEBAPY, F a b e r B i r r e n . N e w Y o r k : U n i v e r s i t yB o o k s ,
I n c , ,1 9 6 1 .
6. B|oLoG|cAL.sP|R|TUAL T R A N S M U T A T | o N s . P a p r N o . 3 , C o m m | s s i o nf o r R g s e a r c hI n t o
t h o c r a t i v e F a c u l t i e 8o f M a n . c n t r e H o u s o , L o n d o n .
7. B|oLoG|cAL.sP|R|TUAL T R A N S M U T A T | O N S , P a p e r N o ' 4 , c o m m | s s | o n o r R s a r c h |nto
ths Creative Facultiosof Man. Csntre Housa, London.
8. M I N D A N D M A T T E R , R a d i o n i cC e n t r eO r g a n l z a t l o nO
, xford, Engltnd,March 1967.
9. RADIoNIcs NEWsLETTER, Bedionic contr organizatlon, oxord, Eng|and, summer 1972'
1 O . T H E D I V I N A T I O N O F D l S E A S E , H o n r y T o m l i n s o n . S u r r e y , E n g l a n d :H e a l t h S c i o n c o P r e s s1, 9 5 8 .
1 1 . M I N D A N D M A T T E R , B a d i o n i c C e n t r e O r g . n l z . t l o n , O x f o r d , E n g l a n d ,S e p t e m b e r1 9 6 5 .
12. ,,PoWER oF THoUGHT,,, Gorge Ds La Warr, Reprlnt o a pap6r r6ad to thg oxord Un|verslty
sciEntific Socew, May 5' 1961.
13. AN INTHODUCTION TO FOUBIEH ANALYSIS, R. D. Stuart. London: Methucn Publirhlng
Co. Ltd.,1961.
14. scIENcE GRoUP JoUBNAL, V o ' x I V ' N o . 1 . H ' T U d o r E d m o n s ' T h 6 T h o s o p h i c asl o c i e t y i n
E n g l e n d .S p r i n g , 1 9 7 0 .
15. PABAPSYCHOLOGY, Vol.5, No.3, 1953-4.
16. "THE EARTH AS A OYNAMO", W a l t e r M . E l s a s s e r ,B e p r l n t f r o m " S c i e n t i f l c A m e r i c a n " , M a y ,
19 5 8 .
17. UNDERSTAND|NG THE EABTH, Edltgd by |' G' Gass, Peter J. smth, and B. C. L' Wi|son.
London: Artemis Press,1971.
1 8 . " B E L A T I O N S H I P O F G E O M A G N E T I C E N V I B O N M E N T T O B I O L O G Y " , R o b e r tO . B e c k e r ,
, , N e W Y o r k s t a t e J o u r n 8 | o M o d i c I n e . , ,A u g u l t 1 ' 1 9 6 3 .

1 9 . O C E A N O F T H E O S O P H Y , W l l l i a m O . J u d g e . L o s A n g e l e s ,C a l l f o r n l a :T h e T h e o s o p h y C o m p a n y ,
1971.
20. D A f L Y C H B O N I C L E , G u y a n a ,S . A . , A p r i l 2 6 , 1 9 7 3 .
21. B r i t i s h B r o a d c a s t i n gC o r p o r a t l o n , L o n d o n , O c t o b o r 3 , 1 9 7 3 .
2 2 . M A G N E T A N D M A G N E T I C F I E L D S , A . B . D a v i s a n d A . K , B h a t t a c h a r y a .C a l c u t t a , I n d i a ;
F i r m a K . L . M u k h o p a d h y a V ,1 9 7 0 .
2 3 . " M A N , T H E B I O - M A G N E T I C A N I M A L " , J o e e p h F . G o d d a v a g c ." F a t s M a g a z l n e " ,J u l y 1 9 6 4 .
2 4 . , , T H E L I V I N G o R G A N I s M A N D T H E M A G N E T I c F I E L D ' ' , L e o n | d R p i n . , , s p u t n i k , , .N o ' 4 ,
I 967.

264
2 5 . T H E l N l T I A T I o N o F T H E W o R L D , V . . s t a n | e y A | d e r . N e w Y o r k : S a m u e |W e i s e r I n c . , 1 9 6 9 .
2 6 . " T I M E M A G A Z I N E " , U . S . E d i t i o n ,J u n e 1 4 , 1 9 7 1 .
27' ,,cEBEBRAL ELECTROMAGNET|c F I E L D s ' ' , P . | ' G u | i a e v ' , , I n t e r n s t i o n aJ| o u r n a y o P a r a -
p s y c h o l o g y " ,V o l , 7 , N o . 4 , 1 9 6 5 .
2 8 . " M A G N E T I C F I E L o S T R E N G T H A N D o R G A N I S M I C O B I E N T A T I O N " ( a b s t r a c t )F,. A . B r o w n
a n d F , H . B a r n w e l l ." B i o l o g i c a l B u l l e t i n g " ,1 1 9 : 3 0 6 , 1 9 6 0 ,
29. "EXTBINSIC RHYTHMICALITY; A BEFERENCE FBAME FOR BIOLOGICAL RHYTHMS
UNDER SO-CALLED CONSTANT CONDITIONS", F. A. Brown, Jr., "Annals New York
Ac.d6my of sci n cos, 98|775.787' 1962,
30. THE PoWER ANo UsF oF THoUGHT, c. W. Lgadbatsr' 4th Beprlnt' Adyar, Madras, India:
T h e T h e o s o p h i c a |P u b l i s h n 9H o u s e , 1 9 7 o .
31. THE WEB OF THE UNIVERSE, E. L, Gardner.znd Editlon. London: Fletcherand Son Ltd,,
19 6 0 .
3 2 , T H E M E N T A L B O D Y , A r t h u r E . P o w e l l , 2 n d R E p r l n t . L o n d o n : T h e T h s o s o p h i c a lP u b l i s h l n g
Houss London Ltd., 1967.
33. ESOTERIC PHILOSOPHY OF LOVE AND MARBIAGE. Dlone Fortune.4thEditon.London:
The Aquerian Press,1970,
34, THE DESTINY OF THE NATIONS, Alice A. Ball6y.3rd Boprlnt. New York: Lucis Publishing
C o . . 19 6 8 .
3 5 . P S Y C H I C A L P H Y S I C S , S . W , T r o m p . A m s t e r d a m , H o l l a n d : E l s e v i e rP u b l i s h l n gC o , , I n c . , 1 9 4 9 ,
36. THE SACBED FLAME, Phoebe D, Bondit. London: Th6osophlcrl Publlshing House, 1953.
3 7 . M A N I N c A R N A T E , P h o e b e D . B e n d i t a n d L a u r e n c g J . B n d i t . L o n d o n : T h e o t o p h i c a |P u b | i r h i n g
H o u s o ,1 9 5 7 .
38. THE SCIENCE OF SEERSHIP, Geoffrey Hodson.London: Bid6r & Co.
39. B L U E P B I N T F O B I M M O F I T A L I T Y , H a r o l d S . B u r r , L o n d o n : N e v i l l eS p e a r m a n ,1 9 7 2 .
40. "NEWSLETTER", Radionic Magnetic Csntre Organizatlon, Oxford, England, Summer 1972.
41. THE CHAKRAS, C , W . L e a d b e a t e r .S t h R e p r l n t . L o n d o n : T h e o s o p h i c a l P u b l i s h i n g H o u s a , 1 9 6 9 .
47. H E A L T H , W E A T H E R A N D C L I M A T E , D r . F . G . S u l m a n , M . D . , A l b e r t J . P h l e b l g , I n c . ,B o x 3 5 2 ,
White Plains, New York 10602.

The following publicationsare availablethrough the University of the Trees Press


4 2 . S U P E B S E N S O N I C S , C h r i s t o p h e rH i l l s , 1 9 7 5 .
43. HILLS'THEOBY O F C O N S C I o U S N E S S , R o b e r t M a s s y ,1 9 7 6 .
44. NUCLEAR EVOLUTION: DISCOVERY O F T H E R A I N B O W B O D Y , C h r i s t o p h e rH i l l s , 1 9 7 7 .
4 5 . E N E B G Y , M A T T E R A N D F O R M , P h i l A l l e n , B o g e r S m i t h , A l a s t a i r B e a r n e ,1 9 7 7 .
46. ,,THE sc|ENCE oF V|BBATIoN AND TBANsM|ss|oN oF L|FE FoBcE', - scrieso 24
cassette tapes, 1975,
4 8 . A L I V E T O T H E U N I V E R S E , B o b e r t M a s s y ,1 9 7 6 .
49. THE BISE OF THE PHOENIX: UNIVERSAL GOVEBNMENT BY NATURE'S LAWS,2nd
Edition.1978.
50. JOUBNEY INTO LIGHT, Ann Bay, 1977.

265
T A P E R E C O R D E D IN T E R V I E W S ,P R I V A T E C O N V E R S A T I O N S ,
, ND PERSONALPAPERS:
W R I T T E NC O R R E S P O N D E N C EA

A. D r . F r e d C a m p a y n e , N u c | e a r P h y s c s t ,U n i v e r s i t y o f G u y a n a , G u y a n a , s , A . , 1 9 7 2 . 7 4 .
B. Dr. L|oyd S.N' Kunar, Geophysicst. Head, Department of Physics, University of Guyana, S.A.,
1972-74.
c.* Dr. Ra|ph U. serra, Biomagnetic Researcher. Flo Piedras, Puerto Rico, 1972-4'
1) "Biomagnetic Report".
2) Miscellaneous articles written andlor complied by Dr. Slerra,
D.f Dr, Albert Boy Davis, Blomagnetlc Besearcher, Green Cove Sprlngs, Florlda, 1972-74.
1 ) "Biomagnetism" (Master Manuscript).
2) "Anatomy of Biomagnetism".
3) "Biomagnetism -.. Biological Electronics",
E. sister Justa smith, Ph'D', Biochemist. Directo of Besearch, Human Dimnsions Institute;
Chairman, chmistry Department, Rosary Hi|| Co||ege, Buffa|o, New York, 1972'
F. Dr. Eric O. Austin, Physician, EEG Speciallst. Goorgetown Publlc Hospital, Guyana, S.A..1973.
G.* Dr' Mark L. Ga||ert, N.o., Badonic Designer and F|esearcher. Garhage c||nic, che|tenham,
England, 1973-4.
1} ,,Esoterc Aspects of Tuned Electronlcs...
H. Dr. Humphrey Osmond, Psychiatrist, Bureau of Besearch in Neurology and Psychlatry. Princeton
University. 1973.
1) "The Many Worlds of Time", H, Msnn, M, Sieglor. and H, Osmond. Beprlntfrom the "Journal
of Analytical Psychology", Vol. l3, No,1.1968.
Dr. ReinhoId Beiter, PhysicIst, Director, Inst|tute or Atmospheric EnvironmentaI Bsearch,
Garmisch-Partenkirchen, Germany; Chairman, Study Group of Biomoteorology, Lsiden, Holland,
1973.
1) "Biometeorology", Vol,5, Part ll, proceedlngs of 6th Intl. Congress,Sept,3-9,1972. Edited
by S. W. Tromp, et. al.
Dr. christopher B. H|||s, Metaphysica| Reseacher, BouIder creek, ca|ifornia,1972.74'
1) "Nuclear Evolution", Centre Community Publicatlons, London, 1968.
K.* Mr. Char|es Top|ey, Research Engneer. London. Eng|and, 1973'
1) "lnfluence of Air lons on Certain Physlological Function6," A papor complled from the
pub|ications of Prof. A. P, Krusge, Univers|ty f CaIifornia, Berkeley.
2l "Air lonization and Weather Sensitivity", a paper written by Prof. F. G. Sulman, Head,
Department of App|ied Pharmacology, The Hebrew University of JerusaIem, Isea|.
3) A personal letter written by Prof. Sulman to Mr. Topley.
4) "lonizing Effects of Winds of lll Bepute on Seratonin Metabolism". A. Danon and F. G.
Sulman. An extract, proceedings, sth Biometerological Congress, Montreux, Switzerland, 1969.
5) , , E f f e c t s of Hot, Dry, Dosert Winds (Sirocco, sharav, Hams|n) on the MetaboIism o Hormones
and Minera|s.,, F. G' suIman, N. Hrschman and J. Pheier, Bepr|nt rom proceedings,
Lucknow Symposium on Arid Zones, UNESCO, 1964,
6) "Review of Scientific Information on the Effects of lonized Air on Human Beings and
Animals." Joseph B. Davis, M.D,, Rsprint, Aerospace Medicine, Vol.34, No. 1. Jan, 1963,
L. Dr, Ingho H, Kornblueh, Research Physician, Former Vice-President, American Institute of
Medical Climatology, Philadelphia, 1973,

| |n addition to conversations and recorded ntervews With the researcher, the works listed be|ow h|s
name were either written or compiled by the researcher himself, and have also contrlbuted to this
vo lume.

266
INDEX
A -energies:246 B i o m a g n e t ic i e | d :1 7 , 8 2 , 1 5 6 '
Axis: 7, 10 Biosphere:57...
Aaron:82.... Bipolar:33...
Abrams, Dr. Albert: 77, 80, -forces:54....
8 2 , 9 3 . 1 5 1. . B B l a c k ,D r . D . l . : 8 9
A c i d : 1 7 ,1 0 8 . . B l a c kh o l e s : 2 9 . . .
Acupuncture: 40 . . B a c k ( s p i n e ) :7 8 . , . . B l o o d :1 6 , 1 7 .
Adrenalcortex: 133 . . BagchiD , r . B a s h uK . : 1 4 2 . . . . -cells:17
Aging: 99 Bailey, Alice A.: 232, 234- B l o o d s t r e a m :1 2 6 - 1 2 7 1 , 34 .,,
A i r - i o nb e h a v i o r at li e - i n : 1 3 9 . . 236,249 B l u e p r i n ft o r l m m o r t a l i t y :1 6 6 .
A i r i o n e n v i r o n m e n t :1 3 6 , , B a i n e sA, . E . : 1 1 4 - 1 1 5 , Bone: 78.
A i r i o n i z a t i o n :1 2 3 , 1 4 2 , 1 4 4 . . B a r d o t ,B r i g i t t e :2 1 9 , . . . , . . . Brain: 22, 40, 45, 78, 106-107,
Air ions: 124, 126, 134, 138, BarnothyD , r.Jeno: 16,92,100 1 0 9 - 11 0 , 1 4 2 , 1 5 0 .
156-158. B a r n o t h y ,D r . M a d e l i n e : 8 , 1 5 , - f r e q u e n c y1: 0 9 - 1 1 3 , 1 5 0. . .
A i r p o l l u t i o n :1 2 5 . 8 0 , 1 0 0 , 1 5 1.. . -responses:104 . .
Akashic B a r n w e l l , D Fr . H . : 9 1 . . . . . . 'Breakthrough to Creativity':
- f o r c e s2: 9 . . . B a r o m e t r i c p r e s s u r 9e 8: . . . . . . 247...
-light: 27.
B r o w n , D r . F r a n k A , , J r . : 9 1,
A l e x a n d e rD , r. Harold: 100 . . . Beasley,Victor: iv, 207 106,151
Algae: 237 B e c k e r ,D r . R o b e r t : 1 0 0 , 1 0 6 , B u l l a r dE, . C . : 8 6
'Alive
t o t h e U n i v e r s e ' :8 2 , 1 7 9 , 113... B u r n s :1 2 8
A l k a l i n e :1 7 , 1 0 8 Beckett:127.., Burr, Prof. Harold Saxon: 166-
A l l e n ,D r . D . W . : 8 6 B e n d i t ,P h o e b e : 1 6 3 , 1 9 7 - 1 9 9 , 171, 228,244-245.
A l l e nl n t e r n a t i o n a1l 1: 0 . . . . . 230.247
A l l e n ,P h i l : 1 1 , 4 0 . B e n o tM , .: 42,44
A l p h a r h y t h m : 11 0 - 11 1, 1 1 3 , Beta rhythm: lll , 112 . . . c
142. . . Bhattacharyan.Dr. George: 9 7 ,
A l t e r n a t i n g f i e l d s1;2 1 ,. . . . . . 107. C a i n ,D r . l . K . : 8 7 .
A n e s t h e s i a :1 0 7 , 1 1 3 . B i g B a n gT h e o r y : 1 6 3 .. . . . . . C a i n ,D r . P . C . : 8 7
A n g l e o fi n c i d e n c e6:1 , . . . , . . B i n d i n gf o r c e : 9 9 CallasM , aria: 222. . .
A n t i o c h C o l l e g e 1: 7 9 . . . . . . . Biochemical:4. C a f c i f i c a t i o n s7: 3 . .
Aristotle:99... -responses:14 Cancer:99...
Arthritic spurs: 73 B i o c l i m a t o l o g:y 1 1 7 - 1 ' 1 81,5 3 'l
Causalbody: 77
A s t r a lb o d y : 1 7 7 . . Bioelectric Cell
Atomc - e n e r g i e s1: 0 9 , 1 3 7 - 1 3 8 .. -division:15..,
- d i s i n t e g r a t i o2n9: . . . . . . . - f i e l d s :9 8 , 1 9 4 . - m e m b r a n e :1 9 , 2 0 .
- m o l e c u l am r agnetism5 : ... Biofeedback8 : 2. -nucleus:19...,
- m a g n e t ifci e l d : 6 Biological C e l l s : 1 7 , 1 9 ,2 0 , 2 2 , 1 6 8 . . . . .
.precesson:9'''.' - c a t a l y s t2: 2 . C e n t r eH o u s e : 5 4 , 6 2 , 2 3 8 . . . .
A t o m cE n e r g yC o m m i s s i o n : -evolution:86 Centrosphere:. 57 . .
136.. . -sensitivity to geomagnetic Cerebral
'lO, forces:152.
Atoms: 7-8, 31, 64, 123, - c o r t e x :1 0 4 , 1 5 0
172.177 -svstems:85... -systems:46...
Aura balancing:82, 179, 183, Biological/behavioral C e r e b r u m :1 1 2 - 1 1 3 .
246. . . - i n f l u e n c e1s5: 2 . Ceremonial order: 234-235. , . .
Auras: 27.66, 163.181,183, -systems:197. . .
Chakra
187...:.... - t i e - i n s ;1 5 0 - 1 5 1 1, 5 4 , 1 5 6. . -earth:188
Auric -electricity:204...
-bodies: 177-178, 198, 205, . e n d o c r ntei e . i n : 1 9 8 ,2 0 0 .

267
-energies:215,225,235. . . . Einstein,Albert: 28. 148, Fundamentalray disc: 64-65 . .
-systems: 192, 195-196,214. E l a s s e rD, r . W i l l i a m :9 0 . . . . . .
246-247. E l e c t r i cf i e l d s : 1 1 9 , 1 2 1 , 1 7 1 . .
Chakras: 183, 185, 187-188, E l e c t r i c i t y6:, 1 7 8 , 1 8 6 , . . . . , G
192-194, 196-202, 204, 208, Electrobiodynamics:27-28.. . .
210-217,225, 235, 250 . . . . E l e c t r o c h e m i c a l1: 9 Gallert, Dr. Mark: 172-173,
Electroencephalogram : 109-110, 175, 177-178,197-198,245 .
C i r c u l a t o r y s y s t e m1: 3 8 . . . . . . 1 1 2 - 1 1 3 , 1 4 2. . Gandhi,Mahatma: 223 . . . . . .
Cfairvoyance:192-193,230 . . . E l e c t r o l y t i c r e s p o n s e 1s :4 . . . . Gardner,E. L.: 229.
Cleopatra:99.... Electromagnetic energies:27-29, GaussC , . S.: 90
C o h e n ,D r . D a v i d : 1 ' 1 0 . . . . . . 30-31, 44, 148, 188 G a u s s :2 3 - 2 4 . 8 8 . 100-101
Cohesion: 3-8 . . Electromagnetism: 6,23,27, Geomagneticfields: 87, 92, 152
CollectiveUnconscious:249. . . 44-45,93. G e o m a g n e t i s m8:5 , 9 8 .
Colors:42, 5 3 , 1 8 3 ,1 8 5 - 1 8 6 E f e c t r o n s6: - 7 ,1 0 - 11 , 2 7 , 6 2 . . G r a d ,D r .B e r n a r d 2: 4 . , . , . . .
Commission for the Research E l e c t r o s t a t i c c h a n g e1s 1: 9 . . . . Gravitationalforces; 29
lnto the CreativeFacultiesof Electro-vibratory: 2, 148, G u fi a e v ,D r . P . l . : 4 5 - 4 6 .
Man:54,62.... 150,244,248,250 Gunst, Robert: 87 . . .
Conflict: 234-235,240. . . . . . . -energies:150-152,246. . . .
Consciousness: 179, 182, 185, - f i e l d s 7: 7 , 1 4 9 , 1 5 5 .. . . . .
188,194, 199,203.... -forces:97.... H
Cosmic/divine energies: 234- - p h e n o m e n a 1: 5 2 . . .
236,249 -tie-ins:243-244. H a n o k aD, r . N . S . : 1 O 4. . . . . .
C o s m i cH u m a n i s m :3 2 . 3 4 . . . . Emotionab l o d v : .1 7 7 Harmonics:36-37,40, 149. . . .
C o s m i cr a y s : 2 7 , 3 0 , 8 9 , 1 6 3 . . Endocrine systems: 126, 133, Harmony: 234-235
Cox, Dr.Allen: 88 188, 198-199, 202, 204, 247 . H a r r i s o nC, h r i s t o p h e r :8 7 . . . . .
C r e a t i v e C o n f l i c t :2 4 O . . . . . . . Energy: 28, 40, 44, 79, 1O8, H e f i g a r :1 1 4 . .
175, 177-178,183-184,192, H e r t z i a n p h e n o m e n a1:2 1 . . . .
1 9 4 ,1 9 7 , 2 3 0 , 2 3 4 Hills, Christopher: 31, 63-64,
' E n e r g y ,M a t t e ra n d F o r m ' : 4 0 . 7 6 , 1 1 1 , 1 6 3 , 1 8 5 - 1 8 9 ,1 9 3 -
D
E n z y m e s :1 5 . 2 2 , 2 4 , 1 4 8 . . . . 194, 204-209,214, 225, 237 . .
D a l r y m p l e , A .B r e n t : 8 8 . . . . . E s o t e r i cv:i i . . . . H i l l s ' M o d eol f M a g n e t i s m7: 1 . .
- e l e c t r o n i c s1: 7 7 . . . 'Hills' Theory of Consciousness':
Davies,Dr. David: 152-153.. . ,
D a v i s ,D r . A . R o y : 1 7 , 69- -energies:233-236 29,30,240. . .
7 0 , 7 3 - 7 5 , 7 8 1, 0 1 ,1 1 1 . . . . E t h e r i cb o d y : 1 7 7 , 1 9 8 , Hodson,Geofrey: 162, 199. . .
Davis,Dr. JosephB.: 124. . . . . E x t r a s e n s o rpye r c e p t i o n :1 6 2 . . H y p o t h a l a m u s1:1 2 , 1 5 0 . . . . .
D e L a W a r r ,G e o r g e :1 5 1, 1 7 2 . . Extra-terrestrial force fields:
De La Warr Researchers:33, 38- 171,245
42, 44-45,94-97, 176. I
Devotion: 234-235
Disease:77, 14O. F fdealism:234-235.
D i v i n i n g :6 6 , 8 2 - 8 3 ,1 7 2 , 1 8 6 . . fm a g i n a t i o n :2 1 6 , 2 3 5 .
D N A : 11 . 1 9 , 7 4 F e e | n g t y p e : 2 2 2 , 2 ,2,5. ' ' ' fn f r a - r e d2: 8 , 3 0 ,4 2 . . .
d o w s i n g :1 8 4 , 1 8 7 Ferromagnetism:228, 248. . . . I n - p h a s e d n e s3s6: , 2 0 3
' l n s t r u m e n tosf K n o w i n g ' :6 6 . .
Force fields: 39-40, 148, 154 . .
Foster,John: 86. lntelfigence:234-235
E F o r t u n e ,D i o n n e : 2 2 9 - 2 3 0 . . . . l n t u i t i o n :2 1 6 , 2 1 8 , 2 3 5. . . , .
Frequency: 28,36-38.40, I n t u i t i v tey p e : 2 2 3 , 2 2 5 , , , . . .
E a r t h : 1 0 ,2 7 . 6 1 6 4 , 7 0. lon
F r i e d e l l ,D r A a r o n : 1 0 8 . . . . . . - d e n s i t y -9 8 . . .
F u n n e l lB, r i a n : 8 7 -therapy1 : 3 1 ,1 3 4 ,1 3 8 . . . .

268
l o n i z i n gw i n d s : 130-133, - m o m e n t 5: , 7 - 8 , 1 4 , 1 9 . . . Nodalpoints: 35, 39, 41,149,
139,144,156. -north:52.... 18 7 - 18 8 .
M a g n e t i s m :1 9 , 2 2 , 2 4 , 4 0 , 4 2 , Nuclear Evolution: 240,
44, 50, 77, 89, 94, 96, 103 . . 2 5 0 .. .
J Magnetosphere: 27 ' N u c l e a rE v o l u t i o n :D i s c o v e r yo f
Magnetophotocronograph: 69. . t h e R a i n b o wB o d y ' :6 4 , 1 1 1 ,
' J o u r n e yf n t o L i g h t ' : 2 4 0 . . . , . M a g n e t r o n :4 7 , 5 2 , 2 4 6 . . . . . . 142, 185, 207 -208,218, 225 .
J u d g e , W i l l i a m O .i x: . . . . . . . Mann, Harriet: 218 Nuclearforces: 29-30 .
' M a n yW o r l d s T i m e ' :
J u n g ,D r . C a r fG . : 2 1 8 , 2 4 9 . . . of 218. . , N u c l e a r m a g n e t r o n1: 4 . . . . . .
M a r s h a lNl ,i n i a n :3 4 - 3 5 . . . . . . N u c l e u s 8: , 1 9 , 6 4
Massy, Dr. Robert; 47-48, 82-
'f
K 83, 35, 137, 172, 181,239 .
Massy's Law of Radiesthesia: o
K a r a g u l l aD, r . S h a f i c a :2 4 7 . . . . 181-182.
'l Matsu,Toru: 237,
K a t z ,B e r n a r d : 9 . . . O r g a n i cf a r m i n g :5 2 . . ,
Kennedy,John F.: 221 .. . . . . M a t u y a m Ea p o c h :8 8 . . . . . . . Osmond, Prof. Humphrey:.218,
K h o l o d o vD , r .Y . A . : 9 3 . 1 0 5 . . M c D o n a l d ,K e i t h : 8 7 . 224,225,245-246.
Klyston generator:47 . . . . . . . Medtation:142, 24o Out-of-phasedness: 36
K o r n b l u e h ,D r . l g h o H . : 1 2 8 M e d u l l a :1 3 3 . . . O v u l a t i o n :1 6 9 . . .
1 2 9 ,1 3 7 , 1 4 2 . . . M e n s t r u a t i o n1:6 9 . Ozonosphere:57
Krueger, Pro.A.P.: 126-127 . , ' ' Mentab l ody: 19lt . . .
K u n d a l i n i 5: 9 , 6 6 . Mesozoicperiod: 87 . . .
Micro-gauss range: 78 P
Microwaves:28,47 .
L M i t o c h o n d r i a1: 9 . . P a c i n i a n c o r p u s c l e s9:7 . . . . . .
P a i n : 7 3 , 1 O 7 .. .
L a k h o v s kGye, o r g e9: 7 , 1 5 1 . . . . . Molecularmagnetism
1 1: . . . . . P e n d u f u m :6 6 , 7 6 , 8 2 , 1 7 9 - 1 8 1 ,
Leadbeater,BishopC. W.: 192 . Moses:82 1 8 3 r1 8 7 - 1 8 8
1 9 3 , 1 9 7 - 1 9 92, 0 3 , 2 2 9 . . . . M u l a y ,D r . l . L . : 1 5 . P e r s o n a l i ttyy p e s : 2 1 8 .
L-fields: 165-171,187, 228 . . . M u l a y ,D r . L . N . : 1 5 P e s t c o n t r o l5: 2 . . .
Light: 30, 42, 44, 64, 75, 94, P h i l i p p iD, r.H.: 38. . .
98, 174-175,178, 186 P i t u i t a r y :1 9 9 . .
LivanovD , r. M. N.: 104. . . . . . N P l a u t ,D r . M , G . : 8 7
Love-wisdom: 234-235 Polar energies: 60-61, 75, 77,
Nagata,Dr. T.: 86. 116,152
N a k a m u r aP, r o f .H i r o s h i : 2 3 7 . . Po|arties: 50, 54, 56, 61, 70,
M N e b e l ,D r . : 7 6 . . . 78-80, 82-83, 87-88, 107,
Negativepole: 60 1 1 3 ,1 2 4 , 1 5 2 , 1 5 6 ,
M a c l e a nD, r . E . K . : 9 9 , . . . . . . N e r v ef o r c e : 1 1 4 , 1 1 6 Po|arzation:16...
M a g n e t :3 3 , 6 0 ,6 9 - 7 0 ,11 3 . 11 5 . Nervous system: 20, 77, 82, Polarizedwater: 73.
Magnetic 1 1 3 - 1 1 4 ,1 2 1 , 1 2 6 , 1 4 9 ,1 6 9 , Poles,North and South: 33,75,
- e n e r g i e s :7 9 , 9 2 , 1 0 1 , 1 0 8 , 't88,
179, 245,247 80,87,179 . .
115,179,234. . - a u t o n o m i c1: 0 3 ,1 9 8 , . . . . P o s i t i v ieo n s :1 2 5 - 1 2 8 . . . . . .
- e n v i r o n m e n t9: 1 . . - c e n t r a l :1 0 5 - 1 0 9 Postma,Dr. J.: 28.
- e q u a t o r : 6 '.1. . Neural P o t a s s i u m1:6 ,1 9 , 2 0 . . . . . . .
-fieldcomposition: 33 -pfexuses;2OO-2O1 P r o p a g a t i o n3: 8 . . .
-fields: 15, 20, 23-24,33, 36, - s t i m u l a t i odne v i c e s :1 1 4 . . . Proton:8, 14 .
4 0 , 4 9 - 5 0 ,6 9 , 7 3 , 7 8 , 8 6 . . . N e u r o - b i o l o g i ccaul r r e n t s :1 1 3 . P s y c h i c apl h y s i c s : 1 1 9 . . . . . . .
- f o r c ef i e l d s : 5 0 , 6 2 , 8 1 , 9 2 . N e u r o m u s c u l ar re s p o n s e :1 8 6 . . Psychofogical types: 218 - 225

269
o Smith,Dr.P.J.8 : 6......... T r o m p , D r . S . W . :1 1 9 - 1 2 1 . . . .
Smith, Roger: 76-77 Troposphere:122. . .
Ouanta:35 S o d i u m :1 6 ,1 9 , 2 0 . . . . . . . . . T r o p o s p h e r i c f r e q u e n c1i 2e 2s :.
Solar T r y p s i n :2 4 . . . .
- d i s r u p t i o n s1: 1 6 , 1 2 4 , 1 5 7
R -energy:156 . .
- f i e l d s9: 8 . . .
Radiation: vii, 42, 88, 196, - f l a r e s :5 0 , 8 9 . U
203,233,236... -system;10...
R a d i a t i o n apl h y s i c s :3 5 , 5 4 . . . - w i n d s :2 7 . . . . U f f e n ,D r . R . J . : 8 8 .
R a d i e s t h e s i a4:7 , 7 0 , 7 6 , 1 6 5 , S o m a t i c m a g n e t i s2m0:, 1 4 8 . . . U l t r a v i orl ae dt i a t i o2n2: , . . . , , .
172,179,181,184,245.... S o m a t i c p o l a r i t i7e8s .: . . . . . . Ultratheta:112,150
R a d i o w a v e s2:8 . 3 0 ,1 7 8 . . . . . S o u n d :4 2 , 7 5 , 9 4 . . . . Ultravioletlight:28,30.....
Radioactve isotopes:89 ' ' ' ' . Space: 45 'Unversa|Government by Na.
R a d i o n i c A n a l y z e1r :7 2 ,1 7 5 , , , S p e c t r u m2: 8 , 3 1, 6 4 . . . . . . . t u r e ' sL a w s ' :2 3 7 - 2 3 8 , 2 4 0 , .
Radionics: 47, 49, 172, 174, Sphericpulses: 122, 154 Universityof the Trees: 49, 134
176-179,246.. S p i n e :9 6 , 1 0 8 . . . 241,250.
R a p p o r t :4 2 , 4 4 - 4 7 . Spriritualhealing 2 :4 . . . . . . . . -Press: 48,53.240.. . . .
Ravitz, Dr. LeonardJ.: 169 . . . Squarebalanceequalizer:.76-77
R e f l e x o g r a p h9: 4 , 9 6 S t a t i cf i e l d s : 1 1 9 - 1 2 0
ReiserP , rof.F, Oliver: 11,19, S t r a t o s p h e r e5:7 . . . , V
32,34,97,171 S t r u t tM , a l c o l m 2: 3 8 . . . . . . . .
R e t e rD, r . R e i n h o | d :1 1 6 ,1 1 8 - S u b c o n s c i o u s2: 2 9 ' V a n A | | e n B a d i a t i o nB e | t s : 5 9 ,
122,124-125,130-132..... Subethers:162... 88...
R e p u l s i o n :3 3 , 3 6 , Sulman, Prof. Felix G.: 117, 't
Vibration: 28,34,36, 70, 61,
Resonance: 4-10, 34-35, 38, 132-133,136-137,139. 172,179,208...
40,42,56... Sun:27,50,116,198, V i b r a t o r y r e s o n a n c1e7s 7: . . . ,
Bespiratorysystem 1 :2 6 - 1 2 7. . S u p e r s e n s o n i c r u l1e8: 7 . . . . . , Vitic: 114-115
R e t i c uaf r f o r m a t i o n : 1 1 2 , 1 5 0 . Supersensonics: 31, 63,
R e v e r s apf e r i o d i c i t y :8 6 . . . . . . 1 1 4 , 1 6 5 , 1 8 5 - 1 8 7 ,2 4 6 . . .
RNA: 19,74 , . . 'Supersensitive
L i f e o f M a n ' :v . . W
R o g e r s , A . S t a n l e y1: 7 4 . . , . . .
R u s s e l Bl ,e r t r a n d2: 2 0 . . , . . , , Wave
-field:180.
- f o r m s :3 7 .
S Tarczy-Hornoch,Zoltan:112. .
Tchijevsky,A. L.: 100, 126 . .. Weak interactionforces: 29-30 .
S a i n tA u g u s t i n e :9 9 T e s l a ,N i k o l a i : 5 0 . . Witness (in experimentation):
S e m i - p e r m e a bm l ee m b r a n e :1 9 . T e s t i c l e s ;7 8 . . . 47,184
S e n s a t i o tny p e : 2 1 9 , 2 2 5 . . . . . T h e t ar h y t h m : 1 1 1.
S e r o t o n i n :1 2 7 , 1 3 3 , 1 3 9 . 1 4 4 . T h i n k i n gt y p e : 2 2 0 , 2 2 5 . . . . .
S e r v r a n x B r o t h e 4r s7:. . . . , . . T h o u g h t w a v e 3s 1: . . . X
S e x u a li n t e r c o u r s e 1: 9 4 T i l l e r ,P r o f .W i l l i a m : 2 O 2 . . . . .
S i e g l e rM
, iriam: 218. . Time: 45,208 . . X - r a y : 2 8 , 1 3 6 ,1 6 3
Sierra,Dr. Ralph: 73, 80-81, TomlinsonD , r. H,: 33,54,78. .
100,115,177... Topley,Charle1 s :2 4 , 1 3 2 , 1 3 4 .
S k e f e t asl y s t e m :2 0 . . . . T o u s s u l i sY, a n n i : 1 7 9 . . . . . . .
Sleep: 80 Tracy, Lee: 1 10 . . .
Smith, Dr. Justa: 22-23 . Trew, Dr. Corna: 249 . .

270
UNTVERSITY OF THE TREES PRESS
Pub|ishers of practica| spiritual guides, scientfic books and Correspondence
courses
l N T o M E D I T A T I O N N O W : A C O U B S E O F S T U D Y , b y C h r i s t o p h e rH i l l s 45.00
This cost covers the regstration and introduction to the comprehensive thre - year
course of study that enables you to make the philosophy of Nuclear Evolution
a rea|ity in your direct experience. Write or more detai|s.

MEDITATING WITH CHILDREN, by Oeborah Bozman s.95


The first of its knd! A de|ightfu| teaching book that brings the great art and science of
meditation and conscious evo|Ution to chi|dren o a|| ages, this workbook is beng used
ln c|asrooms throughout the country as a non-re|igious txt in centering and wareness
development.

MEDITATION FOR CHILoFIEN, by Oeborah Rozman 5.95


A how.to-re|ax, concenate, meditte and app|y Nuc|ear Evo|ution book for thg entirs
family. Awareness exercises deal with family psychology, problems with communication
and openness, and ways to oster de p sharing and |ove. Published by ce|estia| Arts.

THE BISE OF THE PHOENIX


UNIVEBSAL GOVEBNMENT BY NATURE'S LAWS by Christopher Hills
A radica| brgakthrough theory of government to answ r ttle pressing prob|ems of today,
thi3 book 3hows how to creatg a new 3oc|.| and po|ltlcal order through orggnls d s | f-
gov r nm n t. commended by 8rtrand Ru$ | | who wrot the |ntroduction to the f|rst
od|t|on (publlshed ln |imitod quantitv) and said that these methods provld ths only
poEslble way of comb|ning discip|ine with fre d om and freedom with organlzation,
w now hev a v|sb|6 approach to a new constitution based on natur , E mode|s.

SUPEBSENSONICS, by Chrl3tophsr HlllB l s.oo


The D|viner': b|bl and n cyc|op d la that descr|bes actua| methods o mo6surng psychic
ol c tric|ty (prana) and the Ways anciont masters snd civl|iz8tlons arrived at advanced
know|edg of porceptlon which 3how3 you how to commun|cate with p|ants, crysta|s,
atoms, Cosmlc lntelligances or your truo Self. A mind-bendlng book.

ALIVE TO THE UNIVERSEI, by Bobert Massy 9,95


A physiclst oxplalns Superrensonlcs in Blmpls layman's l6ngua9s, and glves step-by-
.t3p in3tructions on how to div|ne for lost objocts, peop|e, wat r . minerals, h 6 |th, t c.
Your vart potentlal for multi-dlmenslonal awareness awalts unfolding through this
book. An illustration a pags.

ENERGY, MATTER AND FoBM, by P. A|len,R. smith and A' Barne 9.95
Three consc|ousness r s a rchers provide a dynamic workbook for tho3e ready to t s t the
bounds of th l consclougness. lt shows how to perform exp r lments for unfold|ng
extra-ord|nary dlmens|ons of experience. This comprehensivo text presents extens|v
informatlon and insight into the human aura, psvchic ensrgy centsrs. kundalini, psycho-
tronics, l c tophotography, dlvining, acUpuncture research, dionics. hoIography, bIack
ho|gs, pyramld energles and the Creatve lmaginatlon.

RAYS FRoM THE cAPsToNE by christopher H|ls 4'95


After 2o years of |n depth r 3 earch lnto pyramid energies, we now have a book which
contradicts many fantasi s about meditation and pyramld power, 3hows tho poslt|ve nd
negatlva uoes of pyramid energies and exp|a|ns the Pi.ray orgon accumu|ator coffer, a
.,natura|'' power dynamo inventgd by th author which a||ows you to u69 pyramid
energy safelv for growing healthler plants, changlng smotlonal atates, zapping ygurtolf
with snorgy, and purifylng conrciousnssr.

SUPEBSENSONIC INSTRUMENTS OF KNOWING, by Chrlstophsr Hill6 .95


Thi6 book provldes lnstructions on tfie uge of varlous suprB n sonics too|s. rods. pon-
du|ums, etc, |n a comp|6te cat|og of b|ofeodback lnstrumsnts and th i r uses'

HILLS'THEORY OF CONSCIOUSNESS. by Robert Massv 6.95


A student o a masr of consciousness descrbos his own d v e|opment in a group o
15 r | ected students of Nuc|ear Evo|ution. This book contains simp|fied accounts of
nspred research of the actua| structure of Consciousness and its many drives which
physicist Massy belevesWi|| dominate the next 5oo.1ooo years of man's history.

All prices subject to change without notice.

27r
Nuclear Evolution: Discovery of the Rainbow Body, by ChristopherHills
D e l u x ep a p e r b a c$k1 2 . 9 5 Hardbacklibrarvedition$'l 8.95
This book is perhapsthe mostauthoritative potentia|s
|ookat the evo|utonary of the human
raceeverpub|ished. Lightis thethemeothe book:thatthehumanpersona|ityisformedrom
wavesand pulsesof light.Humansand otheranimalsand objectseat light,and the human
mind is a blackholethatabsorbslioht.thenemitsit as the rainbowbodv.A masteroiece in
conscrousnessresearch.

Food From Sunlight by Christopher Hills $14.95


The Japanesehaveknown since 1 91 7 thatsuccessfu| harvestingoa|gaewou|dproduce
infiniteamountso food from air. |ightand water.Fai|ureto do so promptedin 1959 the
Japanese newspaperarticle,Ch/ore/laAlgae, theManna from Heaven,is a TwentiethCentury
Myth. But in 1963 Spirulinaalgaewas discoveredand. overthe nextten years,brought
mannafromheavento a reality.InJapanit now sellsounceforouncethesamepriceas gold,
due to its nutritional
valuesand rejuvenation properties.

May You Live in Health, by Aaron Friedell,M.D.


After meeting8O-yearold Aaron Friedell.you would want to buy his book-a guideto
effectivehealthhabits.His system is the resultoforty yea/s practiceas a physicianand
researcheron increasing thevigorof the humanbodyand obtainingpeaceof mind.Although
practical.Dr. Friedell's
book has some amazingtechnicaldata explainedsimply.

The Politics of God, by Dr. Hugh J. Schonfield


The authoroThePassoverPlot does it again!|nthis book his aim is to show thatChristianity
as practicedtodayis not identica|
WithWhatJesus oNazerethor his immediateo||owers
taughtbut represents romtheirbe|iefs.
a deviation Thisbookpicksup the ancientMessianic
ideaand givesit a modernappIication
bringingtogetheronceagaintheessentiaI faithoJews
and Christians.

Wholistic Health and Living Yoga, by Malcolm Strutl


A newwholisticapproachto thespiritual scienceof totalhealthwhichincludestheapplication
of yogicprinciples
to dailylivingsituations.
completeself-examination yoga
and encounters,
postures,meditations, breathing methods.and otherpractlcaltechniques
and energizing or
spiritualstimulation.

Journey Into Light by Ann Ray


By weavinga Woman,s storyof spirituaIstrugg|e and unfo|dingwithwondrousinsightotime,
space and consciousness, a de|ightul and inormative book has beencreated.Seeming|y
remotemodernscientiicbreakthroughs are re|atedto everyday|ieand prob|ems.Different
fromtheusua|bookson spiritual teachings,thisbookon the princip|esoNuc|earEvolution is
not abstractand untested,but is writtenout of rea|experienceand provenin the |aboratory
o
the heart.

ENERGY MATTER & FORM


(Tovarrda Sciene of Conscioumess)
* PYRAMIO ENEBGY * TELEPATHY
* PENDULUM POWEB * HEALING
- AURAS * WATEB DIVINING

Clear, easy to understand experiments that


can help you develop incredible supersensi-
tivity to the Universe around you. 288pp,
8Y2 x 11, color cover, $9.95.

Al| prlces subject to chang wltbout notica

272
SUPERSENSONICS TOOLS AND INSTRUMENTS

The following divining tools mentioned in the text are aids for contacting
intelligences or energies, and are not substitutes for spiritual work on our-
selves.
AURA PENDULUM: A |ow cost pendu|Um or determining a person,s aura and the psychic atmos-
phers that surrounds them. $6.00. An excellent accompaniment is "The Bainbow Aura Pendulum
Booklet" for lB1.OO.
THE MEBKHET: Has th samg use as the osiris but the mrcury scontained in an unbreakab|e body
for use in a tougher environment. $16.(X)
BOOMPH COIL: For thoss who wish to raise their Kundalini energy. $83.0O.
HILLs PosITIVE GREEN PENDULUM: | s s p e c i f c a | | y t u n e d t o | i e . f o r c eo r p r a n a a n d i s t h r e o r e
used for checking people's health and vitalitv, the nutritional value of foods and herbs, and checking
pyramid energies. $1 5.00.
Pl-RAY ORGONE ENEBGY ACCUMULATOR COFFEB: "lt materializes your imaginings," said one
usr',,It has helped bring about some remarkable events, inc|uding hea|ing, selIing properties, finding
housgs and cars or peop|e at the right price. and increasing one,s spritua|ity',, $79'oo.
EGYPTIAN ANKH DIVlNING Roo: |s a tvp of divining rod that made ths ancient Egyptians an
advanced civiIization. For use in the ie|d. $8.0o'
TURENNE MAGNET-F|TTED RoD: A Vey s|ectioe divining rod, used for outdoor work in much
th6 3me way as Moses and Jacob used their rods. Exce|lent for water, minera| and |ost objcts
locating. $22.0O.
TUBENNE MAGNET.F|TTEo PENDULUM: Ca||ed the Bo||s Boyce o pendu|ums bscause it has a
wide range of selectivity and is specially suited for use with the Turenne Bule for dotecting atomic and
chmica| substances. The researchgr,s penduIum. $2o.oo.
TURENNE FUNDAMENTAL BAY D|sc; For chemists this disc takes the p|ace of expnsive ana|yti-
cal instruments. For those concerned about health and self-healing, the disc can reveal whether the
forty.our e|ements of nature present in the human body are in excess or ar dgficint' $29.oo.
sPEcTRUM MIRRoB: A many-amp|ified pnduIUm containing radium, a wave-guide, and a si|ver
mirrored surfac to rgflect of unWanted vibes inc|uding negatve thoughts. Excg|lent for the
professional and the bsginnor. As a gift it is very beautiful, $18.O0.
MAGNETBON: This instrument is a broadcast healer and direction finder, allowing you to send
hea|.ng vibrations to anyone whose photograph you p|ace at the center. A|so a great git or the
organic aardener to prot c t pIants from insects' $35.00
souABE BALANcE EQUALlZEB: A too| for obsorbng and ba|ancing Iife.force.$28.oo'
T|ME REcEss|oNAL o|sc: Enab|es a person With a Merkht or osiris pendu|um to dat
and
orientatg ancint obiects. $7.50.
TURENNE BULE: Revoa|s thg 44 e|ements o nature which are present in the human body,axcess or
dicit o any o which wi|| cause i|| haa|th. It is a remarkab|e instrument for finding out your true
spiritual condition, and your physical and emotional state of being. A real bargain at $35.00
BADIUM BLocK' TRITIUM BLocK: Are amp|ifiers or a|| divining instruments. Both are $23.oo.
The Radium B|ock is specia||y made to fit on the Turenne Ru|e and amp|iies the fie|d of thg samp|e
itself. The Tritium Block amplifies the diviner's reaction.
HEF|GAR: Amp|ifis the fie|d so strong|y that, Using it, most peop|e can become divinrs. |t is a
virtually indispensibls instrument to be used in coniunction with a pendulum or rod. 035,00 Name is
abbrgvation for ,,Hi||s End-Fire Intensifying Guide and Radiator.,,

These prices subiect to change without notice.

UNIVERsITY oF THE TREEs PBEss, P'o. Box 644, Bou|der creek, ca|iornia 95006

O R D E R I N GI N F O R M A T I O N
u.s.A. FOREIGN
'1.
Prepayment:check or money
Foreign maiI is VerY expensive or us so
. order.
we must charge to cover. Overpayment
2 . N o C . O . D .s .
will be credited.
3. No stamps. please.
1. Have all checks and money orders
4. We ship immediately.
. statingceniiedU's. Do||ars'
5. PostageI handlingrates:
2. Expect de|iveryateriveweeks'
' |your order is:
3. Postageand HandlingRates:
. u p t o $ 6 a d d . . .. . . . . . . . . . $1.00
...1.50 0-$50add.... . . . .. $ 3 . 5 0
. $ 6 . 0 1 - $ 2 0 . 0a 0d d . . . . . . .
...2.50 $ 5 ] - $ 1 0 0 a d d. . ..... $4.50
. $ 2 0 . 0 1 - $ 4a0d d . . . . . . . . .
...3.50 S'101-150add.. . . . .. $ 5 . 5 0
. $ 4 0 . 0 1 - $ 6a0d d . . . . . . . . .
. $ 6 0 . 0 1 - $ 2 4a0d d . . . . . . . ... 4.50 $ 1 5 1- $ 2 0 0 a d d ..... $6.50
$201-$250 add ..... $7.50

2't3
T H E S C I E N C E O F V I B R A T I O N A N D T R A N S M I S S I O NO F L I F E - F O R C E
Bumf Boomph Yoga ir the name glven by Chrstopher Hi||s to a crie3of practica| steps ditti||od
from many differont yogic technlques for holghBnlng and purifying human consclourness. Tho
wordr come from a comb|nat|on o thg sanskrit word Rum meaning sP|rlt and th Am r lcan word
oomph mean|ng the |nner bubb|ng of life-force. Th s tap s cannot be effectively describ d 8. they
are ora| step-by-st p in3tructions. Many people use these oxercis s for |ncr a sing the brain g|ectrlcitY
and sntering th cav of Bahma. -

RUMF ROOMPHYOGA
Avai|able |n sequenco on|y RRY.I3 Group Exercisesfor Dis:o|ution of seperst d
TAPE SUBJECT SELF
RRY-l |ntroductlon to the serl3s; the pr|ncip|o of RRY-14 contacting the Trg o Life & th Troe of
|dsnttftc8tlon Know|edge insde Each oth r
RBY-2 sttmu|atton o Braln ce||s; Expans|on lnto RRY.l5 Evolutlonory GrouP lnt r act|onr: The LovB
Tota| op n nes6; Creat|on of Mudrar s a t
RFtY.3 Tantric Un.on of oppo3|t s through shakt. RBY.6 Principles of creative Conf|ict; Mast r |ng
shiva Danc ss|f-lntoxication with so|f.saturat|on
BBY-4 How to contro| the chakra Forces by BBY.l7 Becom|nga sou| Mirror. or co3mic T|.
Looking at th Garbage v3ion camera
RRY.s Badico|izingtheEgosnso;Moditationon BBY.8 AnahataNadam:chantingthroughtheHe8rt
the centor Symbol c n tr ; Gaining contro| over |nner Forces
RRY-6 Gotting contro| of th Ego BRY-19 Group Discuss|on of Rum Boomph Yoga
RRY.7 Meditation or Expanding the so|f.s6nse Exper|ence
snd Burst|ng th Ego Bubb|g RRY.2o Mahavidgya: sup r P n otration of tho Mind-
RRY-8 The Funct|on o thg Ego, The Super. stuff of s | f & oth r s
Conscious Mind, & tmaglnation RRY.21 Ba|ancing L v lty & Gravity; the st p 3 to
BBY.g Meditation & Brgath contro| for Prot | n Nucl a r Evo|ution
synthe3|6i Transmut|ng Sexua| Energie3 RBY-22 Advanc d Exerci. in shiva.shaktl;
RRY.1o Und r 8tanding the Natur of PUre Surrendering A|l Your Bging to tho ong
Consciougness Guru: Your Trug s | f; Diacover|ng Karma
RBY-! 1 Prct|cing the Presence RBY 23 Purifying the chakrat by chantlng th om;
BRY-I2 Va|idation of Yog|c Methods of Know|ng, ov r coming R s iBtanc & |nert|
W8shing th Mind C|ear of Prgvious conc p ts BRY.24 Embodying th Avotar Consciouenegs

Rumf Roomph Yoga (] hr. up to 2 hrs. each) Speak to us o .


R R Y - I. . ....$ 9.OO RRY-13. ....$11.00 K a r m a ,D u t v .a n d O n e s T r u e N a t u r e ( 7' 1: h r s . ) . ...$10.00

RRY.2.. ...'$11.oo RRY.14. ....$ 8.o0 C h a n g e a n d S e l - M a s t e r yh(r1. , 2 0 m i n . .) . . ...'.$ 9.oo

RRY-3.. .... $12.00 R R Y - '5I . .... $ LOO T h e U n i v e r s aHl o l o g r a m( 1 h r . ,5 5 m i n . ) . . . ...... $12.00

RRY-4.. ....$1 1.OO RRY-16. ....$12.00 V i s i o n ( 1h r . ) . . . . ..'. $ B,O0


RRY-5.. -...$ LOO ffRY-l7. :...$12.00 R e a lL o v e .M o t i v e s ( 1h r . , 4 O m i n . ) . . . ...$11.00

RRY-6.. ....$11.00 RRY-18. ....S8.00 LearningFromNature.Procrastination.

RRY-7.. .. .. $ 9.00 RRY-19. .... $10.00 , i n d l e s s n e s(s1 h r , . .). . .


R e b i r t hM $ 8.00

RRy-8.. ....$8.0O RRY-20. ....$10.00


RRy-21. ....$12.00 ModitataonsontheOne
RRy-g.. ....$1O.OO
RRY-22' '... $ 8.oo N u m b e r s1 . 5 ( 1 h r . e a c h ) eac $ 8.o0
RRY.16. '... $ B.oo
RRy-]1. ....$10.00 BRY-23. ....$8.00
Totheonellove
RRy-12. ....$1r.oo RBy-24. ....$g.oo
Numbers,l . 6 {1 hr' each). eac $ 8.00

All prices subject to chang6 without notice.

274
SUPERSENSONICSO AIR ENER GIZERS
SUPERENERGIZER SYSTEM
Wall-mounted Unit

Single room unit perfect 8 emitters


for home. office or den. enriching the air
with electrical ions.
Power "ON" switch tatttttrai
Power "ON" light aaaaattl" ,,We
llf,rrrt"' eel we have the
taa.lF'rr' finest unit available at
llaatt"tt
this price range with 8
: :l : ::: :; ; emitters."-Dave Edwards,
Attractive wall-mounted Production Manager
unit which also looks
smart on your desk or
table top.

-'-
O This heavy duty
unit makes it ideal for
conferencerooms, Many scientists believe that an
small auditoriums,homes, offices, abundanceof negativeions will:
libraries, hospitals, schools and (Dreducethe posiibility oflinfection,colds, etc.
restaurants. O increaseconcentratinand alertness
O reduce the need for sleeo
O relievetension
Orefresh polluted air, and
O combat cigarettesmoke See the book. YOUR ELECTRG
VIBRATORY BODY forthebenefitsof
ORDERING INFORMATION
University of the Trees Press, Box 644, Boutder Creek CA 95006 a high negative ion environmentbased
on recent worldwide research.
NAME -__
STREET ADDRES S: AJough the.considerableresearchon arions indicates that beneficial effectsmay
UPswi||
notdeliver
!oPost
ofice.
Please
supply
fulladdess' ffi:l"ffjii.;il'!T3#J$'3J#.,1lJ.ffi.*1i'i3:iffH#;:il::fs."":i[T
CITY,STATE,zP______-_ ___ their representativesare making any therapeuticor biological claims regarding";,
this machine.

NAME OF PRODUCT QTY PRICE


System 1 8emitters 139.00
Signature ----Date

Total ----
(Plus postage& handling) $5.50 ----
Calif. residents add 67o tax
GRAND TOTAL
All prices subject to change without nolice.

275
. . . about the Universitv of the Trees
The University of the Trees is a communitydedicatedto mansevolution.It was foundedby Christopher Hills in
1973 as a norrprofit organizationbased on the concept of working on the expansion of our ego self toward a group
conscious spirit. The studentswho have come togetherfrom all parts of the U.S. to unfold is evolutionary thrust
participatedaily in such activities as chanting Rumf Roomph Yog4 Creative Conlict, Supersensonics'a course on
direct enlightenmentcalled "Into Meditation Now" and a new concept of community government University of the
Trees is also a degreegrantinginstitutionwhich awards B.A, N,.A.and Ph.D. degreesin a wide variety of subjects
relatedto consciousnessresearch.
We are always searchingfor practical soluons to the problemsof society. one of our recentpublications,..Food
from Sunlight'', is a direct responseto our concernfor the needlessworld hungercrisis. Creative Conlictis a practical
solutionto the problemof humanconflict We facilitateclassesopento the public one nighta week whereskills in direct
communication,ego penetration,openness,and spontaneousperception are practiced. Several of our authors are
available for lecture.If you are in a group that sponsorsworkshops and speakers,please write for furtherdetails. We
offer workshopsin meditation(adults or children), supersensonicsand creative conlicl
Members of the University of the Trees do not rely on taxpayerfinancin& grantsor donationsfor income but rather
our book publishing,phototypesettingsale ofcassettetapesand divining tools. Thank you, everyone,for your response
and suppoWe are still searchingfor an appropriateproprty' preferablya school, campgroundor resortwith existing
facilities in a place that is relatively frost-freefor our algae program
Visitors are welcome on Tuesdays and Saturdaysfor tea at 4:00. We'll be glad to answeryour questionsat these
times.Visitors may also participatein our meditaon,chantingand worship servicewhich Christopher leads on Friday
evenings,promptly at7:.3o(summer),7:00 (winter).Pleasephoneaheadfor changes,(408) 338-3855,duringoTice
hours,weekdays,10:00 a.m.-5:00p.m.

Map for reachingthe University of the Trees Office in Boulder Creek Blessings,
l3l5l Pine Street BoulderCreek CA [408]338-3855 StudenVFaculty
Offrce Hours:10-5 Mondav thru Thurs.
IO-4 Friday, Saturdays10-l University of the Trees
Closed Sundays
FRIDAY MGHT MEDITATION with Christopher Hills
7:30 p.m.(summeronly),7:00 winter
Chanting Instruction
Meditation
Discussion(bring your questions)

Followed by Tea and Cookies

13185Pine Street
Doors close promptly at 7:30
Donation

TEA TIMES
Come and visit on:
Tuesdays& Saturdays
4:00 - 5:00 p.rn

FREEWAY ROUTE EASY DRIVE


101or 280 to 17 South
Exit to Felton via Mount Hermon Road - 3 miles
Ben l-omond - 3 miles. to Boulder Creek - 2 miles

276

You might also like